Micom p40
Micom p40
Micom p40
Grid Solutions
Technical Manual
Distance Protection IED
Hardware Version: P
Software Version: 80
Publication Reference: P446SV-TM-EN-1
Contents
Chapter 1 Introduction 1
1 Chapter Overview 3
2 Foreword 4
2.1 Target Audience 4
2.2 Typographical Conventions 4
2.3 Nomenclature 5
2.4 Compliance 5
3 Product Scope 6
3.1 Product Versions 6
3.2 Ordering Options 7
4 Features and Functions 8
4.1 Distance Protection Functions 8
4.2 Protection Functions 8
4.3 Control Functions 9
4.4 Measurement Functions 9
4.5 Communication Functions 9
5 Logic Diagrams 11
6 Functional Overview 13
Chapter 5 Configuration 69
1 Chapter Overview 71
2 Settings Application Software 72
3 Using the HMI Panel 73
3.1 Navigating the HMI Panel 74
ii P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents
P446SV-TM-EN-1 iii
Contents P446SV
iv P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents
P446SV-TM-EN-1 v
Contents P446SV
vi P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents
P446SV-TM-EN-1 vii
Contents P446SV
viii P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents
P446SV-TM-EN-1 ix
Contents P446SV
x P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents
P446SV-TM-EN-1 xi
Contents P446SV
xii P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents
P446SV-TM-EN-1 xiii
Contents P446SV
xiv P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents
P446SV-TM-EN-1 xv
Contents P446SV
xvi P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents
P446SV-TM-EN-1 xvii
Contents P446SV
xviii P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents
P446SV-TM-EN-1 xix
Contents P446SV
xx P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Contents
P446SV-TM-EN-1 xxi
Contents P446SV
xxii P446SV-TM-EN-1
Table of Figures
Figure 1: P40L family - version evolution 7
Figure 2: Key to logic diagrams 12
Figure 3: Functional Overview 13
Figure 4: Hardware architecture 32
Figure 5: Exploded view of IED 33
Figure 6: Front panel (40TE) 35
Figure 7: Rear view of populated case 38
Figure 8: Rear connection to terminal block 39
Figure 9: Main processor board 40
Figure 10: Power supply board 41
Figure 11: Power supply assembly 42
Figure 12: Power supply terminals 43
Figure 13: Watchdog contact terminals 44
Figure 14: Rear serial port terminals 45
Figure 15: IEC 61850-9-2LE board 45
Figure 16: Standard output relay board - 8 contacts 46
Figure 17: IRIG-B board 47
Figure 18: Fibre optic board 48
Figure 19: Rear communication board 49
Figure 20: Ethernet board 49
Figure 21: Redundant Ethernet board 51
Figure 22: Fully populated Coprocessor board 53
Figure 23: High Break relay output board 54
Figure 24: High Break contact operation 55
Figure 25: Software Architecture 60
Figure 26: Frequency response of FIR filters 66
Figure 27: Frequency Response (indicative only) 67
Figure 28: Navigating the HMI 74
Figure 29: Default display navigation 76
Figure 30: Circuit Breaker Trip Conversion Logic Diagram (Module 63) 85
Figure 31: Comparison of Conventional IED and Sampled Values IED 96
Figure 32: Data sampling using an IEC 61850-9-2LE interface 97
Figure 33: System Impedance Ratio 108
Figure 34: Directional mho element construction 111
Figure 35: Offset Mho characteristic 112
Figure 36: Directional Mho element construction – impedance domain 113
Figure 37: Offset Mho characteristics – impedance domain 114
Figure 38: Offset mho characteristics – voltage domain 115
Table of Figures P446SV
xxiv P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Table of Figures
P446SV-TM-EN-1 xxv
Table of Figures P446SV
Figure 118: Phase selector timing for power swing condition 231
Figure 119: Phase selector timing for fault condition 231
Figure 120: Phase selector timing for fault during a power swing 232
Figure 121: Slow Power Swing detection characteristic 233
Figure 122: Load Blinder Boundary Conditions 236
Figure 123: Power swing blocking logic 237
Figure 124: Setting the resistive reaches 238
Figure 125: Reactive reach settings 239
Figure 126: PSB timer setting guidelines 240
Figure 127: Out of Step detection characteristic 241
Figure 128: Out of Step logic diagram 243
Figure 129: OST setting determination for the positive sequence resistive component OST R5 244
Figure 130: OST R6max determination 245
Figure 131: Example of timer reset due to MOVs operation 248
Figure 132: Autoreclose sequence for a Transient Fault 256
Figure 133: Autoreclose sequence for an evolving or permanent fault 257
Figure 134: Autoreclose sequence for an evolving or permanent fault - single-phase operation 257
Figure 135: Dual CB Autoreclose Sequence for a Transient Fault 258
Figure 136: Autoreclose Sequence for an evolving/permanent fault on a dual CB application 259
Figure 137: Autoreclose Sequence for a persistent fault on a multishot dual CB application set 259
for single-phase operation
Figure 138: Key to logic diagrams 262
Figure 139: Autoreclose System Map - part 1 263
Figure 140: Autoreclose System Map - part 2 264
Figure 141: Autoreclose System Map - part 3 265
Figure 142: Autoreclose System Map - part 4 266
Figure 143: Autoreclose System Map - part 5 267
Figure 144: Autoreclose System Map - part 6 268
Figure 145: Autoreclose System Map - part 7 269
Figure 146: Autoreclose System Map - part 8 270
Figure 147: Autoreclose System Map - part 9 271
Figure 148: Autoreclose System Map - part 10 272
Figure 149: CB State logic diagram (Module 1) 290
Figure 150: Circuit Breaker Open logic diagram (Module 3) 291
Figure 151: CB In Service logic diagram (Module 4) 292
Figure 152: Autoreclose Enable logic diagram (Module 5) 292
Figure 153: Leader/Follower CB Selection Logic Diagram (Module 6) 293
Figure 154: Leader/Follower logic diagram (Module 7 & 8) 294
Figure 155: Autoreclose Modes Enable logic diagram (Module 9) 296
Figure 156: Force three-phase trip logic diagram (Module 10) 297
xxvi P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Table of Figures
P446SV-TM-EN-1 xxvii
Table of Figures P446SV
Figure 196: CB Manual Close System Check Logic Diagram (Modules 51 & 52) 340
Figure 197: Circuit Breaker Fail logic - part 1 351
Figure 198: Circuit Breaker Fail logic - part 2 352
Figure 199: Circuit Breaker Fail logic - part 3 353
Figure 200: Circuit Breaker Fail logic - part 4 354
Figure 201: CB Fail timing 356
Figure 202: Phase Overcurrent Protection logic diagram 362
Figure 203: Negative Phase Sequence Overcurrent Protection logic diagram 364
Figure 204: IDG Characteristic 367
Figure 205: Earth Fault Protection logic diagram 369
Figure 206: EPATR B characteristic shown for TMS = 1.0 372
Figure 207: Sensitive Earth Fault Protection logic diagram 372
Figure 208: Current distribution in an insulated system with C phase fault 373
Figure 209: Phasor diagrams for insulated system with C phase fault 374
Figure 210: Positioning of core balance current transformers 375
Figure 211: High Impedance REF principle 376
Figure 212: High Impedance REF Connection 377
Figure 213: Thermal overload protection logic diagram 379
Figure 214: Spreadsheet calculation for dual time constant thermal characteristic 380
Figure 215: Dual time constant thermal characteristic 380
Figure 216: Broken conductor logic 382
Figure 217: Undervoltage - single and three phase tripping mode (single stage) 389
Figure 218: Overvoltage - single and three phase tripping mode (single stage) 392
Figure 219: Residual Overvoltage logic 396
Figure 220: Residual voltage for a solidly earthed system 397
Figure 221: Residual voltage for an impedance earthed system 398
Figure 222: Underfrequency logic (single stage) 403
Figure 223: Overfrequency logic (single stage) 404
Figure 224: Rate of change of frequency logic (single stage) 405
Figure 225: Fault recorder stop conditions 412
Figure 226: Broken Current Accumulator logic diagram 417
Figure 227: CB Trip Counter logic diagram 418
Figure 228: Operating Time Accumulator 419
Figure 229: Excessive Fault Frequency logic diagram 420
Figure 230: Reset Lockout Alarm logic diagram 421
Figure 231: CB1 Condition Monitoring logic diagram 422
Figure 232: CB2 Condition Monitoring logic diagram 423
Figure 233: Reset Circuit Breaker Lockout Logic Diagram (Modules 57 & 58) 425
Figure 234: CB State logic diagram (Module 1) 428
Figure 235: Hotkey menu navigation 430
xxviii P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Table of Figures
P446SV-TM-EN-1 xxix
Table of Figures P446SV
Figure 275: Redundant Ethernet ring architecture with IED, bay computer and Ethernet switches 517
after failure
Figure 276: Dual homing mechanism 518
Figure 277: Application of Dual Homing Star at substation level 519
Figure 278: IED and REB IP address configuration 520
Figure 279: Connection using (a) an Ethernet switch and (b) a media converter 523
Figure 280: Connection using (a) an Ethernet switch and (b) a media converter 527
Figure 281: Control input behaviour 550
Figure 282: Data model layers in IEC61850 562
Figure 283: Edition 2 system - backward compatibility 566
Figure 284: Edition 1 system - forward compatibility issues 566
Figure 285: Example of Standby IED 567
Figure 286: Standby IED Activation Process 568
Figure 287: GPS Satellite timing signal 571
Figure 288: Timing error using ring or line topology 573
Figure 289: Default display navigation 584
Figure 290: Location of battery isolation strip 597
Figure 291: Rack mounting of products 598
Figure 292: Terminal block types 600
Figure 293: 40TE case dimensions 604
Figure 294: RP1 physical connection 620
Figure 295: Remote communication using K-bus 621
Figure 296: InterMicom loopback testing 624
Figure 297: Simulated input behaviour 631
Figure 298: Test example 1 632
Figure 299: Test example 2 633
Figure 300: Test example 3 634
Figure 301: State impedances 646
Figure 302: Possible terminal block types 668
Figure 303: Front panel assembly 670
xxx P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 1
INTRODUCTION
Chapter 1 - Introduction P446SV
2 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 1 - Introduction
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter provides some general information about the technical manual and an introduction to the device(s)
described in this technical manual.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 3
Foreword 4
Product Scope 6
Features and Functions 8
Logic Diagrams 11
Functional Overview 13
P446SV-TM-EN-1 3
Chapter 1 - Introduction P446SV
2 FOREWORD
This technical manual provides a functional and technical description of General Electric's P446SV, as well as a
comprehensive set of instructions for using the device. The level at which this manual is written assumes that you
are already familiar with protection engineering and have experience in this discipline. The description of principles
and theory is limited to that which is necessary to understand the product. For further details on general
protection engineering theory, we refer you to Alstom's publication NPAG, which is available online or from our
contact centre.
We have attempted to make this manual as accurate, comprehensive and user-friendly as possible. However we
cannot guarantee that it is free from errors. Nor can we state that it cannot be improved. We would therefore be
very pleased to hear from you if you discover any errors, or have any suggestions for improvement. Our policy is to
provide the information necessary to help you safely specify, engineer, install, commission, maintain, and
eventually dispose of this product. We consider that this manual provides the necessary information, but if you
consider that more details are needed, please contact us.
All feedback should be sent to our contact centre via the following URL:
www.gegridsolutions.com/contact
4 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 1 - Introduction
2.3 NOMENCLATURE
Due to the technical nature of this manual, many special terms, abbreviations and acronyms are used throughout
the manual. Some of these terms are well-known industry-specific terms while others may be special product-
specific terms used by General Electric. The first instance of any acronym or term used in a particular chapter is
explained. In addition, a separate glossary is available on the General Electric website, or from the General Electric
contact centre.
We would like to highlight the following changes of nomenclature however:
● The word 'relay' is no longer used to describe the device itself. Instead, the device is referred to as the 'IED'
(Intelligent Electronic Device), the 'device', or the 'product'. The word 'relay' is used purely to describe the
electromechanical components within the device, i.e. the output relays.
● British English is used throughout this manual.
● The British term 'Earth' is used in favour of the American term 'Ground'.
2.4 COMPLIANCE
The device has undergone a range of extensive testing and certification processes to ensure and prove
compatibility with all target markets. A detailed description of these criteria can be found in the Technical
Specifications chapter.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 5
Chapter 1 - Introduction P446SV
3 PRODUCT SCOPE
Unlike a conventional IED, a device with an IEC61850-9-2 interface, or Sampled Value (SV) device accepts current
and voltage measurement inputs, which have already been digitized in accordance with the IEC 61850-9-2LE
standard.
The P446SV is such a device. It accepts sampled analogue values from merging units. It does not accept analogue
values directly and therefore does not have any current or voltage transformers. This provides a number of
advantages over conventional devices, which are discussed throughout this technical manual.
The P446SV has been designed for distance protection of overhead line and underground cable applications,
where the network is solidly grounded. It is used for dual circuit breaker applications, such as breaker-and-a-half,
or ring bus topologies, where two circuit breakers feed each line. As well as distance protection, this device can
also be used for 4-shot phase-segregated Autoreclose protection and a range of standard current, voltage, power
and frequency backup protection applications.
6 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 1 - Introduction
P445: J37
P54x No Distance: K47
P841A: K47
All other products: K57
Conventional Stream NCIT Stream
P445: P41
P54x No Distance: M61
P446, P546, P841B: M72
P841A: M61
All other products: M71
XCPU3
Cyber-security
NCIT (now obsolete)
New Protection
functions
Sub-cycle Diff Stream
P445: P45
P54x No Distance: M65 P543, P545: M63
P446, P546, P841B: M74
P841A: M65 Non-distance
All other products: M75
XCPU3
New Protection Sub-cycle differential for
Cyber-security
functions non-distance versions
NCIT (9-2LE interface)
P445: P46
P54x No Distance: M66
P841A: M66
All other products: M76
Current Differential
Starters for P54x
Other improvements
Multi-end subcycle stream
V00062
P446SV-TM-EN-1 7
Chapter 1 - Introduction P446SV
8 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 1 - Introduction
Feature ANSI
NERC compliant cyber-security
P446SV-TM-EN-1 9
Chapter 1 - Introduction P446SV
Feature ANSI
Front RS232 serial communication port for configuration 16S
Rear serial RS485 communication port for SCADA control 16S
2 Additional rear serial communication ports for SCADA control and
16S
teleprotection (fibre and copper) (optional)
Ethernet communication (optional) 16E
Redundant Ethernet communication (optional) 16E
Courier Protocol 16S
IEC 61850 edition 2 16E
IEC 60870-5-103 (optional) 16S
DNP3.0 over serial link (optional) 16S
DNP3.0 over Ethernet (optional) 16E
SNMP 16E
IRIG-B time synchronisation (optional) CLK
IEEE 1588 PTP (Edition 2 devices only)
10 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 1 - Introduction
5 LOGIC DIAGRAMS
This technical manual contains many logic diagrams, which should help to explain the functionality of the device.
Although this manual has been designed to be as specific as possible to the chosen product, it may contain
diagrams, which have elements applicable to other products. If this is the case, a qualifying note will accompany
the relevant part.
The logic diagrams follow a convention for the elements used, using defined colours and shapes. A key to this
convention is provided below. We recommend viewing the logic diagrams in colour rather than in black and white.
The electronic version of the technical manual is in colour, but the printed version may not be. If you need coloured
diagrams, they can be provided on request by calling the contact centre and quoting the diagram number.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 11
Chapter 1 - Introduction P446SV
Key:
Energising Quantity AND gate &
Hardcoded setting
Pulse / Latch
Measurement Cell S
SR Latch Q
R
Internal Calculation
S
SR Latch Q
Derived setting Reset Dominant RD
Switch Multiplier X
Bandpass filter
Comparator for detecting
undervalues
12 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 1 - Introduction
6 FUNCTIONAL OVERVIEW
This diagram is applicable to three products in the P40L family; P443, P445 and P446. Use the key on the diagram
to determine the features relevant to the product described in this technical manual.
BUS
I
I
LINE
V
V ref
27/ 85 LEDs
59N FL 50BF VTS 79 25 PSL
LINE 59
Neutral current
(if present) Conventional Inter MiCOM Protection
from parallel line communication Always Optional P443 & P446 P446
signalling available only only P443,P445 & P446
X
BUS
V00010
P446SV-TM-EN-1 13
Chapter 1 - Introduction P446SV
14 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 2
SAFETY INFORMATION
Chapter 2 - Safety Information P446SV
16 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 2 - Safety Information
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter provides information about the safe handling of the equipment. The equipment must be properly
installed and handled in order to maintain it in a safe condition and to keep personnel safe at all times. You must
be familiar with information contained in this chapter before unpacking, installing, commissioning, or servicing the
equipment.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 17
Health and Safety 18
Symbols 19
Installation, Commissioning and Servicing 20
Decommissioning and Disposal 25
Regulatory Compliance 26
P446SV-TM-EN-1 17
Chapter 2 - Safety Information P446SV
The documentation provides instructions for installing, commissioning and operating the equipment. It cannot,
however cover all conceivable circumstances. In the event of questions or problems, do not take any action
without proper authorisation. Please contact your local sales office and request the necessary information.
18 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 2 - Safety Information
3 SYMBOLS
Throughout this manual you will come across the following symbols. You will also see these symbols on parts of
the equipment.
Caution:
Refer to equipment documentation. Failure to do so could result in damage to the
equipment
Warning:
Risk of electric shock
Earth terminal. Note: This symbol may also be used for a protective conductor (earth) terminal if that terminal
is part of a terminal block or sub-assembly.
Note:
The term 'Earth' used in this manual is the direct equivalent of the North American term 'Ground'.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 19
Chapter 2 - Safety Information P446SV
Plan carefully, identify any possible hazards and determine how best to move the product. Look at other ways of
moving the load to avoid manual handling. Use the correct lifting techniques and Personal Protective Equipment
(PPE) to reduce the risk of injury.
Caution:
All personnel involved in installing, commissioning, or servicing this equipment must be
familiar with the correct working procedures.
Caution:
Consult the equipment documentation before installing, commissioning, or servicing
the equipment.
Caution:
Always use the equipment as specified. Failure to do so will jeopardise the protection
provided by the equipment.
Warning:
Removal of equipment panels or covers may expose hazardous live parts. Do not touch
until the electrical power is removed. Take care when there is unlocked access to the
rear of the equipment.
Warning:
Isolate the equipment before working on the terminal strips.
Warning:
Use a suitable protective barrier for areas with restricted space, where there is a risk of
electric shock due to exposed terminals.
Caution:
Disconnect power before disassembling. Disassembly of the equipment may expose
sensitive electronic circuitry. Take suitable precautions against electrostatic voltage
discharge (ESD) to avoid damage to the equipment.
20 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 2 - Safety Information
Caution:
NEVER look into optical fibres or optical output connections. Always use optical power
meters to determine operation or signal level.
Warning:
Testing may leave capacitors charged to dangerous voltage levels. Discharge
capacitors by rediucing test voltages to zero before disconnecting test leads.
Caution:
Operate the equipment within the specified electrical and environmental limits.
Caution:
Before cleaning the equipment, ensure that no connections are energised. Use a lint
free cloth dampened with clean water.
Note:
Contact fingers of test plugs are normally protected by petroleum jelly, which should not be removed.
Caution:
Equipment intended for rack or panel mounting is for use on a flat surface of a Type 1
enclosure, as defined by Underwriters Laboratories (UL).
Caution:
To maintain compliance with UL and CSA/CUL, install the equipment using UL/CSA-
recognised parts for: cables, protective fuses, fuse holders and circuit breakers,
insulation crimp terminals, and replacement internal batteries.
Caution:
Where UL/CSA listing of the equipment is required for external fuse protection, a UL or
CSA Listed fuse must be used for the auxiliary supply. The listed protective fuse type is:
Class J time delay fuse, with a maximum current rating of 15 A and a minimum DC
rating of 250 V dc (for example type AJT15).
Caution:
Where UL/CSA listing of the equipment is not required, a high rupture capacity (HRC)
fuse type with a maximum current rating of 16 Amps and a minimum dc rating of 250 V
dc may be used for the auxiliary supply (for example Red Spot type NIT or TIA).
For P50 models, use a 1A maximum T-type fuse.
For P60 models, use a 4A maximum T-type fuse.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 21
Chapter 2 - Safety Information P446SV
Caution:
Digital input circuits should be protected by a high rupture capacity NIT or TIA fuse with
maximum rating of 16 A. for safety reasons, current transformer circuits must never be
fused. Other circuits should be appropriately fused to protect the wire used.
Caution:
CTs must NOT be fused since open circuiting them may produce lethal hazardous
voltages
Warning:
Terminals exposed during installation, commissioning and maintenance may present a
hazardous voltage unless the equipment is electrically isolated.
Caution:
Tighten M4 clamping screws of heavy duty terminal block connectors to a nominal
torque of 1.3 Nm.
Tighten captive screws of terminal blocks to 0.5 Nm minimum and 0.6 Nm maximum.
Caution:
Always use insulated crimp terminations for voltage and current connections.
Caution:
Always use the correct crimp terminal and tool according to the wire size.
Caution:
Watchdog (self-monitoring) contacts are provided to indicate the health of the device
on some products. We strongly recommend that you hard wire these contacts into the
substation's automation system, for alarm purposes.
Caution:
Earth the equipment with the supplied PCT (Protective Conductor Terminal).
Caution:
Do not remove the PCT.
Caution:
The PCT is sometimes used to terminate cable screens. Always check the PCT’s integrity
after adding or removing such earth connections.
22 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 2 - Safety Information
Caution:
Use a locknut or similar mechanism to ensure the integrity of stud-connected PCTs.
Caution:
The recommended minimum PCT wire size is 2.5 mm² for countries whose mains supply
is 230 V (e.g. Europe) and 3.3 mm² for countries whose mains supply is 110 V (e.g. North
America). This may be superseded by local or country wiring regulations.
For P60 products, the recommended minimum PCT wire size is 6 mm². See product
documentation for details.
Caution:
The PCT connection must have low-inductance and be as short as possible.
Caution:
All connections to the equipment must have a defined potential. Connections that are
pre-wired, but not used, should be earthed, or connected to a common grouped
potential.
Caution:
Check voltage rating/polarity (rating label/equipment documentation).
Caution:
Check CT circuit rating (rating label) and integrity of connections.
Caution:
Check protective fuse or miniature circuit breaker (MCB) rating.
Caution:
Check integrity of the PCT connection.
Caution:
Check voltage and current rating of external wiring, ensuring it is appropriate for the
application.
Warning:
Do not open the secondary circuit of a live CT since the high voltage produced may be
lethal to personnel and could damage insulation. Short the secondary of the line CT
before opening any connections to it.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 23
Chapter 2 - Safety Information P446SV
Note:
For most Alstom equipment with ring-terminal connections, the threaded terminal block for current transformer termination
is automatically shorted if the module is removed. Therefore external shorting of the CTs may not be required. Check the
equipment documentation and wiring diagrams first to see if this applies.
Caution:
Where external components such as resistors or voltage dependent resistors (VDRs) are
used, these may present a risk of electric shock or burns if touched.
Warning:
Take extreme care when using external test blocks and test plugs such as the MMLG,
MMLB and P990, as hazardous voltages may be exposed. Ensure that CT shorting links
are in place before removing test plugs, to avoid potentially lethal voltages.
4.9 UPGRADING/SERVICING
Warning:
Do not insert or withdraw modules, PCBs or expansion boards from the equipment
while energised, as this may result in damage to the equipment. Hazardous live
voltages would also be exposed, endangering personnel.
Caution:
Internal modules and assemblies can be heavy and may have sharp edges. Take care
when inserting or removing modules into or out of the IED.
24 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 2 - Safety Information
Caution:
Before decommissioning, completely isolate the equipment power supplies (both poles
of any dc supply). The auxiliary supply input may have capacitors in parallel, which may
still be charged. To avoid electric shock, discharge the capacitors using the external
terminals before decommissioning.
Caution:
Avoid incineration or disposal to water courses. Dispose of the equipment in a safe,
responsible and environmentally friendly manner, and if applicable, in accordance with
country-specific regulations.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 25
Chapter 2 - Safety Information P446SV
6 REGULATORY COMPLIANCE
Compliance with the European Commission Directive on EMC and LVD is demonstrated using a technical file.
26 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 2 - Safety Information
Where:
'(2)G' High protection equipment category, for control of equipment in gas atmospheres in Zone 1 and 2.
This equipment (with parentheses marking around the zone number) is not itself suitable for operation
within a potentially explosive atmosphere.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 27
Chapter 2 - Safety Information P446SV
28 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 3
HARDWARE DESIGN
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV
30 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter provides information about the product's hardware design.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 31
Hardware Architecture 32
Mechanical Implementation 33
Front Panel 35
Rear Panel 38
Boards and Modules 39
P446SV-TM-EN-1 31
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV
2 HARDWARE ARCHITECTURE
The main components comprising an General Electric Sampled Values device are as follows:
● The housing, consisting of a front panel and connections at the rear
● The Main processor module consisting of the main CPU (Central Processing Unit), memory and an interface
to the front panel HMI (Human Machine Interface)
● A selection of plug-in boards and modules with presentation at the rear for the sampled values inputs,
power supply, communication functions, digital I/O and time synchronisation connectivity
All boards and modules are connected by a parallel data and address bus, which allows the processor module to
send and receive information to and from the other modules as required. There is also a separate serial data bus
for conveying sampled data from the input module to the CPU. These parallel and serial databuses are shown as a
single interconnection module in the following figure, which shows typical modules and the flow of data between
them.
Keypad
Output relay boards Output relay contacts
Processor module
Front panel HMI
LCD
Opto-input boards Digital inputs
LEDs
I/O
Front port
Sampled Values
Flash memory for settings
input board
Sample Value Inputs
Battery-backed SRAM
for records
V00280
32 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design
3 MECHANICAL IMPLEMENTATION
All products based on the Px4x platform have common hardware architecture. The hardware is modular and
consists of the following main parts:
● Case and terminal blocks
● Boards and modules
● Front panel
The case comprises the housing metalwork and terminal blocks at the rear. The boards fasten into the terminal
blocks and are connected together by a ribbon cable. This ribbon cable connects to the processor in the front
panel.
The following diagram shows an exploded view of a typical product. The diagram shown does not necessarily
represent exactly the product model described in this manual.
The products are available in panel-mount or standalone versions. All products are nominally 4U high. This equates
to 177.8 mm or 7 inches.
The cases are pre-finished steel with a conductive covering of aluminium and zinc. This provides good grounding
at all joints, providing a low resistance path to earth that is essential for performance in the presence of external
noise.
The case width depends on the product type and its hardware options. There are three different case widths for
the described range of products: 40TE, 60TE and 80TE. The case dimensions and compatibility criteria are as
follows:
P446SV-TM-EN-1 33
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV
Note:
Not all case sizes are available for all models.
34 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design
4 FRONT PANEL
P446SV-TM-EN-1 35
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV
4.1.2 KEYPAD
The keypad consists of the following keys:
4 arrow keys to navigate the menus (organised around the Enter key)
A read key for viewing larger blocks of text (arrow keys now used for
scrolling)
2 hot keys for scrolling through the default display and for control of
setting groups. These are situated directly below the LCD display.
36 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design
Note:
The front serial port does not support automatic extraction of event and disturbance records, although this data can be
accessed manually.
You must use the correct serial cable, or the communication will not work. A straight-through serial cable is
required, connecting pin 2 to pin 2, pin 3 to pin 3, and pin 5 to pin 5.
Once the physical connection from the unit to the PC is made, the PC’s communication settings must be set to
match those of the IED. The following table shows the unit’s communication settings for the front port.
Protocol Courier
Baud rate 19,200 bps
Courier address 1
Message format 11 bit - 1 start bit, 8 data bits, 1 parity bit (even parity), 1 stop bit
P446SV-TM-EN-1 37
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV
5 REAR PANEL
The MiCOM P40Agile Modular series uses a modular construction. Most of the internal workings are on boards and
modules which fit into slots. Some of the boards plug into terminal blocks, which are bolted onto the rear of the
unit. However, some boards such as the communications boards have their own connectors. The rear panel
consists of these terminal blocks plus the rears of the communications boards.
The back panel cut-outs and slot allocations vary. This depends on the product, the type of boards and the
terminal blocks needed to populate the case. The following diagram shows the rear view of a 40TE. The IEC
61850-9-2LE interface is highlighted in grey.
E00283
Note:
This diagram is a typical example and may not show the exact same arrangement of boards as your particular model. Refer
to the Cortec for product details.
38 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design
6.1 PCBS
A PCB typically consists of the components, a front connector for connecting into the main system parallel bus via
a ribbon cable, and an interface to the rear. This rear interface may be:
● Directly presented to the outside world (as is the case for communication boards such as Ethernet Boards)
● Presented to a connector, which in turn connects into a terminal block bolted onto the rear of the case (as is
the case for most of the other board types)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 39
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV
The main processor board performs all calculations and controls the operation of all other modules in the IED,
including the data communication and user interfaces. This is the only board that does not fit into one of the slots.
It resides in the front panel and connects to the rest of the system using an internal ribbon cable.
The LCD and LEDs are mounted on the processor board along with the front panel communication ports.
The memory on the main processor board is split into two categories: volatile and non-volatile. The volatile
memory is fast access SRAM, used by the processor to run the software and store data during calculations. The
non-volatile memory is sub-divided into two groups:
● Flash memory to store software code, text and configuration data including the present setting values.
● Battery-backed SRAM to store disturbance, event, fault and maintenance record data.
There are two board types available depending on the size of the case:
● For models in 40TE cases
● For models in 60TE cases and larger
40 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design
The power supply board provides power to the unit. One of three different configurations of the power supply
board can be fitted to the unit. This is specified at the time of order and depends on the magnitude of the supply
voltage that will be connected to it.
There are three board types, which support the following voltage ranges:
● 24/54 V DC
● 48/125 V DC or 40-100V AC
● 110/250 V DC or 100-240V AC
The power supply board connector plugs into a medium duty terminal block. This terminal block is always
positioned on the right hand side of the unit looking from the rear.
The power supply board is usually assembled together with a relay output board to form a complete subassembly,
as shown in the following diagram.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 41
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV
The power supply outputs are used to provide isolated power supply rails to the various modules within the unit.
Three voltage levels are used by the unit’s modules:
● 5.1 V for all of the digital circuits
● +/- 16 V for the analogue electronics such as on the input board
● 22 V for driving the output relay coils.
All power supply voltages, including the 0 V earth line, are distributed around the unit by the 64-way ribbon cable.
The power supply board incorporates inrush current limiting. This limits the peak inrush current to approximately
10 A.
Power is applied to pins 1 and 2 of the terminal block, where pin 1 is negative and pin 2 is positive. The pin
numbers are clearly marked on the terminal block as shown in the following diagram.
42 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design
6.3.1 WATCHDOG
The Watchdog contacts are also hosted on the power supply board. The Watchdog facility provides two output
relay contacts, one normally open and one normally closed. These are used to indicate the health of the device
and are driven by the main processor board, which continually monitors the hardware and software when the
device is in service.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 43
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV
44 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design
An additional serial port with D-type presentation is available as an optional board, if required.
RX
Fibre optic
Ethernet
connections
TX
LINK RJ45
1 TX+
2 TX- RJ45 service
3 RX+
4
port for
ACTIVITY 5 commissioning
6 RX- and testing only
7
8
E00227
P446SV-TM-EN-1 45
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV
RJ45 Connector
This is a service port for commissioning and testing only. Do not use this for permanent connections.
LEDs
LED Function On Off Flashing
Green Link Link ok Link broken
Yellow Activity Traffic
Note:
The 9-2LE interface fibre port does not support auto negotiation. Ensure the Ethernet port of the device connected to the 9-2
LE interface fibre port is set to 100Mbps full duplex.
This output relay board has 8 relays with 6 Normally Open contacts and 2 Changeover contacts.
The output relay board is provided together with the power supply board as a complete assembly, or
independently for the purposes of relay output expansion.
There are two cut-out locations in the board. These can be removed to allow power supply components to
protrude when coupling the output relay board to the power supply board. If the output relay board is to be used
independently, these cut-out locations remain intact.
The terminal numbers are as follows:
Terminal Number Output Relay
Terminal 1 Relay 1 NO
Terminal 2 Relay 1 NO
Terminal 3 Relay 2 NO
46 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design
The IRIG-B board can be fitted to provide an accurate timing reference for the device. The IRIG-B signal is
connected to the board via a BNC connector. The timing information is used to synchronise the IED's internal real-
time clock to an accuracy of 1 ms. The internal clock is then used for time tagging events, fault, maintenance and
disturbance records.
IRIG-B interface is available in modulated or demodulated formats.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 47
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV
The IRIG-B facility is provided in combination with other functionality on a number of additional boards, such as:
● Fibre board with IRIG-B
● Second rear communications board with IRIG-B
● Ethernet board with IRIG-B
● Redundant Ethernet board with IRIG-B
There are two types of each of these boards; one type which accepts a modulated IRIG-B input and one type
which accepts a demodulated IRIG-B input.
This board provides an interface for communicating with a master station. This communication link can use all
compatible protocols (Courier, IEC 60870-5-103, MODBUS and DNP 3.0). It is a fibre-optic alternative to the metallic
RS485 port presented on the power supply terminal block. The metallic and fibre optic ports are mutually exclusive.
The fibre optic port uses BFOC 2.5 ST connectors.
The board comes in two varieties; one with an IRIG-B input and one without:
48 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design
The optional communications board containing the secondary communication ports provide two serial interfaces
presented on 9 pin D-type connectors. These interfaces are known as SK4 and SK5. Both connectors are female
connectors, but are configured as DTE ports. This means pin 2 is used to transmit information and pin 3 to receive.
SK4 can be used with RS232, RS485 and K-bus. SK5 can only be used with RS232 and is used for electrical
teleprotection. The optional rear communications board and IRIG-B board are mutually exclusive since they use
the same hardware slot. However, the board comes in two varieties; one with an IRIG-B input and one without.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 49
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV
This is a communications board that provides a standard 100-Base Ethernet interface. This board supports one
electrical copper connection and one fibre-pair connection.
There are several variants for this board as follows:
● 100 Mbps Ethernet board
● 100 Mbps Ethernet with on-board modulated IRIG-B input
● 100 Mbps Ethernet with on-board unmodulated IRIG-B input
Two of the variants provide an IRIG-B interface. IRIG-B provides a timing reference for the unit – one board for
modulated IRIG-B and one for demodulated. The IRIG B signal is connected to the board with a BNC connector.
The Ethernet and other connection details are described below:
IRIG-B Connector
● Centre connection: Signal
● Outer connection: Earth
LEDs
LED Function On Off Flashing
Green Link Link ok Link broken
Yellow Activity Traffic
RJ45connector
Pin Signal name Signal definition
1 TXP Transmit (positive)
2 TXN Transmit (negative)
3 RXP Receive (positive)
4 - Not used
5 - Not used
6 RXN Receive (negative)
7 - Not used
8 - Not used
50 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design
IRIG-B
Link Fail
Pin3 connector
Pin 2
Pin 1
Link channel Link channel B
A (green LED) (green LED)
Activity channel Activity channel B
A (yellow LED) (yellow LED)
A
C
V01009
This board provides dual redundant Ethernet (supported by two fibre pairs) together with an IRIG-B interface for
timing.
Different board variants are available, depending on the redundancy protocol and the type of IRIG-B signal
(unmodulated or modulated). The available redundancy protocols are:
● SHP (Self healing Protocol)
● RSTP (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol)
● DHP (Dual Homing Protocol)
● PRP (Parallel Redundancy Protocol)
IRIG-B Connector
● Centre connection: Signal
● Outer connection: Earth
P446SV-TM-EN-1 51
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV
LEDs
LED Function On Off Flashing
Green Link Link ok Link broken
Yellow Activity SHP running PRP, RSTP or DHP traffic
RJ45connector
Pin Signal name Signal definition
1 TXP Transmit (positive)
2 TXN Transmit (negative)
3 RXP Receive (positive)
4 - Not used
5 - Not used
6 RXN Receive (negative)
7 - Not used
8 - Not used
52 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design
Note:
The above figure shows a coprocessor complete with GPS input and 2 fibre-optic serial data interfaces, and is not necessarily
representative of the product and model described in this manual. These interfaces will not be present on boards that do not
require them.
Where applicable, a second processor board is used to process the special algorithms associated with the device.
This second processor board provides fast access (zero wait state) SRAM for use with both program and data
memory storage. This memory can be accessed by the main processor board via the parallel bus. This is how the
software is transferred from the flash memory on the main processor board to the coprocessor board on power
up. Further communication between the two processor boards is achieved via interrupts and the shared SRAM.
The serial bus carrying the sample data is also connected to the co-processor board, using the processor’s built-in
serial port, as on the main processor board.
There are several different variants of this board, which can be chosen depending on the exact device and model.
The variants are:
● Coprocessor board with current differential inputs and GPS input
● Coprocessor board with current differential inputs only
● Coprocessor board with GPS input only
P446SV-TM-EN-1 53
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV
Note:
The 1 pps signal is always supplied by a GPS receiver (such as a P594).
Note:
This signal is used to control the sampling process, and timing calculations and is not used for time stamping or real time
synchronisation.
A High Break output relay board is available as an option. It comprises four normally open output contacts, which
are suitable for high breaking loads.
A High Break contact consists of a high capacity relay with a MOSFET in parallel with it. The MOSFET has a varistor
placed across it to provide protection, which is required when switching off inductive loads. This is because the
stored energy in the inductor causes a high reverse voltage that could damage the MOSFET, if not protected.
When there is a control input command to operate an output contact the miniature relay is operated at the same
time as the MOSFET. The miniature relay contact closes in nominally 3.5 ms and is used to carry the continuous
load current. The MOSFET operates in less than 0.2 ms, but is switched off after 7.5 ms.
When the control input is reset, the MOSFET is again turned on for 7.5 mS. The miniature relay resets in nominally
3.5 ms before the MOSFET. This means the MOSFET is used to break the load. The MOSFET absorbs the energy
when breaking inductive loads and so limits the resulting voltage surge. This contact arrangement is for switching
DC circuits only.
The board number is:
● ZN0042 001
54 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 3 - Hardware Design
Databus on off
control input
MOSFET reset
Relay contact
Closed
Load current
V00246
Warning:
These relay contacts are POLARITY SENSITIVE. External wiring must comply with the polarity
requirements described in the external connection diagram to ensure correct operation.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 55
Chapter 3 - Hardware Design P446SV
56 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 4
SOFTWARE DESIGN
Chapter 4 - Software Design P446SV
58 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 4 - Software Design
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter describes the software design of the IED.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 59
Sofware Design Overview 60
System Level Software 61
Platform Software 64
Protection and Control Functions 65
P446SV-TM-EN-1 59
Chapter 4 - Software Design P446SV
These elements are not distinguishable to the user, and the distinction is made purely for the purposes of
explanation. The following figure shows the software architecture.
Supervisor task
Records
and control
Protection
settings
Platform Software Layer
Event, fault,
Remote
disturbance,
Settings database communications
maintenance record
Sampling function interfaces
logging
V00307
The software, which executes on the main processor, can be divided into a number of functions as illustrated
above. Each function is further broken down into a number of separate tasks. These tasks are then run according
to a scheduler. They are run at either a fixed rate or they are event driven. The tasks communicate with each other
as and when required.
60 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 4 - Software Design
P446SV-TM-EN-1 61
Chapter 4 - Software Design P446SV
At the conclusion of the initialization software the supervisor task begins the process of starting the platform
software. Coprocessor board checks are also made as follows:
● A check is made for the presence of the coprocessor board
● The RAM on the coprocessor board is checked with a test bit pattern before the coprocessor board is
transferred from flash memory
If any of these checks produces an error, the coprocessor board is left out of service. The other protection
functions provided by the main processor board are left in service.
At the successful conclusion of all of these tests the unit is entered into service and the application software is
started up.
62 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 4 - Software Design
If the problem is with the battery status or the IRIG-B board, the device continues in operation. For problems
detected in any other area, the device initiates a shutdown and re-boot, resulting in a period of up to 10 seconds
when the functionality is unavailable.
A restart should clear most problems that may occur. If, however, the diagnostic self-check detects the same
problem that caused the IED to restart, it is clear that the restart has not cleared the problem, and the device takes
itself permanently out of service. This is indicated by the ‘’health-state’ LED on the front of the device, which
switches OFF, and the watchdog contact which switches ON.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 63
Chapter 4 - Software Design P446SV
4 PLATFORM SOFTWARE
The platform software has three main functions:
● To control the logging of records generated by the protection software, including alarms, events, faults, and
maintenance records
● To store and maintain a database of all of the settings in non-volatile memory
● To provide the internal interface between the settings database and the user interfaces, using the front
panel interface and the front and rear communication ports
The logs are maintained such that the oldest record is overwritten with the newest record. The logging function
can be initiated from the protection software. The platform software is responsible for logging a maintenance
record in the event of an IED failure. This includes errors that have been detected by the platform software itself or
errors that are detected by either the system services or the protection software function. See the Monitoring and
Control chapter for further details on record logging.
4.3 INTERFACES
The settings and measurements database must be accessible from all of the interfaces to allow read and modify
operations. The platform software presents the data in the appropriate format for each of the interfaces (LCD
display, keypad and all the communications interfaces).
64 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 4 - Software Design
P446SV-TM-EN-1 65
Chapter 4 - Software Design P446SV
capacitor voltage transformer (CVT) transients in the voltages. The device uses a combination of a 1/4 cycle filter
using 12 coefficients, a 1/2 cycle filter using 24 coefficients, and a single cycle filter using 48 coefficients. The
device automatically performs intelligent switching in the application of the filters, to select the best balance of
removal of transients with fast response. The protection elements themselves then perform additional filtering,
implemented for example, by the trip count strategy.
The following figure shows the frequency response of the 12, 24 and 48 coefficient filters, noting that all have a
gain of unity at the fundamental frequency:
Filter Response
2.5
2
Full
1.5
Gain Half
1
Quarter
0.5
0
0 3 6 9 12 15 18 21
Harmonic
E00308
66 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 4 - Software Design
1
Ideal anti-alias filter response
0.8
Fourier Response
0.6 Real anti-alias filter without anti-alias filter
response
0.4
Fourier Response
0.2 with anti-alias filter
P446SV-TM-EN-1 67
Chapter 4 - Software Design P446SV
68 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 5
CONFIGURATION
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV
70 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
Each product has different configuration parameters according to the functions it has been designed to perform.
There is, however, a common methodology used across the entire product series to set these parameters.
Some of the communications setup can only be carried out using the HMI, and cannot be carried out using
settings applications software. This chapter includes concise instructions of how to configure the device,
particularly with respect to the communications setup, as well as a description of the common methodology used
to configure the device in general.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 71
Settings Application Software 72
Using the HMI Panel 73
Line Parameters 84
Date and Time Configuration 88
Settings Group Selection 91
P446SV-TM-EN-1 71
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV
72 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration
The keypad provides full access to the device functionality using a range of menu options. The information is
displayed on the LCD.
Keys Description Function
Function keys (not all models) For executing user programmable functions
P446SV-TM-EN-1 73
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV
Note:
As the LCD display has a resolution of 16 characters by 3 lines, some of the information is in a condensed mnemonic form.
Alarm message
V00400
If there are alarms present, the yellow Alarms LED will be flashing and the menu display will read as follows:
74 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration
Alarms / Faults
Present
HOTKEY
Even though the device itself should be in full working order when you first start it, an alarm could still be present,
for example, if there is no network connection for a device fitted with a network card. If this is the case, you can
read the alarm by pressing the 'Read' key.
ALARMS
NIC Link Fail
If the device is fitted with an Ethernet card, you will first need to connect the device to an active Ethernet network
to clear the alarm and get the default display.
If there are other alarms present, these must also be cleared before you can get into the default display menu
options.
11:09:15
23 Nov 2011
HOTKEY
Description (user-defined)
For example:
Description
MiCOM P14NB
HOTKEY
P446SV-TM-EN-1 75
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV
Plant Reference
MiCOM
HOTKEY
Access Level
For example:
Access Level
3
HOTKEY
In addition to the above, there are also displays for the system voltages, currents, power and frequency etc.,
depending on the device model.
NERC compliant
banner
System Current
Access Level
Measurements
System Voltage
System Frequency
Measurements
System Power
Plant Reference
Measurements
V00403
If the device is cyber-secure but is not yet configured for NERC compliance (see Cyber-security chapter), a warning
will appear when moving from the "NERC compliant" banner. The warning message is as follows:
76 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration
You will have to confirm with the Enter button before you can go any further.
Note:
Whenever the IED has an uncleared alarm the default display is replaced by the text Alarms/ Faults present. You cannot
override this default display. However, you can enter the menu structure from the default display, even if the display shows
the Alarms/Faults present message.
Enter Password
1. A flashing cursor shows which character field of the password can be changed. Press the up or down cursor
keys to change each character (tip: pressing the up arrow once will return an upper case "A" as required by
the default level 3 password).
2. Use the left and right cursor keys to move between the character fields of the password.
3. Press the Enter key to confirm the password. If you enter an incorrect password, an invalid password
message is displayed then the display reverts to Enter password. On entering a valid password a message
appears indicating that the password is correct and which level of access has been unlocked. If this level is
sufficient to edit the selected setting, the display returns to the setting page to allow the edit to continue. If
the correct level of password has not been entered, the password prompt page appears again.
4. To escape from this prompt press the Clear key. Alternatively, enter the password using the Password
setting in the SYSTEM DATA column. If the keypad is inactive for 15 minutes, the password protection of the
front panel user interface reverts to the default access level.
To manually reset the password protection to the default level, select Password, then press the CLEAR key instead
of entering a password.
Note:
In the SECURITY CONFIG column, you can set the maximum number of attemps, the time window in which the failed attempts
are counted and the time duration for which the user is blocked.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 77
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV
Press Clear To
Reset Alarms
3. To clear all alarm messages, press the Clear key. To return to the display showing alarms or faults present,
and leave the alarms uncleared, press the Read key.
4. Depending on the password configuration settings, you may need to enter a password before the alarm
messages can be cleared.
5. When all alarms are cleared, the yellow alarm LED switches off. If the red LED was on, this will also be
switched off.
Note:
To speed up the procedure, you can enter the alarm viewer using the Read key and subsequently pressing the Clear key. This
goes straight to the fault record display. Press the Clear key again to move straight to the alarm reset prompt, then press the
Clear key again to clear all alarms.
Note:
Sometimes the term "Setting" is used generically to describe all of the three types.
78 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration
It is convenient to specify all the settings in a single column, detailing the complete Courier address for each
setting. The above table may therefore be represented as follows:
Setting Column Row Description
SYSTEM DATA 00 00 First Column definition
Language (Row 01) 00 01 First setting within first column
Password (Row 02) 00 02 Second setting within first column
Sys Fn Links (Row 03) 00 03 Third setting within first column
… … …
VIEW RECORDS 01 00 Second Column definition
Select Event [0...n] 01 01 First setting within second column
Menu Cell Ref 01 02 Second setting within second column
Time & Date 01 03 Third setting within second column
… … …
MEASUREMENTS 1 02 00 Third Column definition
IA Magnitude 02 01 First setting within third column
IA Phase Angle 02 02 Second setting within third column
IB Magnitude 02 03 Third setting within third column
… … …
The first three column headers are common throughout much of the product ranges. However the rows within
each of these column headers may differ according to the product type. Many of the column headers are the
same for all products within the series. However, there is no guarantee that the addresses will be the same for a
particular column header. Therefore you should always refer to the product settings documentation and not make
any assumptions.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 79
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV
8. Press the Enter key to confirm the new setting value or the Clear key to discard it. The new setting is
automatically discarded if it is not confirmed within 15 seconds.
9. For protection group settings and disturbance recorder settings, the changes must be confirmed before
they are used. When all required changes have been entered, return to the column heading level and press
the Down cursor key. Before returning to the default display, the following prompt appears.
Update settings?
ENTER or CLEAR
10. Press the Enter key to accept the new settings or press the Clear key to discard the new settings.
Note:
For the protection group and disturbance recorder settings, if the menu time-out occurs before the changes have been
confirmed, the setting values are discarded. Control and support settings, howeverr, are updated immediately after they are
entered, without the Update settings? prompt.
The availability of these functions is controlled by the Direct Access cell in the CONFIGURATION column. There are
four options: Disabled, Enabled, CB Ctrl only and Hotkey only.
For the Setting Group selection and Control inputs, this cell must be set to either Enabled or Hotkey only. For
CB Control functions, the cell must be set to Enabled or CB Ctrl only.
Use the right cursor keys to enter the SETTING GROUP menu.
¬Menu User01®
SETTING GROUP 1
Nxt Grp Select
80 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration
Select the setting group with Nxt Grp and confirm by pressing Select. If neither of the cursor keys is pressed within
20 seconds of entering a hotkey sub menu, the device reverts to the default display.
Press the right cursor key twice to get to the first control input, or the left cursor key to get to the last control input.
¬STP GP User02®
Control Input 1
EXIT SET
Now you can execute the chosen function (Set/Reset in this case).
If neither of the cursor keys is pressed within 20 seconds of entering a hotkey sub menu, the device reverts to the
default display.
Plant Reference
MiCOM
HOTKEY CLOSE
To close the circuit breaker (in this case), press the key directly below CLOSE. You will be given an option to cancel
or confirm.
Execute
CB CLOSE
Cancel Confirm
More detailed information on this can be found in the Monitoring and Control chapter.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 81
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV
FUNCTION KEYS
Fn Key Status
0000000000
The next cell down (Fn Key 1) allows you to activate or disable the first function key (1). The Lock setting allows a
function key to be locked. This allows function keys that are set to Toggled mode and their DDB signal active
‘high’, to be locked in their active state, preventing any further key presses from deactivating the associated
function. Locking a function key that is set to the Normal mode causes the associated DDB signals to be
permanently off. This safety feature prevents any inadvertent function key presses from activating or deactivating
critical functions.
FUNCTION KEYS
Fn Key 1
Unlocked
The next cell down (Fn Key 1 Mode) allows you to set the function key to Normal or Toggled. In the Toggle mode
the function key DDB signal output stays in the set state until a reset command is given, by activating the function
key on the next key press. In the Normal mode, the function key DDB signal stays energised for as long as the
function key is pressed then resets automatically. If required, a minimum pulse width can be programmed by
adding a minimum pulse timer to the function key DDB output signal.
FUNCTION KEYS
Fn Key 1 Mode
Toggled
The next cell down (Fn Key 1 Label) allows you to change the label assigned to the function. The default label is
Function key 1 in this case. To change the label you need to press the enter key and then change the text on
the bottom line, character by character. This text is displayed when a function key is accessed in the function key
menu, or it can be displayed in the PSL.
FUNCTION KEYS
Fn Key 1 Label
Function Key 1
Subsequent cells allow you to carry out the same procedure as above for the other function keys.
The status of the function keys is stored in non-volatile memory. If the auxiliary supply is interrupted, the status of
all the function keys is restored. The IED only recognises a single function key press at a time and a minimum key
82 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration
press duration of approximately 200 ms is required before the key press is recognised. This feature avoids
accidental double presses.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 83
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV
4 LINE PARAMETERS
This product requires information about the circuit to which it is applied. This includes line impedance, residual
compensation, and phase rotation sequence. For this reason circuit parameter information must be input using
the LINE PARAMETERS settings. These LINE PARAMETERS settings are used by protection elements as well as by the
fault locator.
84 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration
530
Trip Inputs A
1 S
1601
Q CB2 Trip OutputA
R
531
Trip Inputs B
1 S
1602
Q CB2 Trip OutputB
R
532
Trip Inputs C
1 S
1603
Q CB2 Trip OutputC
R
CB2Tripping Mode 1
&
3 Pole 1 S
1600
Q CB2 Trip 3ph
1485 R
AR Force CB2 3P 1
Force 3PTrip CB2 1604
1608
CB2 Trip I/P 3Ph
Dwell
522
1 Any Trip
530 100 ms
Trip Inputs A
531
Trip Inputs B
≥ S
Trip Inputs C 532 2 Q 527
2/3 Ph Fault
R
892
Pole Dead A &
1 S
528
Q 3 Ph Fault
R
893
& 1
Pole Dead B 1
&
894 1
Pole Dead C
&
V03387
Figure 30: Circuit Breaker Trip Conversion Logic Diagram (Module 63)
VA
ZF1 =
I A + k ZN ⋅ I N
where:
● VA is the phase A voltage
● IA is the phase A current
● IN is the residual current, derived from the phase currents by the equation:
P446SV-TM-EN-1 85
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV
I N = I A + I B + IC
Z L 0 − Z L1
k ZN =
3Z L1
where:
● ZL0 is the total zero sequence impedance of the line (a complex value)
● ZL1 is the total positive sequence impedance of the protected line (a complex value)
The complex residual compensation coefficient is defined by two settings: kZN Res Comp (the absolute value) and
kZN Res Angle (the angle in degrees).
Caution:
The kZN Res Angle is different to that in LFZP, SHNB, and LFZR products: If importing
settings from these products, you must subtract angle ÐZL1
VA
Z F1 =
I A + kZN ⋅ I N + k Zm ⋅ I M
where:
● VA is the phase A voltage
● IA is the phase A current
● IN is the residual current of the protected line (derived from phase currents)
● IM is the residual current of the parallel line (measured)
● kZN is the residual compensation coefficient
● kZm is the mutual compensation coefficient
I N = I A + I B + IC
Z L 0 − Z L1
k ZN =
3Z L1
Zm0
k Zm =
3Z L1
86 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration
where:
● ZL0 is the total zero sequence impedance of the line (a complex value)
● ZL1 is the total positive sequence impedance of the protected line (complex value)
● Zm0 is the zero sequence mutual impedance between the two circuits (complex value).
If used, you must set the mutual compensation feature kZm using the settings:
● kZm Mutual Set (the absolute value) and
● kZm Mutual Angle (the angle in degrees).
Note:
The following paragraph applies only to distance products and so may not be applicable to your model
In applications where the Mutual Compensation is used to reduce errors in the distance elements, a third setting,
Mutual Cut Off, is used for a fast dynamic control. The ratio IM/IN is compared with the Mutual Cut Off setting. If
the ratio is higher, mutual compensation is suppressed to prevent false-tripping for faults on the parallel line.
Typically a Mutual Cut Off factor of 1.5 is chosen to give a good margin of safety between the requirements of
correct mutual compensation for faults on the protected circuit whilst avoiding maloperations for faults on the
parallel circuit.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 87
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV
88 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration
3. Ensure that the IED is receiving valid time synchronisation messages by checking that the PTP Status cell
reads Valid Master.
4. Check that Act. Time Source cell reads PTP. This indicates that the IED is using PTP as the source for its
time. Note that If IRIG-B or SNTP have been selected as the Primary Source, these must first be
disconnected before the device can switch to PTP as the active source.
5. Once the IED is using PTP as the active time source, adjust the time offset of the universal coordinated time
on the Master Clock equipment, so that local time is displayed.
6. Check that the time, date and month are correct in the Date/Time cell.
The LocalTime Offset setting allows you to enter the local time zone compensation from -12 to + 12 hours at 15
minute intervals.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 89
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV
These settings are described in the DATE AND TIME settings table in the configuration chapter.
90 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 5 - Configuration
Each setting group has its own PSL. Once a PSL configuration has been designed it can be allocated to any one of
the 4 setting groups. When downloading or extracting a PSL configuration, you will be prompted to enter the
required setting group to which it will allocated.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 91
Chapter 5 - Configuration P446SV
92 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 6
94 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 95
Introduction To Sampled Values 96
Data Resampling 97
Sampled Value Alignment 98
P446SV-TM-EN-1 95
Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation P446SV
Conventional IED
IA Fast
Direct
IB protection
CT Inputs comparison
IC algorithms
IN A/D Sampled
Scaling Values
VA Conversion
VB Standard
VT Inputs Filtering and
VC protection
Processing
VN algorithms
SV IED
IA
IB
IC
IN Analog Sampled Values IEC 61850
Merging Unit (in IEC61850 Ethernet frames) SV Processing
VA
Interface
VB
VC
VN
96 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation
3 DATA RESAMPLING
An IEC 61850-9-2LE SV interface receives 80 Sampled Values per cycle from the Process Bus. This is the same for
both 50 and 60 Hz. The SV interface then resamples these Sampled Values to make the data appear the same to
the IED as analogue signals would do on its normal inputs from CTs and VTs. The resampling frequency depends
on the device.
The IEC 61850-9-2LE interface also tracks the supply frequency. This is because the Sampled Values from the
Process Bus are fixed at 4000 samples/sec for 50 Hz and 4800 samples/sec at 60 Hz.
SV IED
IA
IB
IC
Analog Sampled Values IEC 61850
IN Resampling
Merging Unit (80 samples per cycle) SV CPU
VA
Interface
VB
VC
VN
Process Bus
V03701
P446SV-TM-EN-1 97
Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation P446SV
4.1 CHANNEL MAPPINGS FOR SAV TEST, SAV QUESTIONABLE, SAV INVALID
These signals correspond to the analogue channels in a conventional MiCOM IED. The channel name appears on
the IED display against each bit.
98 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation
The protection function will be trusted and NOT inhibited for questionable data for the items above which have
been set.
The protection function returns to the Normal state when the quality flags for all the necessary Sampled Value
inputs are Good. The quality flags can change with each sample, therefore there is a one-cycle transition delay
between the Normal and Inhibit states for each protection function.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 99
Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation P446SV
4.4 VT SWITCHING
This function is used in the P442, P444, P446, P546 and P841B IEDs which have an IEC 61850-9-2LE interface. It
allows the user to switch the three-phase voltage input between two independent Sampled Value frames while the
IED is in service. This may correspond to two separate voltage transformers in the primary system. The VT Switch
function also allows the single-phase check synchronising voltages to be selected from three independent
Sampled Value frames.
The VT switching function is disabled by default. To enabled it, in the IED menu IEC 61850-9-2LE, select VT Switch
Mode then Enabled.
100 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation
DDB DDB
Vsc1 Select x1 Vsc1 Select 1x Vsc1 Selection
0 1 Vcs2
1 0 Vcs3
1 1 Unused
The selection of voltage Vsc2 is controlled by the combined status of two DDBs, Vsc2 Select x1 and Vsc2 Select 1x
as shown in the following table.
DDB DDB
Vsc2 Select x1 Vsc2 Select 1x Vsc2 Selection
0 0 Vcs2
0 1 Vcs3
1 0 Vcs1
1 1 Unused
The selected single-phase voltages are only displayed when VT Switch Mode is enabled.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 101
Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation P446SV
102 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation
P446SV-TM-EN-1 103
Chapter 6 - Sampled Value Operation P446SV
104 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 7
DISTANCE PROTECTION
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
106 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter introduces the principles and theory behind the protection and describes how it is implemented in this
product. Guidance for applying this protection is also provided.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 107
Introduction 108
Distance Measuring Zones Operating Principles 110
Phase and Earth Fault Distance Protection Implementation 139
Delta Directional Element 147
Application Notes 150
P446SV-TM-EN-1 107
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
2 INTRODUCTION
Amongst protection engineers, the basic principles of Distance Protection are widely documented and understood.
If you are reading this chapter, we assume that you are familiar with the principles of distance protection and
associated components such as Aided Schemes. However, to help you choose suitable settings, some of the
principles of operation of the Distance Measuring Zones is included in this chapter.
R
Source Line
VS IR VL=VR
ZL
V VR
V02753
The voltage V applied to the impedance loop is the open circuit voltage of the power system. Point R represents the
protection location; IR and VR are the current and voltage measured by the relay, respectively.
The impedances Zs and ZL are described as source and line impedances because of their position with respect to
the protection location. Source impedance Zs is a measure of the fault level at the relaying point. For faults
involving earth it is dependent on the method of system earthing behind the relaying point. Line impedance ZL is a
measure of the impedance of the protected section. The voltage VR applied to the relay is, therefore, IRZL. For a
fault at the reach point, this may be expressed in terms of the System Impedeance Ratio, using the following
expression:
VR = V/(SIR+1)
where SIR = ZS/ZL
108 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
From the equation above, it can be seen that the measured voltage has a significant impact on the decision
making process.
The ability of distance protection to measure accurately for a given reach point fault, depends on the voltage at
the relaying location being above a minimum value at the time of the fault. If the voltage is above this minimum
value, it is generally used to polarize the distance protection and indicate the direction of the fault. This is called
self-polarization.
If the voltage collapses below the minimum threshold necessary to make a sensible decision, alternative methods
of polarization to determine the direction of the fault are needed. Two methods that are applied are cross-
polarization and memory polarization. If a fault doesn’t affect all phases, the voltage signals on the healthy phases
can be used for the directional decision. This is called cross-polarization. If the fault causes all phase voltages to
collapse, a stored record of the pre-fault voltage can be used to make the directional decision. This is called
memory polarization. Memory polarization, cross-polarization, and self-polarization can sometimes be used in
combination.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 109
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
110 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
Note:
The faulted phase current (I) is generally used as the reference (0º) for the vector diagrams.
V IZ
IZ
V 90°
V02710
Figure 34: Directional mho element construction
P446SV-TM-EN-1 111
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
V IZ
IZ
90°
V
V I Z
I
I Z
V02711
112 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
jX Z k ZN I N I ph
jX
V ph I ph Z replica
V IZ
Z Z
Z replica
90°
90°
R R
V I V ph I ph
V02712
Zreplica = Z(1+kZN.IN/Iph)
or if mutual compensation is applied:
Z(1+kZN.IN/Iph+kZM.IM/Iph)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 113
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
Then if healthy phase currents are much less then the current of the faulty phase and the mutual compensation is
disabled:
IN @ Iph
so that
Zreplica @ Z(1 + kZN)
Thus the ZLP plane representation of the characteristic becomes static.
jX Z1 -plane
V IZ
Z
90°
V I
V I Z
R
Z
V02713
Figure 37: Offset Mho characteristics – impedance domain
114 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
Z LP -plane
jX Z k ZN I N I ph
V ph I ph Z replica
Z Z replica
90°
h
h / Ip
Vp
Z replica R
Z
V ph I ph Z replica
Z k ZN I N I ph
V02714
Figure 38: Offset mho characteristics – voltage domain
where: Zreplica is the replica forward reach and Z'replica is the replica reverse reach.
With mutual compensation applied:
Zreplica = Z(1+kZN.IN/Iph + kZM.IM/Iph)
Z'replica = Z'(1+kZN.IN/Iph + kZM.IM/Iph)
If the healthy phase currents are much less than the current of the faulty phase, then the neutral current is
approximately the same as the phase current, and the terms can be simplified as follows:
Zreplica = Z(1+kZN + kZM.IM/Iph)
Z'replica = Z'(1+kZN + kZM.IM/Iph)
If the healthy phase currents are much less than the current of the faulty phase, and mutual current compensation
is not applied, then these terms can be simplified as follows:
Zreplica @ Z(1+kZN)
Z'replica @ Z'(1+kZN)
So, as with the Directional Self-Polarized Mho characteristic for earth-faults, the ZLP plane representation of the
characteristic becomes static.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 115
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
Operation occurs when the angle between the signals is greater than 90°.
The memory voltage Vmem is the pre-fault voltage. Assuming the pre-fault current is close to zero at the relaying
point, he pre-fault voltage is equal to the source voltage. Therefore:
Vmem = VS
IED
Dist
VS Bus I
Line
ZS ZF
V
V02715
Figure 39: Simplified forward fault
p
90° ≤ ∠ V I + ⋅ Z S − ∠ ( V I − Z ) ≤ −90°
1+ p
The Mho expansion for a forward fault is illustrated in the following diagram:
116 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
jX
Self-polarised
V IZ
Z
V I 90°
R
p
ZS
1 p p
V I ZS
1 p
V02716
Figure 40: Mho expansion – forward fault
ZS = (Vmem - V)/I
P446SV-TM-EN-1 117
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
IED
Dist
Bus VS
I
Network
ZF ZL ZS
V
V02717
p
90° ≤ ∠ V I − ⋅ ( Z S + Z L ) − ∠ ( V I − Z ) ≤ −90°
1+ p
The Mho contraction for a reverse fault is illustrated in the following diagram:
118 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
p
V I (ZS ZL )
1 p
jX
90°
V IZ
p
(Z S Z L )
1 p
V I
R
Self-polarised
V02718
Figure 42: Mho contraction – reverse fault
ZS + ZL = (V - Vmem)/I
P446SV-TM-EN-1 119
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
The cross-polarization voltage is generated using phase(s) not otherwise used for the particular distance or
directional measurement. While one pole is dead, and the memory is not available, the elements associated with
the remaining phases are polarized as shown in the following table:
Cross Polarizing Signal Cross Polarizing Signal Cross Polarizing Signal
Loop
(No poles dead) Lagging Pole Dead Leading Pole Dead
A-N 0.5(aVB + a2VC) αVB α2VC
B-N 0.5(aVC + a2VA) αVC α2VA
C-N 0.5(aVA + a2VB) αVA α2VB
A-B √3VC Ð -90º 0 0
B-C √3VA Ð -90º 0 0
C-A √3VB Ð -90º 0 0
where a is a mathematical operator which rotates a vector through 120° and a2 denotes a rotation of 240°.
The table shows polarizing signal contributions for each loop under the different operating conditions. The
proportion of cross-polarization voltage used is defined by the Dist. Polarizing (p) setting.
Note:
Cross polarization is used only when there is no memory polarization quantity available.
Note:
If no memory voltage is available then the cross-polarized quantity is used instead.
The setting Dist. Polarizing (p) defines the amount of memory polarization (or if need be, cross polarization
voltage), which should be added with respect to the existing self-polarizing voltage so that:
S1 = V + pVmem.
The value "p" can be set from 0.2 (20%) to 5 (500%).
This will have an affect on the characteristic where operation occurs when the fault impedance lies inside a circle
whose diameter is set by the points IZ and p/(1+p)IZsource
This means for example:
● If p = 1, the characteristic will have an expansion of 50% IZsource
● If p = 5, the characteristic will have an expansion of 83.3% IZsource
120 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
4. If the fault is cleared before the voltage memory signal expires, the memory algorithm resets and restarts
the two/four cycle validation process.
5. If there is no voltage memory available (either because the line has just been energised, or because the
memory voltage has expired), cross polarization is used instead. The contribution of cross polarizing signals
is only used when memory polarizing is invalid and is only valid for certain pole dead conditions.
6. If neither memory polarization voltage nor cross-polarization voltage is available (pole dead condition for
phase-to-phase element), then the phase-to-phase elements are self polarized. If the polarizing voltage is
less than 1V, only zone 1 is allowed to operate. In this case a Mho characteristic with a reverse offset of 25%
is applied. This ensures operation when closing on to a close-up three-phase fault (SOTF/ TOR condition).
One of the additional benefits of adding memory into the polarizing mix is that Mho characteristics offer dynamic
expansion if there is a forward fault, therefore covering greater fault arc resistance
jX
Zone 3
(offset)
Zone 2
(forward)
Directional line
Zone 1
-R θ +R
Reverse direction
-jX V02700
A programmable zone (zone P) is also available. Similar to Zone 3, the programmable zone can be configured as
Offset, Directional Forward, or Directional Reverse.
A combination of simple comparators, each using signals derived from measured currents and voltages,
determines whether measured impedance is within a tripping zone. A separate comparator is used for each line of
each Quadrilateral.
Each tripping zone is constructed from a Quadrilateral based on that depicted in the following diagram:
P446SV-TM-EN-1 121
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
Reverse Resistive
Reach line Tripping
Region
Resistive
Reach line
R’ θ R +R
Z’
In the figure, an Offset Quadrilateral characteristic is defined by its Impedance Reach, Z, (and Reverse Impedance
Reach, Z’), its Resistive Reach, R, (and Reverse Resistive Reach, R’), and the zone angle (θ).
The two near-horizontal lines (Impedance Reach Line and Reverse Impedance Reach Line) set the reactive
impedance limits of the tripping zone. The two near-vertical lines (Resistive Reach Line and Reverse Resistive
Reach Line) set the resistive impedance limits.
The Resistive Reach Lines (also called Resistive Blinders) are parallel and set at the angle of the zone’s
characteristic impedance.
The Impedance Reach Lines exhibit a characteristic tilt (slope). A line that tilts to reduce the reactive reach
(negative tilt/tilt down) encourages underreaching; A line that tilts to increase the reactive reach (positive tilt/tilt up)
encourages overreaching. The tilt can be used to reinforce the overreaching/underreaching requirements of the
zone. For example, for an underreaching Forward zone, a negative tilt will ensure that the measurement continues
to underreach, even with increasing fault resistance.
The Impedance Reach, Z, and the Resistive Reach, R, apply in the context of the direction of the protection. For a
Forward Zone, or an Offset Zone, Z and R look into the protected plant. For a Reverse Zone, Z and R look behind the
protected plant. Reactive Line tilts follow the same convention.
122 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
jX Z
Tripping
Region
Directional Line
R’ θ R +R
Z’ Forward direction
60°
-jX
This product has a Delta Directional element that is normally used to directionalise the Distance protection.
By default, the Delta Directional element is enabled (Dir. Status in DELTADIRECTIONAL set to Enabled). In this
case, the Directional Line for the Quadrilateral is derived using superimposed fault-current (Delta I). When using the
Delta Directional element, the Directional Line angle has a default value of 60º, but you can change it with the Dir.
Char Angle setting.
If you want to use a conventional directional technique, then you can do this by disabling the Delta Directional
element. The protection will then use a conventional directional element with a fixed angle of 60º.
The following figure illustrates two Offset zones that have been converted into Directional Forward zones by the
overlay of a Directional Line. An Offset zone is also shown for reference.
jX
Offset zone
Directional zone
Directional zone
Directional Line
-R +R
Forward direction
-jX
Figure 46: Quadrilateral Characteristic featuring 2 directional forward zones and 1 offset zone
P446SV-TM-EN-1 123
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
Each of the lines produced by the comparators defines a tripping limit: Impedance on one side of the line prevents
tripping whereas impedance on the other side of the line may, if the other comparators agree, allow tripping. For
example, impedance beyond the Impedance Reach Line will not allow tripping.
The combination of the comparator outputs produces a polygon shaped tripping region. The polygon may be
either 4-sided or 5-sided. The shape depends according to the settings that are applied by the five comparators
and how the Directional Line interacts with the reach lines (usually the Reverse Impedance Reach Line):
● The Directional Line may completely mask a reach line. If that is the case, the polygon will be 4-sided
(quadrilateral).
● If the Directional Line intersects a reach line, the polygon will be 5-sided.
jX
Directional Line
-R R
Forward direction
-jX
Figure 47: Five-sided polygon formed by Quadrilateral characteristic with Directional-Line intersection of
Reverse Impedance Reach Line
The applied settings will determine the intersection point. When the settings have been chosen, the following
values will affect the line intersection point:
● Impedance Reach
● Reverse Impedance Reach
● Resistive Reach
124 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
The Impedance Reach, the Resistive Reach, and the Zone Characteristic Impedance Angle, can be freely assigned.
The Directional Line Angle is 60º by default but can be varied if the Delta Directional element is enabled. The Tilt
Angle of the impedance lines has a default setting of -3º, but some variation is allowed if the Advanced setting
option is chosen.
The Reverse Impedance Reach, and the Reverse Resistive Reach are applied as a fixed ratio of the Impedance
Reach and the Resistive Reach for Directional characteristics. The ratios used vary according to the zone type. The
following tables present the different values for phase-phase characteristics and phase-earth characteristics. For
completion, the reach limit values for Offset zones are also included (although the overlaid Directional line does not
apply and the Offset characteristics will always be quadrilateral).
P446SV-TM-EN-1 125
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
Reverse Resistive
Zone Type Impedance Reach Z Reverse Impedance Reach Z’ Resistive Reach R
Reach R’
Q Ph-Earth Offset ZQ Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) ZQ’ Gnd Rev Rch * (1 + kZN) RQ Gnd Resistive RQ’ Gnd Res. Rev
where kZN = (Z0 - Z1) / 3Z1 and is defined by two settings: kZN Res Comp and KZN Res Angle.
Note:
Not all products feature all zones.
Note:
With default settings applied, Directional Zones 1, 2, and 4 should appear Quadrilateral.
+jX
V IZ
Z V I
+R
V02722
Referenced to the fault current I, the angle of tilt is equal to the setting σ. A negative angle sets a downward tilt
and a positive angle sets an upward tilt. Operation can occur when the operating signal lags the polarizing signal.
A negative angle sets a downward tilt and a positive angle sets an upward tilt.
For all V/I vectors below the Impedance Reach line, the following condition is true:
Ð (V/I - Z) £ σ
126 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
or
Ð (V - I.Z) £ Ð I.Ð σ
The resultant two signals provided to the comparator are:
S1 = V - I.Z
S2 = I.Ð σ
Impedance on the tripping side of the Impedance Reach line is detected when the angle between S1 and S2 is less
than 0°.
+jX
+R
+Z’ V/I
-3°
V / I - Z’
V02723
For an Offset zone, Z’ is the settable reverse reach. For a directional zone Z’ is a fixed percentage (either 25% or
100%) of the forward reach (Z) in the opposite direction.
The signals provided to the comparator are:
S1 = V - I.Z’
S2 = I.Ð -3°
Impedance on the tripping side of the Reverse Impedance Reach line is detected when the angle between S1 and
S2 is greater than 0°.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 127
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
IED
Dist V I Half of the loop
Bus
A
ZF
R LP
B
Network Line
V02725
The setting Rx Ph. Resistive defines the complete loop resistive reach RLP of the Distance Protection.
Since a phase-to-phase distance element measures half of the loop, the right-hand resistive reach R, of the
characteristic is equal to half of the setting value.
R = ½ Rx Ph. Resistive
+jX
V/I
V/I-R
R ÐZ +R
V02724
For all V/I vectors which are on the left side of the right blinder the following condition is true:
Ð (V/I - R) £ Z
or
Ð (V - I.R) £ Ð I. Z
The two signals provided to the comparator are:
S1 = V - I.R
S2 = I.Z
128 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
The impedance on the left side of the right hand resistive line is detected when the angle between S1 and S2 is
greater than 0°.
+jX
ÐZ
V/I
V / I - R’ +R
R’
V02726
For an offset zone, R’ is the settable reverse resistive reach (=½*Rx’ Ph Res. Rev.). . For a directional zone, R’ is fixed
at 25% of the Resistive Reach (=½*Rx Ph Res. Rev.), acting in the opposite direction.
The two signals provided to the comparator are:
S1 = V - I.R
S2 = I.Z
The impedance on the right side of the left hand resistive line is detected when the angle between S1 and S2 is less
than 0°.
+jX
V/I
R’ R +R
Z’
3°
V02727
P446SV-TM-EN-1 129
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
The comparators used for the Phase-Fault Quadrilateral zones are summarised in the following table:
Condition
Zone Line S1 S2
(∠S1 - ∠S2)
Forward/Offset Impedance Reach Line V – I.Z I.Ð σº <0º
Forward/Offset Reverse Impedance Reach Line V – I.Z’ I.Ð 3º >0º
Forward/Offset Resistive Reach Line V – I.R I.Z >0º
Forward/Offset Reverse Resistive Reach Line V – I.R’ I.Z <0º
Reverse Impedance Reach Line V + I.Z -I.Ð σº <0º
Reverse Reverse Impedance Reach Line V + I.Z’ -I.Ð 3º >0º
Reverse Resistive Reach Line V + I.R -I.Z >0º
Reverse Reverse Resistive Reach Line V + I.R’ -I.Z <0º
The positive sequence reach settings used for the Phase-Fault Quadrilateral characteristics are summarised in the
following table:
Reverse Impedance Reverse Resistive
Zone Type Impedance Reach Z Resistive Reach R
Reach Z’ Reach R’
1 Ph-Ph Forward Z1 Ph. Reach 0.25 Z ½*R1 Ph. Resistive 0.25 R
2 Ph-Ph Forward Z2 Ph. Reach 0.25 Z ½*R2 Ph. Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Ph Forward Z3 Ph. Reach 0.25 Z ½*R3 Ph. Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Ph Reverse Z3 Ph. Reach 0.25 Z ½*R3 Ph. Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Ph Offset Z3 Ph. Reach Z3’ Ph Rev Reach ½*R3 Ph. Resistive ½*R3’ Ph Res. Rev.
4 Ph-Ph Reverse Z4 Ph. Reach Z ½*R4 Ph. Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Ph Forward ZP Ph. Reach Z ½*RP Ph Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Ph Reverse ZP Ph. Reach Z ½*RP Ph Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Ph Offset ZQ Ph. Reach ZP’ Ph Rev Reach ½*RP Ph Resistive ½*RP’ Ph. Res. Rev.
Q Ph-Ph Forward ZQ Ph. Reach Z ½*RQ Ph Resistive 0.25 R
Q Ph-Ph Reverse ZQ Ph. Reach Z ½*RQ Ph Resistive 0.25 R
Q Ph-Ph Offset ZQ Ph. Reach ZQ’ Ph Rev Reach ½*RQ Ph Resistive ½*RQ’ Ph. Res. Rev.
Note:
Not all zones feature in all product variations.
130 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
P446SV-TM-EN-1 131
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
Z 1-plane
Iph j
+jX Ð e
I
V IZ
Z V I
+R
V02731
For all V/I vectors below the Impedance Reach line, the following condition is true:
Ð (V/I-Z) ≤ σ
or
Ð (V – I.Z) ≤ I + σ
If mutual compensation is not applied, for an earth-fault loop
V = Vph
and
I = Iph + kZN.IN
so the signals fed into comparator are:
S1 = Vph – Iph.Zreplica
S2 = Iph Ð σ
where: Zreplica is the replica forward reach
The impedance below the Impedance Reach line is detected when the angle between the signals is less than 0°:
For products that have mutual compensation, if the mutual compensation is applied, then
Zreplica =Z(1+kZN.IN/Iph+kZM.IM/Iph).
132 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
Z LP -plane
+jX Z k ZN I N I ph V ph I ph Z replica
Z replica
Z
V ph I ph
+R
V02732
The Impedance Reach line tilting angle in the ZLP plane is fixed at σ (Zx Tilt Top Line setting).
The Impedance Reach line tilting angle in the Z1 plane is defined as follows:
Tilt angle = Ð(Iph/I) + σ = Ð(Iph/(Iph + kZN.IN)) + σ
If the healthy phase currents are much less than the current of the faulty phase, then IN ≈ Iph. The tilting angle in
this case is fixed at the following value:
Tilt angle = Ð((1/(1 + kZN)) + σ
For products that have mutual compensation, if the mutual compensation is enabled, the tilting angle is:
Tilt angle = Ð(Iph/(Iph + kZN.IN+ kZM.IM)) + σ
The replica reach Zreplica depends on the ratio of IN/Iph. If IN ≈ Iph (and if mutual compensation is not applied)
then:
Zreplica =Z (1 + kZN)
So the characteristic is static.
The general characteristic in the ZLP plane is shown in the following figure:
P446SV-TM-EN-1 133
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
ZLP plane
+jX
Zreplica
Vph / Iph
R’ LP R LP
+R
3°
Z’ replica
V02733
The comparators used for the reactance lines are as per the following table:
Zone Line S1 S2 Condition
Forward or Offset Impedance Reach Vph - Iph.Zreplica Iph∠σ ∠S1 -∠S2 < 0º
Forward or Offset Reverse Impedance Reach Vph - Iph.Z’replica Iph∠-3º ∠S1 -∠S2 > 0º
Reverse Impedance Reach Vph + Iph.Zreplica -Iph∠σ ∠S1 -∠S2 < 0º
Reverse Reverse Impedance Reach Vph + Iph.Z’replica -Iph ∠-3º ∠S1 -∠S2 > 0º
134 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
● For Reverse operating zones the dynamically tilting line is in the opposite quadrant of the characteristic
compared with Forward/Offset Zones and the dynamic tilt moves the line away from the resistive axis.
● For Offset zones, the Impedance Reach lines tilt away from the R-axis, whilst the Reverse Impedance Reach
Lines tilt towards the +R axis. This avoids overreaching in the reverse direction.
● For products that feature single-phase tripping, when one circuit breaker pole is open during a single-pole
autoreclose sequence, dynamic tilting is automatically disabled. The fault current is used as the polarizing
signal and a fixed -7° tilt is applied. The additional tilt reduces the possibility of overreach caused by using
the faulted phase as the reference.
Note:
Zone 1X used in Zone 1 Extension Schemes uses the Zone 2 tilt settings to ensure that it does not underreach.
Dynamic tilting of reactance lines only occurs when the line is polarized with I2. If Iph is used as the polarizing
quantity the tilt of the Impedance Reach line is fixed. If fixed tilting is selected, Iph is always used. If dynamic tilting
is enabled, then the protection will decide whether to use I2 or Iph (and hence whether dynamic tilting will apply)
according to the angular relationship between I2 and Iph.
The following criteria are applied:
● If the angle between I2 and Iph is more than 45°, the Quadrilateral characteristics are disabled and Mho
characteristics are used instead.
● If the angle between I2 and Iph is less than 45°, Leading and lagging polarizing currents are allocated
according to the phase relations between I2 and Iph as presented in the diagram below:
I LEAD I ph I ph I LEAD I 2
I LAG I 2 I LAG I ph
I2
I ph
I2
V02728
Figure 57: Phase relations between I2 and Iph for leading and lagging polarizing currents
The comparators used for the reactance lines are allocated as per the following table:
Zone Line S1 S2 Condition
If ILEAD is I2 the lines are dynamically tilted up from the fixed angle.
If ILEAD is Iph, the fixed tilt applies.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 135
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
If ILAG is I2, the lines are dynamically tilted down from the fixed angle.
If ILAG is Iph, the fixed tilt applies.
+jX
Z1 plane
Ð (Iph / I) +
V/I
R’
+R
Z’ R
Ð (I ph / I) – 3°
V02734
136 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
+jX Z1 plane
1
Ð
1 k ZN
Z
1
R 'LP
1 k ZN 1
RLP
1 k ZN
R’reach Rreach
+R
Z’
1
Ð 3°
1 k ZN
V02735
a = (1/(1 + kZN))
In typical cases the sine ratio coefficient term is close to unity so the simplified equations can be used:
Rreach = RLP / ǀ (1 + kZN) ǀ,
R’reach = R’LP / ǀ (1 + kZN) ǀ,
So in terms of replica impedances and loop resistances, the comparators used for the resistance lines are as per
the following table:
Zone Line S1 S2 Condition
Forward or Offset Resistive reach Vph - Iph.RLP Iph.Zreplica ∠S1 -∠S2 > 0º
Forward or Offset Reverse resistive reach Vph - Iph.R’LP Iph.Zreplica ∠S1 -∠S2 < 0º
Reverse Resistive reach Vph + Iph.RLP -Iph.Zreplica ∠S1 -∠S2 > 0º
Reverse Reverse resistive reach Vph + Iph.R’LP -Iph.Zreplica ∠S1 -∠S2 < 0º
The Resistive Impedance Reach side of the earth zone is controlled by the Resistive Reach setting applied (Rx Gnd
Resistive). This defines the fault arc resistance that can be detected for a single phase-earth fault. For such a fault,
the fault resistance appears in the total fault loop (out and return loop), in which the line impedance is Z1 x (1 +
kZN), if IN @ Iph.
Most injection test sets plot impedance characteristics in positive sequence terms, so that the right-hand intercept
appears less than the setting applied (Rn Gnd Resistive /(1+ kZN)). The left hand side is set by the Rn Gnd Res Rev
setting and acts similarly.
Note:
The resistive reach lines of earth-fault Quadrilateral characteristics are not affected by the type of tilting used by the reactive
lines (fixed or dynamic), nor by the angle values.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 137
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
If fixed tilting is selected, then he current input quantity for S2 is Iph in all cases.
The positive sequence reach settings used for the Earth-Fault Quadrilateral characteristics are summarised in the
table below:
Reverse Resistive
Zone Type Impedance Reach Z Reverse Impedance Reach Z’ Resistive Reach R
Reach R’
1 Ph-Earth Forward Z1 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z R1 Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
2 Ph-Earth Forward Z2 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z R2 Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Earth Forward Z3 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z R3 Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Earth Reverse Z3 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z R3 Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
3 Ph-Earth Offset Z3 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) Z3’ Gnd Rev Rch * (1 + kZN) R3 Gnd Resistive R3’ Ph Res. Rev
4 Ph-Earth Reverse Z4 Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) Z R4 Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Earth Forward ZP Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z RP Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Earth Reverse ZP Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z RP Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
P Ph-Earth Offset ZQ Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) ZP’ Gnd Rev Rch * (1 + kZN) RP Gnd Resistive RP’ Gnd Res. Rev
Q Ph-Earth Forward ZQ Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z RQ Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
Q Ph-Earth Reverse ZQ Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) 0.25 Z RQ Gnd Resistive 0.25 R
Q Ph-Earth Offset ZQ Gnd. Reach * (1 + kZN) ZQ’ Gnd Rev Rch * (1 + kZN) RQ Gnd Resistive RQ’ Gnd Res. Rev
where kZN = (Z0 - Z1) / 3Z1 and is defined by two settings: kZN Res Comp and KZN Res Angle.
138 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
P446SV-TM-EN-1 139
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
● For directional zones, the directionality element must agree with the tripping zone. Zones 1, 2, and 4 are
always directional whereas other zones are only directional if set as directional. In directional zones the
directionality element must agree with the tripping zone. For example, Zone 1 is a Forward Directional zone
and must not trip for Reverse faults. Therefore a Zone 1 trip is only allowed if the directionality element
issues a Forward decision. Zone 4 is reverse-looking so needs a Reverse decision by the directionality
element.
● The set time delay for the measuring zone must expire, with the measured fault impedance remaining
inside the zone characteristic for the duration of the delay time. Typically, Zone 1 has no time delay
(instantaneous), whereas all other zones have time delays.
● Where channel-aided distance schemes are used, the time delay tZ2 for overreaching Zone 2 may be
bypassed for some of the schemes.
Note:
Any existing trip decision is not reset under this condition. After the first cycle following a selection, the phase selector is only
permitted to change to a selection involving additional phases.
On double phase-to-earth faults, only the phase-to-phase elements are enabled. This is because they are
generally more accurate under these conditions than earth fault elements. A biased neutral current level detector
operates to indicate the involvement of earth in the fault.
140 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
AB
BC
CA
V02702
Figure 60: Phase to phase current changes for C phase-to-ground (CN) fault
As default, phase selection is made when any superimposed current exceeds 5% of nominal current (0.05 In).
Any superimposed current greater than 80% of the largest superimposed current is included in the phase selection
logic.
For applications which might experience high levels of sub-synchronous currents, the phase selector automatically
raises the threshold from the default 5% of In, in order to prevent sporadic operation whilst maintaining high
sensitivity to faults.
Note:
If you test the distance elements using test sets, which do not provide a dynamic model to generate true fault delta
conditions, you need to set Static Test Mode to Enabled in the COMMISSION TESTS column. This disables phase selector
control and forces the distance protection to use a conventional (non-delta) directional line.
The phase selector picks up on fault detection, and enables Distance protection on all elements which have been
selected by the pick-up. These elements are enabled for 2 cycles, and normally this will result in tripping. On double
ground-to-phase faults, only appropriate phase elements are enabled. This is because they are generally more
accurate than ground elements under these conditions. If, however, tripping is not initiated within the 2 cycles, for
the following 5 cycles all Distance elements (including all phase-earth elements) are enabled. During these five
cycles, this could lead to incorrect operation of earth-fault elements in case of an out-of-zone double-phase-earth
fault. This is because one of the phase-earth elements could demonstrate significant overreach, which may result
in maloperation. To help prevent this, a Biased Neutral Current Detector is incorporated.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 141
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
I N I A I B IC
Neutral current
K 10%
The neutral current detector uses the maximum of the three phase current differences as a biasing value. The
slope of the characteristic is fixed at 10%.
Biasing the neutral current detector assures that the detector is sensitive enough to operate for any single-phase
fault, without the risk of picking up on neutral spill current during phase-to-phase faults. The neutral spill current
might arise from mismatched current transformers or current transformer saturation. The biasing also ensures
that the earth fault distance elements are generally disabled for double-phase-to-earth faults with high resistance
in the neutral. Such faults can occur in resistively earthed systems, or in solidly earthed systems due to high arc
resistance. Given that these conditions are very similar to pure phase-to-phase faults, the earth fault distance
elements can exhibit high measuring errors which the use of the neutral current detector overcomes.
Note:
Distance zones are directionalized by a Delta Directional decision. The characteristic angle for this decision is set with the
Delta Directional configuration, in the DISTANCE SETUP column. The default setting is 60°.
142 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
The Delta Directional technique needs the changes in voltage and current to exceed the preset thresholds, in order
to determine forward and reverse decisions. If these thresholds are not exceeded, but a potential fault is detected,
the Distance protection reverts to a conventional directional technique with memory polarization of the voltage.
If you don’t want to use the Delta directional technique, set Dir. Status in the DISTANCE SETUP column to
Disabled in which case memory polarization is used.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 143
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
Therefore, for slower operation, I needs to be low, as restricted by a relatively weak infeed and Z needs to be small,
as for a short line.
144 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
where:
● Vn = Nominal phase to neutral voltage
● I = Fault current
● Z = Reach setting for the zone concerned
Sub-cycle tripping is maintained for lower SIRs, up to a ratio of 2. The instantaneous operating time is increased by
about a quarter of a power frequency cycle at higher SIRs.
Transients caused by voltage dips, however severe, do not affect the protection’s directional measurement
because it uses voltage memory.
jX
Operate area
Operate area
V00645
● Z denotes the Load/B Impedance setting. This sets the radius of the under-impedance circle.
● ß denotes the Load/B Angle setting. This sets the angle of the two blinder boundary lines - the gradient of
the rise or fall with respect to the resistive axis.
The protection can allow the load blinder to be bypassed any time that the measured voltage for the phase in
question falls below an undervoltage setting. Under such circumstances, the low voltage could not be attributed to
normal voltage excursion tolerances on load. A fault must be present on the phase in question, so it is acceptable
to override the blinder action and allow the Distance protection to trip for an in-zone measurement. The
advantage of bypassing the load blinders is that the resistive coverage for faults near to the protection location
can be higher.
To use the load blinders you must set the Load Blinders setting to Enabled. You then set appropriate values for
the blinder impedance using the Z< Blinder Imp setting, the b value using the Load/B Angle setting, and the
undervoltage threshold using the Load Blinder V< setting.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 145
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
Note:
Load blinding can be applied for phase and earth characteristics. Residual compensation is not applied. Phase characteristics
use phase-to-phase voltage and phase-to-phase current. Earth fault characteristics use phase-to-neutral voltage and phase-
to-neutral current.
146 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
Note:
The characteristic angle set in this section is also used by the Distance protection. This is because distance zones are
directionalized by the delta decision.
Delta directional comparison looks at the relative phase angle of the superimposed current DI (delta I) compared to
the superimposed voltage DV (delta V), at the instant of fault inception. The delta is only present when a fault
occurs and a step change from the pre-fault steady-state load is generated by the fault. The element issues a
forward or reverse decision which can be input into an aided channel unit protection scheme.
Under healthy network conditions the system voltage is close to Vn nominal and load current flows. Under such
steady-state conditions, if the voltage measured on each phase now is compared with a stored memory from
exactly two power-system cycles previously, the difference between them is zero. Zero voltage change (DV = 0) and
zero current change (DI = 0), except when there are changes in load current.
When a fault occurs on the system, the delta changes measured are:
DV = fault voltage (time “t”) - pre-fault healthy voltage (t-2 cycles)
DI = fault current (time “t”) - pre-fault load current (t-2 cycles)
The delta measurements are a vector difference, resulting in a delta magnitude and angle. Under healthy system
conditions the pre-fault values are those measured 2 cycles earlier. When a fault is detected the pre-fault values
are retained for the duration of the fault.
The changes in magnitude are used to detect the presence of the fault and the angles are used to determine
whether the fault is in the Forward or Reverse direction.
The following figure shows a single phase to earth fault.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 147
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
IF1
V1
IF/3
IF2
V2
voltage
generator
represents
voltage change
IF0 at fault location
V0
E02704
The fault is shown near to the busbar at end R of the line, and results in a connection of the positive, negative, and
zero sequence networks in series. The delta diagram shows that any fault is a generator of D, connected at the
location of the fault inception. The characteristics of the deltas are:
● The DI generated by the fault is equal to the total fault arc current.
● The DI splits into parallel paths, with part contribution from source “S” and part from remote end “R” of the
line. Therefore each element measures a lower proportion of DI.
● The DV generated by the fault is equal to the fault arc voltage minus the pre-fault voltage, so it is in anti-
phase with the pre-fault voltage.
● The DV measured by the protection is the voltage drop across the source impedance behind the protection
location. This is generally smaller than the DV measured at the fault location, because the voltage collapse
is smaller nearer to the source than at the fault.
● For fault detection, the measured DI and DV associated with the fault must be greater than the Dir I Fwd
and Dir V Fwd settings respectively.
148 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
Note:
If Delta directional aided scheme are not used, Distance zone directionalizing uses fixed operating thresholds: DV=0.5V and
DI=5%In. If the fault DV is below the setting of 0.5V, a conventional distance line ensures correct forward/reverse polarizing.
For Delta directional aided schemes, sufficient DV must be present for tripping to occur.
The delta directional element will produce a forward decision when the angle between the delta volts and delta
current shifted by the Dir. Char Angle setting is greater than 90°. The Dir. Char Angle setting is the characteristic
angle of the source impedance, Zs.
Forward
Reverse
DI
Zs
RCA
To facilitate testing of the distance elements using test sets, which do not provide a dynamic model to generate
true fault delta conditions, set the Static Test Mode setting in the COMMISSIONING TESTS column to Enabled.
This disables phase selector control and forces the protection to use a conventional (non-delta) directional line.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 149
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
6 APPLICATION NOTES
Zone Reach
Z
Tilt Angle
Time
Delay
t
Line
Angle
Resistive
Reach
R
E02746
The following figure shows the basic settings needed to configure a forward-looking mho zone, assuming that the
load blinder is enabled.
150 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
Variable mho
Zone Reach Z
expansion by
polarizing ratio
Time
Delay
t
Load
Line Blinder
Angle
Angle β
Blinder Radius
E02747
P446SV-TM-EN-1 151
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
Zone 3 may also be set as a reverse directional zone. The setting chosen for Zone 3, if used, depends on its
application. Typical applications include its use as an additional time delayed zone or as a reverse back-up
protection zone for busbars and transformers.
Programmable zone elements can be set with the same options as Zone 3 (Forward, Reverse or Offset). A
programmable zone can be used as an additional forward protection zone if custom and practice requires using
more than three forward zones of Distance protection.
The Zone 4 elements may also provide back-up protection for the local busbar. Where Zone 4 is used to provide
reverse directional decisions for Blocking or Permissive Overreach schemes, Zone 4 must reach further behind the
protection than Zone 2 for the remote end protection. In such cases the reverse reach should be:
● Mho: Z4 > Remote Zone 2 reach x 120%
● Quadrilateral: Z4 > (Remote Zone 2 reach x 120%) minus the protected line impedance
Note:
In the case of the Mho, the line impedance is not subtracted. This ensures that whatever the amount of dynamic expansion of
the circle, the reverse looking zone always detects all solid and resistive faults capable of detection by Zone 2 at the remote
line end.
Note:
Because the fault current for an earth fault may be limited by tower footing resistance, high soil resistivity, and weak
infeeding; any arcing resistance is often higher than for a corresponding phase fault at the same location. It maybe necessary
to set the Rn Gnd Resistive settings to be higher than the Rn Ph Resistive setting. A setting of Rn Gnd Resistive three times that
of Rn Ph Resistive is not uncommon.
152 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
Long lines
In the case of medium and long line applications where quadrilateral distance earth-fault characteristics are used,
Zn Dynamic Tilt should be enabled and the starting tilt angle should be -3° (as per the default settings). This tilt
compensates for possible current and voltage transformer and line data errors.
For high resistive faults during power exporting, the underreaching Zone 1 is only allowed to tilt down by the angle
difference between the faulted phase and negative sequence current Ð(Iph-I2) starting from the –3° set angle. This
ensures stability of Zone 1 for high resistance faults beyond the Zone 1 reach even during heavy load conditions
(high load angle between two voltage sources) and sufficient sensitivity for high resistance internal faults. The tilt
angle for all other zones (that are by nature overreaching zones) remain at -3°.
In the case of power importing, Zone 1 remains at –3° while all other zones are allowed to tilt up by the Ð(Iph-I2)
angle difference, starting from –3°. This increases the Zone 2 and Zone 4 resistive reaches and secures correct
operation in permissive overreach and blocking type schemes.
Short lines
For very short lines, typically below 10Miles (16km), the ratio of resistive to reactance reach setting (R/X) could
easily exceed 10. For such applications the geometrical shape of the quadrilateral characteristic could be such
that the top reactance line is close or even crosses the resistive axis as presented in the following figure:
jX
High resistive internal fault
Total dynamic tilt starting from zero
Z1
-3 ° Iph -I 2
Line angle R
Iph -I 2
V02748
In the case of high resistance external faults on a short line, particularly under heavy power exporting conditions,
Zone 1 remains stable due to dynamic downwards tilting of the impedance reach line. However, the detection of
high resistance internal faults especially towards the end of the line needs consideration. In such applications you
can choose to detect high resistance faults using highly sensitive Aided Directional Earth Fault scheme, or to clear
the fault with Distance ground protection. For the Distance to operate, it is necessary to eliminate over-tilting for
internal faults by reducing the initial -3° tilting angle to zero so that the overall impedance reach line tilt is equal to
Ð(Iph-I2) angle only.
As shown in the previous figure, the internal resistive fault then falls in the Zone 1 operating characteristic.
However, for short lines the load angle is relatively low when compared to long transmission lines for the same
transfer capacity and therefore the impedance reach line dynamic tilting may be moderate. Therefore it may be
necessary to reduce the Zone 1 reach to guarantee Zone 1 stability. This is particularly recommended if the
distance protection is operating in an aided scheme. To summarise, for very short lines with large R/X setting
ratios, we recommend settiing the initial tilt angle to zero and the Zone 1 reach to 70-75% of the line impedance.
The above discussion assumes homogenous networks where the angle of the negative sequence current derived
at relaying point is very close to the total fault current angle. If the network is non-homogenous, there is a
difference in angle that causes inaccurate dynamic tilting. Therefore in such networks either quadrilateral with
fixed tilt angle or mho characteristic should be considered to avoid Zone 1 overreach.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 153
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
Note:
You can also use Delta Directional schemes to detect high resistance faults.
Exporting End
To secure stability, the tilt angle of Zone 1 at the exporting end has to be set negative and above the maximum
angle difference between sources feeding the resistive faults. This data should be known from load flow study, but
if unavailable, the minimum recommended setting would be the angle difference between voltage and current
measured at local end during the heaviest load condition coupled with reduced Zone 1 reach of 70-75% of the line
impedance.
Note:
With a sharp fixed tilt angle, the effective resistive coverage would be significantly reduced. Therefore for short lines, dynamic
tilting (with variable tilt angle depending on fault resistance and location) is preferred. For all other overreaching zones, set the
tilting angle to zero.
Importing End
Set zone 1 tilt angle to zero and for all other zones the typical setting should be positive and between +5° and +10°.
Note:
The setting accuracy for overreaching zones is not crucial because it does not pose a risk for distance maloperation. The
purpose is to boost Zone 2 and Zone 4 reach and improve the performance of Aided Schemes.
Note:
A negative angle is used to set a downwards tilt gradient, and a positive angle to tilt upwards.
154 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
Note:
Mho characteristics have an inherent tendency to avoid unwanted overreaching, making them very desirable for long line
protection.
Note:
When using the Special Applications filter the instantaneous operating time is increased by about a quarter of a power
frequency cycle.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 155
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
Cable applications
Use 20% (0.2) memory. This results in minimum Mho expansion and keeps the protected line section well within the
expanded Mho, thereby ensuring better accuracies and faster operating times for close-up faults. This matches
the guidance previously provided for LFZP123 or LFZR applications for cable feeders
Short lines
For lines shorter than 10miles (16km), or with an SIR higher than 15, use the maximum memory polarization
(setting = 5). This ensures sufficient characteristic expansion to cover fault arc resistance.
156 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
The reverse fault detectors must be set more sensitively, as they are used to invoke the blocking and current
reversal guard elements. We suggest that all reverse detectors are set at 66 to 80% of the setting of the forward
detector, typically:
● Dir. V Rev = Dir. V Fwd x 0.66
● Dir. I Rev = Dir. I Fwd x 0.66
Due to the implementation method, Deltas are present only for 2 cycles on fault inception. If any distance elements
are enabled, these will automatically allow the delta forward or reverse decisions to seal-in, until such time as the
fault is cleared from the system. Therefore as a minimum, some distance zone(s) must be enabled in the DISTANCE
SETUP column as fault detectors. It does not matter what time delay is applied for the zone(s). This can either be
the typical distance delay for that zone or set to ‘Disabled’ in the SCHEME LOGIC column, if no distance tripping is
required. As a minimum, Zone 3 must be enabled, with a reverse reach such as to allow seal-in of Dir. Rev, and a
forward reach to allow seal-in of Dir. Fwd.
The applicable reaches would be:
● Zone 3 Forward: Set at least as long as a conventional Zone 2 (120-150% of the protected line)
● Zone 3 Reverse: Set at least as long as a conventional Zone 4, or supplement by assigning Zone 4 if a large
reverse reach is not preferred for Zone 3.
We generally advise a Mho characteristic in such starter applications, although quadrilaterals are acceptable. As
the Mho starter is likely to have a large radius, we strongly advise applying the Load Blinder.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 157
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
The settings are applicable whether the Distance protection characteristics are set to Mho, or Quadrilateral. If you
choose Quadrilateral however, you will need to consider the Resistive reaches of Quadrilaterals.
For this study, we wish to protect one line of a double 230kV, 100km line between a substation at Green Valley and
a substation at Blue river. There are generating sources at Tiger Bay, 80 km from Green Valley and at Rocky Bay, 60
km from Blue River.
The single-line diagram for the system is shown in the following figure:
100 km
80 km 60 km
IED IED
E02705
158 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
Therefore set:
kZN Res Comp = 0.79
KZN Res Angle = -6.5°
From this the protection algorithm automatically calculates the required Ohmic reaches.
Alternatively, using the Setting Mode Advanced, the values can be calculated and entered manually as follows:
Required Zone 1 reach = 0.8 x 100 x 0.484Ð79.4° x 0.12 = 4.64Ð79.4° W secondary
So:
● Set Z1 Ph. Reach and Z1 Gnd. Reach = 4.64 W
● Set Z1 Ph. Angle and Z1 Gnd. Angle = 80°
P446SV-TM-EN-1 159
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
Alternatively, in Simple setting mode, this reach can be set as a percentage of the protected line. Typically a
figure of at least 120% of the line between Green Valley and Blue River is used.
Alternatively, in Simple setting mode, this reach can be set as a percentage of the protected line.
160 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
Phase-Fault Elements
Ideally, the Resistive reach should be set greater than the maximum fault arc resistance for a phase-phase fault
(Ra), calculated in terms of the minimum expected phase-phase fault current, the maximum phase conductor
separation, according to the formula developed by (van) Warrington as:
Ra = (28710 x L)/If x 1.4
where:
● If = Minimum expected phase-phase fault current (A)
● L = Maximum phase conductor separation (m)
Typical figures for Ra are given, for different values of minimum expected phase fault currents, in the following
table:
P446SV-TM-EN-1 161
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
Note:
For circuits with infeed from more than one terminal, the fault resistance will appear greater. This is because the protection
cannot measure the current contribution from a remote terminal. The apparent fault resistance increase could be between 2
to 8 times the calculated resistance. For this reason, we recommended setting the zone Resistive reaches to 4 times the
calculated arc resistance.
In this example, the minimum phase fault level is 1000 MVA. This is equivalent to an effective short-circuit fault
feeding impedance of:
Earth-Fault Elements
Fault resistance would comprise arc-resistance and tower footing resistance. A typical resistive reach coverage
setting would be 40 W (primary).
For high resistance earth faults, the situation could arise where no distance elements would operate. In such
cases, supplementary earth fault protection (for example Aided DEF protection) should be applied. If
supplementary earth fault protection is used, large resistive reaches for Earth-Fault Distance protection do not
need to be used so that the Earth-Fault Resistive reach can be set according to the utility practice. In the absence
of specific guidance, a recommendation for setting Zone 1 is:
● Cables: Resistive Reach = 3 x Zone 1 reach
● Overhead lines: Choose Resistive Reach in the range [2.3 - 0.0045] x Line length(km) x Zone 1 Reach
● Lines longer than 400 km: Choose Resistive Reach = 0.5 x Zone 1 Reach
162 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 7 - Distance Protection
A B
Ia Ib
Zat
Zbt
Ic
Zct
Va
Va = Ia Zat + Ib Zbt C Impedance seen by relay A =
Ia
Ia = Ia + Ic
E03524
P446SV-TM-EN-1 163
Chapter 7 - Distance Protection P446SV
164 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 8
166 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 167
Introduction 168
Carrier Aided Schemes Implementation 169
Aided Distance Scheme Logic 171
Aided DEF Scheme Logic 184
Aided Delta Scheme Logic 195
Application Notes 202
P446SV-TM-EN-1 167
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
2 INTRODUCTION
The provision of communication channels between the terminals of a protected transmission line or distribution
feeder enables unit protection to be applied.
Protection devices located at different terminals can be configured to communicate with one another in order to
implement unit protection schemes. The exchange of simple ON/OFF command signals allows unit protection to
be achieved with Distance Protection schemes (Aided Distance), Directional Earth Fault schemes (Aided DEF) and if
applicable, Delta Directional Comparison Protection schemes (Aided Delta). Schemes where a communication
channel is used to send command signals between line ends are known as Carrier Aided Schemes.
The terms ‘simplex’ and ‘duplex’ are used to describe the type of communication channel used. Simplex
communication, also sometimes referred to as half-duplex, requires only a single communication channel
between line ends. Signals can be sent in both directions but not at the same time. Duplex communication requires
two communication channels between line ends (one in each direction). Duplex communication allows signals to
be sent and received at the same time.
168 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
The underreaching options can be used to implement Carrier Aided Distance schemes. The other options can be
used with any Carrier Aided scheme application.
The following diagram shows how the schemes can be assigned.
Scheme Function Aided Distance Aided Distance Aided DEF Aided Delta*
*Not P445
V03500
P446SV-TM-EN-1 169
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
Note:
The PUR schemes are only suitable for Distance protection. Therefore, if a PUR scheme is selected, the option to allocate to
other protection is not available.
170 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
Note:
This assumes a 20% typical end-zone when Zone 1 is set to 80% of the protected line.
The following are some of the main features and requirements for a permissive under-reaching scheme.
● Only a simplex channel is required.
● Scheme security is high, because the signalling channel is only keyed for faults in the protected line.
● If the circuit breaker at the remote terminal is open, faults in the remote 20% of the line are cleared using
the Zone 2 time delay of the local protection.
● If there is a weak-infeed, or zero-infeed from the remote terminal, (current below the protection sensitivity),
faults in the remote 20% of the line are cleared using the Zone 2 time delay of the local protection.
● If the signalling channel fails, basic distance scheme tripping remains available.
The PUR logic is:
● Send logic: Assert signal if Zone 1 element operates
● Permissive trip logic: Trip if the Zone 2 element picks up AND the Carrier Aided signal is received
P446SV-TM-EN-1 171
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
Zone 3
Zone 2
Zone 1
A B
Z
Z
Zone 1
Zone 2
Zone 3
CRx CRx
CTx CTx
& &
Z1 Z1
TZ1 TZ1
Trip A Trip B 1
1
Zp TZp Zp
TZp
Z2 TZ2 Z2
TZ2
Z3 TZ3 Z3
TZ3
Z4 TZ4 Z4
TZ4
E03501
Note:
This assumes a 20% typical end-zone when Zone 1 is set to 80% of the protected line.
172 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
The following are some of the main features and requirements for a POR scheme:
● The scheme requires a duplex signalling channel to prevent possible maloperation if a carrier is keyed for an
external fault. Because the signalling channel can be keyed for faults external to the protected zone, it is
vital that they are only received by, and acted upon by, the intended recipient. A simplex channel cannot
assure this.
● A POR scheme may be more advantageous than a PUR scheme for the protection of short transmission
lines. This is because the resistive coverage of the Zone 2 elements may be greater than that of the Zone 1
elements (in the case of Mho elements)
● Current reversal guard logic prevents healthy-line protection maloperation for high speed current reversals
that can be experienced on double circuit line applications, which can be caused by sequential opening of
circuit breakers.
● If the signalling channel fails, basic distance scheme tripping remains available.
The POR scheme also uses the reverse looking zone 4 as a reverse fault detector. This is used in the current
reversal logic and in the weak infeed echo feature, shown dotted in the figure below:
P446SV-TM-EN-1 173
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
Zone 4
Zone 3
Zone 2
Zone 1
Z B
Zone 1
Zone 2
Zone 3
Zone 4
CRx CRx
Zone 4 & & Zone 4
CTx CTx
1 1
LD0V LD0V
& &
& &
Z1 Z1
TZ1 Trip A Trip B
TZ1
1 1
ZP TZP ZP
TZP
Z2 TZ2 TZ2 Z2
Z3 TZ3 TZ3 Z3
Z4 TZ4 TZ4 Z4
Selectable features
E03502
The POR scheme is enhanced by POR Trip Reinforcement, and POR Weak Infeed features.
174 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
This feature is called permissive trip reinforcement. It is designed to ensure that synchronous tripping occurs at all
protected terminals.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 175
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
The window of time during which the unblocking logic is enabled starts 10ms after the guard signal is lost, and
continues for 150ms. The 10ms delay gives time for the signalling equipment to change frequency, as in normal
operation. For the duration of any alarm condition, Zone 1 extension logic is invoked if the Z1 Ext Scheme setting is
set to operate for channel failure.
t2(C) t2(D)
Fault Fault
A L1 B A L1 B
Strong Weak
source C L2 D source C L2 D
The current reversal guard incorporated in the permissive overreach scheme logic is initiated when the reverse
looking Zone 4 elements operate on a healthy line.
Once the reverse looking Zone 4 elements have operated, the permissive trip logic and signal send logic are
inhibited at substation D. The reset of the current reversal guard timer is initiated when the reverse looking Zone 4
resets. A time delay tReversal Guard is required in case the overreaching trip element at end D operates before
the signal send from the protection at end C has reset. Otherwise this would cause the product at D to overreach.
Permissive tripping for the products at D and C substations is enabled again once the faulted line is isolated and
the current reversal guard time has expired.
The current reversal guard incorporated in the blocking scheme logic is initiated when a blocking element picks-up
to inhibit the channel-aided trip. When the current reverses and the reverse looking Zone 4 elements reset, the
blocking signal is maintained by the timer tReversal Guard. Therefore, the protections in the healthy line are
prevented from overreaching due to the sequential opening of the circuit breakers in the faulted line. After the
faulted line is isolated, the reverse-looking Zone 4 elements at substation C and the forward looking elements at
substation D reset.
176 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
The two schemes are similar. Both schemes feature current reversal guard signals used in conjunction with reverse
looking Zone 4 elements. In the Blocking 1 scheme, the current reversal guard signal applies to the send signal,
whereas in the Blocking 2 scheme, the current reversal guard signal applies to the receive signal.
The signalling channel is keyed from operation of the reverse-looking Zone 4 elements. If the remote zone 2
element picks up, it operates after the trip delay if no block is received. Listed below are some of the main features
and requirements for a Blocking scheme:
● Blocking schemes require only a simplex communication channel.
● Reverse-looking Zone 4 is used to send a blocking signal to the remote end to prevent unwanted tripping.
● When a simplex channel is used, a blocking scheme can easily be applied to a multi-terminal line provided
that outfeed does not occur for any internal faults.
● The blocking signal is transmitted over a healthy line, and so problems associated with power line carrier
signals failing are avoided.
● Blocking schemes provide similar resistive coverage to the permissive overreach schemes.
● Fast tripping occurs at a strong source line end, for faults along the protected line section, even if there is
weak- or zero- infeed at the other end of the protected line.
● If a line terminal is open, fast tripping still occurs for faults along the whole of the protected line length.
● If the signalling channel fails to send a blocking signal during a fault, fast tripping occurs for faults along the
whole of the protected line, but also for some faults in the next line section.
● If the signalling channel is taken out of service, the protection operates in the conventional basic mode.
● A current reversal guard timer is included in the logic to prevent unwanted tripping on healthy circuits
during current reversal situations on a parallel circuits.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 177
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
Zone 4
Zone 3
Zone 2
Zone 1
A Z B
Z
Zone 1
Zone 2
Zone 3
Zone 4
CRx CRx
Fast Z4 Fast Z4
CTx CTx &
&
& &
Z1 Z1
TZ1 Trip B
TZ1
Trip A
1 1
ZP TZP ZP
TZP
Z2 TZ2 TZ2 Z2
Z3 TZ3 TZ3 Z3
Z4 Z4
TZ4 TZ4
Selectable features
E03504
178 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
The Aided 1 Scheme RX signal corresponds to a 'channel-receive' signal for scheme 1. The Aided 1 COS/LGS signal
corresponds to a 'channel out of service' or 'loss of guard' signal ('Loss of guard' is the inverse signal to 'guard
received').
As well as the default mapping, it is possible to map the signals to other inputs if required.
The window during which the unblocking logic is enabled starts 10ms after the guard signal is lost and continues
for 150ms. The 10ms delay gives time for the signalling equipment to change frequency.
Note:
If the Z1 Ext Scheme setting is set to operate for channel failure, the Zone 1 extension logic will be invoked if a channel failure
is detected.
This scheme type also provides Loss of Guard logic as described below.
Permissive Permissive Alarm
System condition Loss of guard
channel received trip allowed generated
Healthy Line No No No No
Internal Line Fault Yes Yes Yes No
Unblock No Yes Yes, during a 150 ms window Yes, delayed on pickup by 150 ms
Signalling Anomaly Yes No No Yes, delayed on pickup by 150 ms
P446SV-TM-EN-1 179
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
Aid 1 Distance
Scheme options *
960
Zone1 AN Element
961 &
Zone1 BN Element 1 1 &
1
962
Zone1 CN Element
963
Zone1 AB Element
964
&
Zone1 BC Element 1
965
Zone1 CA Element 1
&
966
Zone2 AN Element
967 &
Zone2 BN Element 1 1
968
Zone2 CN Element
969
Zone2 AB Element Signal Send
970 &
Zone2 BC Element 1 Echo Send
971
Zone2 CA Element 1
& 498
Zone4 AN Element 984 1
& Aided 1 Send
985
& tRG
Zone4 BN Element 1 1
986
Zone4 CN Element From Aided 1 DEF
987 From Aided 1 Delta
Zone4 AB Element
& (if applicable)
988
Zone4 BC Element 1
989 Blk Send
Zone4 CA Element
497
Aid1 Custom Send
496
Notes: Aid1 Block Send
This example assumes zone 2 distance phase and distance ground
elements are enabled .
Aided 1 scheme only shown .
Note: For the purpose of clarity , this diagram shows the first
relevant stage number for each signal and setting name .
V03505
& 317
1 Aid 1 Chan Fail
&
t DR t DW
&
1
& 494
1 Aided 1 receive
1
& t PR
&
&
492
Aided 1 COS/LGS
&
493
Aided 1 Scheme Rx
&
Aid. 1 Selection
PUR Unblocking
POR Unblocking 1
Prog. Unblocking V03508
180 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
501
Aid1 Trip Enable
1
502
Aid1 Custom Trip tDST
1
503
1 Aid 1 Dist Trip
966
Zone2 AN Element
&
1 & 633
& 1 Aided 1 Trip A
967
Zone2 BN Element
&
1 & 634
& 1 Aided 1 Trip B
968
Zone 2 CN Element
&
1 & 635
& 1 Aided 1 Trip C
Aid 1 Distance
1 1 & 636
Ground Only & 1 Aided 1 Trip N
Phase And Ground From Aided 1 Def Trip A
Phase Only 1 From Aided 1 Delta Trip A (if applicable)
From Aided 1 Def Trip B
From Aided 1 Delta Trip B (if applicable)
969
From Aided 1 Def Trip C
Zone2 AB Element From Aided 1 Delta Trip C (if applicable)
&
From Aided 1 Def Trip N
970
From Aided 1 Delta Trip N (if applicable )
Zone2 BC Element
& Notes:
Aided 1 scheme only shown.
971
Zone2 CA Element
&
V03509
Aid. 1 Selection
PUR
501
& Aid1 Trip Enable
Aided 1 Receive 494 100 ms
V03512
P446SV-TM-EN-1 181
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
POR
522
Any Trip
&
Trip Inputs 3Ph
529 &
1 Echo Send
Send on Trip
None
Any Trip
& &
Any Trip
522 1 100ms
Send on Trip
Aided / Z1
&
Aid 1 Distance
Disabled
608 &
Zone 1 Trip 1
503
Aid 1 Dist Trip
505 &
Aid 1 DEF Trip 1
250 ms 100 ms
494
Aided 1 Receive
&
Aid. 1 Selection
POR
903
CB Open 3 ph 10 ms
904
CB1 Open A ph
912 &
CB2 Open A ph WI Sngl Pole Trp
905
1
CB1 Open B ph
& Disabled
913 &
CB2 Open B ph WI Trip Delay 642
906 & Aid1 WI Trip 3Ph
CB1 Open C ph
914 &
CB2 Open C ph 60 ms
Blk Send 637
833 Aid 1 WI Trip A
VTS Slow Block 638
Week Infeed
Aid 1 WI Trip B
Weak Infeed Snapshot Logic 639
&
Aided 1 WI V< A
1358 1
904
CB1 Open A ph &
912
CB2 Open A ph
1359
Aided 1 WI V< B
905
CB1 Open B ph &
913
CB2 Open B ph
1360
Aided 1 WI V< C
905
CB1 Open C ph &
913
CB2 Open C ph V03514
182 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
492
Aided 1 COS/LGS
V03516
tReversal Guard
498
Aided 1 Send
1
Aided 1 Receive 494 tRGD 1 501
Aid1 Trip Enable
492
Aided 1 COS/LGS
V03517
P446SV-TM-EN-1 183
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
5.2 IMPLEMENTATION
Aided DEF protection can be used with permissive over-reach schemes or blocking schemes.
The Aided DEF protection is enabled using the Directional E/F setting in the CONFIGURATION column. This makes
the settings in the AIDED DEF column visible.
The Aided DEF requires a polarizing quantity (selected in the DEF Polarizing setting) in conjunction with a
characteristic angle setting (DEF Char. Angle) to make the directional decision.
For all models a signal derived from the phase voltage inputs can be used for polarization. For certain models with
more VT inputs, a directly measured input can be used.
You have a choice between Zero Sequence Polarizing or Negative Sequence Polarizing for the Aided DEF element.
If you choose Zero Sequence Polarization, you have a choice to enable an innovative feature known as Virtual
Current Polarization to enhance the Aided DEF function.
Aided DEF protection is blocked if any of the following conditions are met:
● An Any Trip signal is asserted by one of the integrated protection functions
● The phase selector picks up on more than one phase
● Any of the signals Pole Dead A, Pole Dead B, or Pole Dead C are asserted
Zero Sequence polarization normally uses the measurement of residual voltage (VN). This can only be achieved if a
5-limb VT or three single-phase VTs are used. A special form of zero sequence polarization called Virtual Current
Polarization is also possible with this device. Virtual Current Polarization allows directionalisation for low levels of
polarization voltage.
184 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
Directional forward
90° < (angle(VNpol) +180°) - (angle(IN )- RCA) < 90°
Directional reverse
90° > (angle(VNpol) +180° - (angle(IN) - RCA) > 90°
This is represented in the following figure:
P446SV-TM-EN-1 185
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
IN angle -RCA
IN
The Polarizing voltage (VNpol) is as per the table below and RCA is the relay characteristic angle defined by the
DEF Char. Angle setting.
Phase selector pickup VNpol
A Phase Fault VB + VC
B Phase Fault VA + VC
C Phase Fault VA + VB
No Selection VN = VA + VB + VC
The problems in these applications can be alleviated using negative phase sequence (nps) voltage for polarization.
The nps voltage threshold must be set in the cell DEF V2pol Set.
Note:
The current quantity used for operation of the Aided DEF when it is nps Polarized is the residual current not the nps current.
Directional forward
-90° < [(angle(V2) +180°) - (angle(I2) - RCA) ] < 90°
Directional reverse
-90° > [ (angle(V2) +180°) - angle(I2) - RCA) ] > 90°
where RCA is the relay characteristic angle set in the DEF Char. Angle setting.
186 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
I2 angle -RCA
I2
If Virtual I Pol is set to ‘Disabled’ it prevents checking of the faulted phase and subsequent removal of the faulted
phase voltage. The aided DEF protection is then polarized by the residual voltage only.
For negative sequence polarization, the relay characteristic angle settings (DEF Char. Angle) must be based on the
angle of the upstream negative phase sequence source impedance. A typical setting is -60°.
The Aided DEF Forward setting determines the current sensitivity (trip sensitivity) of the aided DEF aided scheme.
This setting must be set higher than any standing residual current unbalance. A typical setting will be between
10% and 20% In.
The Aided DEF Reverse setting determines the current sensitivity for the reverse earth fault. The setting must
always be below the aided DEF forward threshold for correct operation of blocking schemes and to provide
stability for current reversal in parallel line applications. The recommended setting is 2/3 of the Aided DEF forward
setting.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 187
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
Note:
The Aided DEF Reverse setting has to be above the maximum steady state residual current imbalance.
188 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
DEF Forward
ZL
A B
DEF Forward
CRx CRx
DEF-Reverse & CTx CTx
& DEF-Reverse
1 1
Trip Trip
DEF Inst DEF Inst
1 A B
1
DEF Bu1 t
Bu1 t
Bu1 DEF Bu1
P446SV-TM-EN-1 189
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
The figures below show the element reaches, and the simplified scheme logic of the Aided Directional Earth Fault
(Aided DEF) Blocking scheme.
DEF-Forward
DEF-Reverse
ZL
A B
DEF-Forward
DEF-Reverse
CRx CRx
DEF-Reverse Start Start DEF-Reverse
CTx CTx
Stop Stop
DEF Bu1 t
Bu1 t
Bu1 DEF Bu1
DEF Bu2 t
Bu2 t
Bu2 DEF Bu2
DEF IDMT t
IDMT t
IDMT DEF IDMT
E03519
V03526
190 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
Blk Send
497
Aid1 Custom Send
496
Aid1 Block Send
Notes:
Aided 1 scheme only shown .
P445 does not provide an Aided Delta function .
V03506
& 317
1 Aid 1 Chan Fail
&
t DR t DW
&
1
& 494
1 Aided 1 receive
1
& t PR
&
&
492
Aided 1 COS/LGS
&
493
Aided 1 Scheme Rx
&
Aid. 1 Selection
PUR Unblocking
POR Unblocking 1
Prog. Unblocking V03508
P446SV-TM-EN-1 191
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
395
Aid 1 DEF Trip
Aid1 Inhibit DEF
3 Pole
501 1
Aid1 Trip Enable 1 And 3 Pole
1
502
Aid1 Custom Trip
1 tDEF & 641
Aid1 DEF Trip3 Ph
DEF Status &
505
Enabled 1 Aid 1 DEF Trip
&
996
DEF Forward
& 633
& 1 Aided 1 Trip A
1010
Phase Select A
& 634
1011 & 1 Aided 1 Trip B
Phase Select B
& 635
& 1 Aided 1 Trip C
1012
Phase Select C
& 636
1013 & 1 Aided 1 Trip N
Phase Select N
&
1
From Aided 1 Distance Trip A
& From Aided 1 Delta Trip A (if applicable)
From Aided 1 Distance Trip B
From Aided 1 Delta Trip B (if applicable)
& From Aided 1 Distance Trip C
From Aided 1 Delta Trip C (if applicable )
1013
Phase Select N From Aided 1 Distance Trip N
From Aided 1 Delta Trip N (if applicable )
Notes:
Aided 1 scheme only shown .
V03510
192 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
POR
522
Any Trip
&
Trip Inputs 3Ph
529 &
1 Echo Send
Send on Trip
None
Any Trip
& &
Any Trip
522 1 100ms
Send on Trip
Aided / Z1
&
Aid 1 Distance
Disabled
608 &
Zone 1 Trip 1
503
Aid 1 Dist Trip
505 &
Aid 1 DEF Trip 1
250 ms 100 ms
494
Aided 1 Receive
&
Aid. 1 Selection
POR
903
CB Open 3 ph 10 ms
904
CB1 Open A ph
912 &
CB2 Open A ph WI Sngl Pole Trp
905
1
CB1 Open B ph
& Disabled
913 &
CB2 Open B ph WI Trip Delay 642
906 & Aid1 WI Trip 3Ph
CB1 Open C ph
914 &
CB2 Open C ph 60 ms
Blk Send 637
833 Aid 1 WI Trip A
VTS Slow Block 638
Week Infeed
Aid 1 WI Trip B
Weak Infeed Snapshot Logic 639
&
Aided 1 WI V< A
1358 1
904
CB1 Open A ph &
912
CB2 Open A ph
1359
Aided 1 WI V< B
905
CB1 Open B ph &
913
CB2 Open B ph
1360
Aided 1 WI V< C
905
CB1 Open C ph &
913
CB2 Open C ph V03514
P446SV-TM-EN-1 193
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
492
Aided 1 COS/LGS
V03516
tReversal Guard
498
Aided 1 Send
1
Aided 1 Receive 494 tRGD 1 501
Aid1 Trip Enable
492
Aided 1 COS/LGS
V03517
194 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
Caution:
Aided Delta should not be used on a communications channel if that channel is being used to
implement an Aided Distance Scheme or an Aided DEF scheme. You should ensure that the Aided
Distance and Aided DEF elements are disabled if you want to apply the Aided Delta (Directional
Comparison Protection).
P446SV-TM-EN-1 195
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
R R
Z (T)
CRX CRX
CB CB
OPEN & Signalling Signalling & OPEN
Equipment Equipment
Trip G Trip H
1 1
TZ (T) TZ (T)
END G END H t
Z t Z
0 0
E03520
196 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
R R
Z (T)
CRX CRX
Signalling Signalling
Equipment Equipment
Trip G Trip H
1 1
E03521
P446SV-TM-EN-1 197
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
Aid. 1 Delta
Enabled
998
From Aided 1 DEF
Delta Dir Fwd AN
Signal Send
999
Delta Dir Fwd BN
Echo Send
1000
Delta Dir Fwd CN &
1 1 1
Delta Dir Fwd AB 1001 & &
1 498
1002
& Aided 1 Send
Delta Dir Fwd BC tRG
1003
Delta Dir Fwd CA
1005
Delta Dir Rev BN Aid1 Custom Send 497
1006
Delta Dir Rev CN &
1 Aid1 Block Send 496
Delta Dir Rev AB 1007
1008
Delta Dir Rev BC
Notes:
1009
Delta Dir Rev CA Aided 1 scheme only shown .
396
Aid1 Inhib Delta V03507
& 317
1 Aid 1 Chan Fail
&
t DR t DW
&
1
& 494
1 Aided 1 receive
1
& t PR
&
&
492
Aided 1 COS/LGS
&
493
Aided 1 Scheme Rx
&
Aid. 1 Selection
PUR Unblocking
POR Unblocking 1
Prog. Unblocking V03508
198 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
& 633
Delta Dir FWD AN 998 & 1 Aided 1 Trip A
1
& 634
Delta Dir FWD BN 999 & 1 Aided 1 Trip B
1
& 635
Delta Dir FWD CN 1000 & 1 Aided 1 Trip C
1
1001
Delta Dir FWD AB & 636
& 1 Aided 1 Trip N
1002
Delta Dir FWD BC 1
From Aided 1 Def Trip A
1003
Delta Dir FWD CA From Aided 1 Distance Trip A
From Aided 1 Def Trip B
From Aided 1 Distance Trip B
Notes: From Aided 1 Def Trip C
Aided 1 scheme only shown . From Aided 1 Distance Trip C
From Aided 1 Def Trip N
V03511 From Aided 1 Distance Trip N
P446SV-TM-EN-1 199
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
POR
522
Any Trip
&
Trip Inputs 3Ph
529 &
1 Echo Send
Send on Trip
None
Any Trip
& &
Any Trip
522 1 100ms
Send on Trip
Aided / Z1
&
Aid 1 Distance
Disabled
608 &
Zone 1 Trip 1
503
Aid 1 Dist Trip
505 &
Aid 1 DEF Trip 1
250 ms 100 ms
494
Aided 1 Receive
&
Aid. 1 Selection
POR
903
CB Open 3 ph 10 ms
904
CB1 Open A ph
912 &
CB2 Open A ph WI Sngl Pole Trp
905
1
CB1 Open B ph
& Disabled
913 &
CB2 Open B ph WI Trip Delay 642
906 & Aid1 WI Trip 3Ph
CB1 Open C ph
914 &
CB2 Open C ph 60 ms
Blk Send 637
833 Aid 1 WI Trip A
VTS Slow Block 638
Week Infeed
Aid 1 WI Trip B
Weak Infeed Snapshot Logic 639
&
Aided 1 WI V< A
1358 1
904
CB1 Open A ph &
912
CB2 Open A ph
1359
Aided 1 WI V< B
905
CB1 Open B ph &
913
CB2 Open B ph
1360
Aided 1 WI V< C
905
CB1 Open C ph &
913
CB2 Open C ph V03514
200 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
492
Aided 1 COS/LGS
V03516
tReversal Guard
498
Aided 1 Send
1
Aided 1 Receive 494 tRGD 1 501
Aid1 Trip Enable
492
Aided 1 COS/LGS
V03517
P446SV-TM-EN-1 201
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
7 APPLICATION NOTES
The time delay setting (Aid.1 Dist. Dly, Aid.2 Dist. Dly) should be set to 0 ms for fast fault clearance.
The time delay setting (Aid.1 Dist. Dly, Aid.2 Dist. Dly) should be set to 0 ms for fast fault clearance.
The POR scheme also uses the reverse looking zone 4 IED as a reverse fault detector. This is used in the current
reversal logic and in the optional weak infeed echo feature.
Weak Infeed
Where weak infeed tripping is employed, a typical voltage setting is 70% of rated phase-neutral voltage. Weak
infeed tripping is time delayed according to the WI Trip Delay value, usually set at 60ms.
To allow time for a blocking signal to arrive, a short time delay must be allowed before tripping (Aid.1 Dist. Dly, Aid.
2 Dist. Dly). The recommended delay is as follows:
● Recommended setting = Maximum signalling channel operating time + one power frequency cycle.
Note:
Two variants of a Blocking scheme are provided, Blocking 1 and Blocking 2. Both schemes operate similarly, except that the
reversal guard timer location in the logic changes. Blocking 2 may sometimes allow faster unblocking when a fault evolves
from external to internal, and hence a faster trip.
202 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
To allow time for a blocking signal to arrive, a short time delay on aided tripping must be used. The recommended
delay time setting (Aid. 1 DEF Dly., Aid. 2 DEF Dly.) is the maximum signalling channel operating time +20 ms.
The time delay (Aid. 1 Delta Dly, Aid. 2 Delta Dly) should be set to 0 ms for fast fault clearance.
Recommended delay setting (Aid. 1 Delta Dly, Aid. 2 Delta Dly): Maximum signalling channel operating time
+ 6ms.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 203
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
A B
Ia Ib
Zat
Zbt
Ic
Zct
Va
Va = Ia Zat + Ib Zbt C Impedance seen by relay A =
Ia
Ia = Ia + Ic
E03524
204 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
Carrier aided schemes can also be used in conjunction with distance elements to protect teed feeders. Although
Permissive Overreaching and Permissive Underreaching schemes may be used, they suffer some limitations.
Blocking schemes are generally considered to be the most suitable.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 205
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
(i) A B
(ii) A C
Z1A Z1B
(iii) A C B
No infeed
Figure 102: Problematic Fault Scenarios for PUR Scheme Application to Teed Feeders
● Scenario (i) shows a short tee connected to one nearby terminal and one distant terminal. In this case, Zone
1 elements set to 80% of the shortest connected feeder length don’t all overlap, resulting in a section not
covered by any Zone 1 element. Any fault in this section would rely on delayed Zone 2 tripping.
● Scenario (ii) shows an example where terminal C has no infeed. Distance elements at C may not operate for
faults close to the terminal. As the fault is outside the Zone 1 reaches of A and B, clearance will rely on
delayed Zone 2 tripping at A and B.
● Scenario (iii) shows an example where outfeed from terminal C feeds an internal fault via terminal B. In this
case, terminal C will not see the fault until the breaker at B has operated. The result would be sequential
(and hence delayed) tripping.
Note:
Triangulated simplex channels could be used in place of a common simplex one if prefered.
As with Permissive Underreaching (PUR) schemes, a limitation of a Blocking scheme implementation is a scenario
where outfeed from one terminal feeds an internal fault via another terminal. The terminal with the outfeed sees a
206 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes
reverse fault condition. This results in a blocking signal being sent to the two remote terminals. Although the fault
will be cleared, tripping will be prevented until the Zone 2 time delay has expired.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 207
Chapter 8 - Carrier Aided Schemes P446SV
208 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 9
NON-AIDED SCHEMES
Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes P446SV
210 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter describes the distance schemes that do not require communication between the ends (Non-Aided
Schemes).
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 211
Non-Aided Schemes 212
Basic Schemes 213
Trip On Close Schemes 217
Zone1 Extension Scheme 221
Loss of Load Scheme 222
P446SV-TM-EN-1 211
Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes P446SV
2 NON-AIDED SCHEMES
This product provides Distance protection. The Distance protection has been designed for use as a standalone
non-unit protection, or for use with communications systems to provide unit protection (Carrier Aided schemes).
Standalone operation provides basic scheme Distance protection (e.g. instantaneous Zone 1 operation, delayed
Zone 2 protection and further delayed Back-up protection, etc.). It also implements some special standalone
schemes that don’t require communications. These are known as Non-Aided Distance Schemes.
The non-aided schemes provided in this product can be divided into the following categories:
● Basic schemes
● Trip On Close schemes
● Zone 1 Extension scheme
● Loss of Load scheme
The settings for these Non-Aided Distance Schemes are located in the SCHEME LOGIC column.
212 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes
3 BASIC SCHEMES
Basic Scheme operation is always executed if distance elements are enabled. It is the process by which the
measured line impedance is compared against the Distance measuring zone configuration (reach settings and
timers). Instantaneous or time delayed tripping or blocking signals may be issued for a specific zone according to
its settings and the measured impedance values.
There are five basic scheme zones; Zone 1, Zone 2, Zone 3, Zone 4 and Zone P
The Basic Scheme settings include:
● A mode setting, which is common to all zones
● Zone Tripping settings for each zone
● Zone phase delay settings for each zone
● Zone ground delay settings for each zone
On a per-zone basis, phase and earth-fault elements may be set to have different time delays.
To supplement Basic Scheme operation, there are also standalone scheme designs (Non-Aided Distance Schemes)
that provide timely clearance for particular fault scenarios where carrier aided signalling is either not available, or
is unnecessary. These scenarios cover Trip on Closure (including Switch On to Fault, and Trip on Reclose), Loss of
Load, and Zone1 Extension.
The Basic Scheme is continually executed, regardless of any carrier-aided acceleration schemes which may be
enabled.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 213
Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes P446SV
Enabled
&
960
Zone1 AN Element
961
Zone1 BN Element & 1
962
Zone 1 CN Element
384 &
Block Zone 1 Gnd
Enabled
&
963
Zone1 AB Element
964
Zone1 BC Element & 1
965
Zone1 CA Element
385 &
Block Zone 1 Phs
Note: The logic circuits for Zone 2 to Zone P follow the same principles as Zone 1 V02738-1
741
Zone1 Ph Status 1 Zone 1 A Start
Enabled
742
963
1 Zone 1 B Start
Zone1 AB Element &
743
963
1 Zone 1 C Start
Zone1 BC Element &
744
965
1 Zone 1 N Start
Zone1 CA Element &
385
Block Zone 1 Phs Note: This diagram shows Zone 1 only . The other zones follow the same principles . V02737
214 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes
1691
Any Dist Start
608
Zone 1 Ground Elements 1 Zone 1 Trip
612
1 Zone 1 N Trip
tZ1 Ph. Delay
&
&
&
Note: This diagram shows Zone 1 only. The other zones follow the same principles . V02738-2
P446SV-TM-EN-1 215
Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes P446SV
Zone 3
Zone 2
Zone 1
Z B
Z
Zone 1
Zone 2
Zone 3
Typical application
Relay A Relay B
Z1 TZ1 TZ1 Z1
Trip A Trip B
1 1
ZP TZP TZP ZP
Z2 TZ2 TZ2 Z2
Z3 TZ3 TZ3 Z3
Z4 Z4
TZ4 TZ4
216 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes
SOTF provides instantaneous operation of selected elements if a fault is present when manual closure of the circuit
breaker is performed.
TOR provides instantaneous operation of selected elements if a persistent fault is present when the circuit breaker
attempts autoreclosure
The SOTF and TOR functions are known as Trip on Close logic. Both methods operate in parallel if mapped to the
SOTF and TOR Tripping matrix in the setting file.
The settings for Switch on to Fault (SOTF) and Trip on Reclose (TOR) are located in the TRIP ON CLOSE section of the
SCHEME LOGIC column.
SOTF and TOR are complemented by Current No Voltage level detectors (also known as CNV level detectors). These
CNV level detectors are set using the voltage and current settings located in the CB FAIL & P.DEAD column. The
same settings are used for pole dead logic detection. A 20ms time delay in the logic avoids a possible race
between very fast overvoltage and undercurrent level detectors.
The following figures show the Trip On Close function in relation to the Distance zones and the Trip On Close
function when driven by Current No Volt level detectors.
TOR Status
Enabled
878
Inhibit TOR 485 & TOR Active
891
Any Pole Dead S 877
Q TOC Active
R
TOC Delay
SOTF Pulse
SOTF Status
Enabled PoleDead 1
En Pdead + Pulse
Enabled ExtPulse 1
488 &
Set SOTF
V02742
P446SV-TM-EN-1 217
Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes P446SV
559
Fast OV PHA
864
&
IA < Start
560 20 ms
Fast OV PHB 556
865 & 1 CNV ACTIVE
IB < Start 0
561
Fast OV PHC
866 &
IC< Start
TOR Tripping
Current No Volts
556 557
CNV ACTIVE & TOR Trip CNV
878
TOR Active
SOTF Tripping
Current No Volts
556 558
CNV ACTIVE & SOTF Trip CNV
879
SOTF Active
V02743
The Current No Volt (‘CNV’) level detectors can be set in the CB FAIL & P.DEAD column The same settings are used
for pole dead logic detection. A 20ms time delay in the logic avoids a possible race between very fast overvoltage
and undercurrent level detectors.
218 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes
When busbar voltage transformers are used, the Pole Dead’ signal is not produced. Connect circuit breaker
auxiliary contacts for correct operation. This is not necessary if the SOTF is activated by an external pulse.
● SOTF Delay: The time chosen should be longer than the slowest delayed-auto-reclose dead time, but
shorter than the time in which the system operator might re-energise a circuit once it had opened/tripped.
We recommend 110 seconds as a typical setting.
● SOTF Pulse: Typically this could be set to at 500ms. This time is enough to establish completely the voltage
memory of distance protection.
● TOC Reset Delay: We recommend 500ms as a typical setting (chosen to be in excess of the 16 cycles length
of memory polarizing, allowing full memory charging before normal protection resumes).
SOTF Tripping
Zone 1 709
& SOTF Trip Zone 1
879
SOTF Active
960
Zone1 AN Element
961
Zone1 BN Element Note: This diagram shows Zone 1 only. The other zones follow the same
Zone1 CN Element 962 principles.
963 1
Zone 1 AB Element
964
Zone1 BC Element
965
Zone1 CA Element V02756
560 20 ms
Fast OV PHB 556
865 & 1 CNV ACTIVE
IB < Start 0
561
Fast OV PHC
866 & 558
IC< Start & SOTF Trip CNV
879
SOTF Active
SOTF Tripping
Current No Volts V02758
P446SV-TM-EN-1 219
Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes P446SV
While the Trip on Reclose Mode is active, the protection trips instantaneously for pick up of any selected Distance
zone. You select the zone with the TOR Tripping setting. For example, Zone 2 could operate without waiting for the
usual time delay if a fault is in Zone 2 on CB closure. Also Current No Volts can be mapped for fast fault clearance
on line reclosure on a permanent fault. To operate for faults on the entire circuit length, at least Zone 1 and Zone 2
should be selected. If no elements are selected, the normal time delayed elements and aided scheme provide the
protection. TOR tripping is three-phase and auto-reclose is blocked.
TOR Tripping
Zone 1 704
& TOR Trip Zone 1
878
TOR Active
960
Zone1 AN Element
961
Zone1 BN Element
962
Zone1 CN Element Note: This diagram shows Zone 1 only. The other zones follow the same
963 1
Zone 1 AB Element principles.
964
Zone1 BC Element
965
Zone1 CA Element V02755
560 20 ms
Fast OV PHB 556
865 & 1 CNV ACTIVE
IB < Start 0
561
Fast OV PHC
866 & 557
IC< Start & TOR Trip CNV
878
TOR Active
TOR Tripping
Current No Volts V02757
220 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes
Z1 Extension (A)
ZL
A Z1A B
Z1 Extension (B)
E02739
In this scheme Zone 1X is enabled and set to overreach the protected line. A fault on the line, including one in the
end 20% not covered by Zone 1, results in instantaneous tripping followed by autoreclosure. Zone 1X has resistive
reaches and residual compensation similar to Zone 1. The autorecloser is used to inhibit tripping from Zone 1X so
that on reclosure the device operates with Basic scheme logic only, to co-ordinate with downstream protection for
permanent faults. Therefore transient faults on the line are cleared instantaneously, which reduces the probability
of a transient fault becoming permanent. However, the scheme can operate for some faults on an adjacent line,
although this is followed by autoreclosure with correct protection discrimination. Increased circuit breaker
operations would occur, together with transient loss of supply to a substation.
Fault trip Z1X time delay
First fault trip = tZ1
Fault trip for persistent fault on auto-reclose = tZ2
The Zone 1 extension scheme can be disabled, permanently enabled or just brought into service when the
communication channel fails and the aided scheme is inoperative. If used in conjunction with a channel-aided
scheme, Z1X can be set to be enabled when Ch1 or Ch2 fails, or when all channels fail, or when any channel fails.
490
Reset Zone 1 Ext 876
& Z1 X Active
Z1 Ext Scheme
Enabled
En. on Ch 1 Fail 1
&
En. on Ch 2 Fail
En. All Ch Fail
En. Any Ch Fail &
&
&
317
Aid 1 Chan Fail
318 1
Aid 2 Chan Fail
V02754
P446SV-TM-EN-1 221
Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes P446SV
Zone 2 IED1
Zone 1 IED 1
Zone 1 IED 2
Zone 2 IED 2
IED 1 IED 2
V02740
Any fault in the reach of Zone 1 results in fast tripping of the local circuit breaker. For an end zone fault for IED 1
(near IED 2) with remote infeed (from IED 2), the remote breaker is tripped in Zone 1 by the remote device at IED 2.
The local device (IED 1) can recognise this by detecting loss of load current in the healthy phases. This condition, in
conjunction with operation of a Zone 2 comparator at IED 1P, can be used to trip the local circuit breaker.
Before an accelerated trip can occur, load current must be detected before the fault. The loss of load current
opens a window during which time a trip occurs if a Zone 2 comparator operates. A typical setting for this window
is 40ms as shown in the figure below, although this can be altered in the LoL Window setting. The accelerated trip
is delayed by 18ms to prevent initiation of a loss of load trip due to circuit breaker pole discrepancy occurring for
clearance of an external fault. The local fault clearance time can be deduced as follows:
t = Z1d + 2CB + LDr + 18ms
where:
● Z1d = Maximum downstream zone 1 trip time
● CB = Breaker operating time
● LDr = Upstream level detector (LOL <1) reset time
For circuits with load tapped off the protected line, care must be taken in setting the loss of load feature to ensure
that the undercurrent level detector setting is above the tapped load current. When selected, the loss of load
feature operates with the main distance scheme that is selected. This provides high speed clearance for end zone
faults when the Basic scheme is selected or, with permissive signal aided tripping schemes, it provides high speed
back up clearance for end zone faults if the channel fails.
Note:
Loss of load tripping is only available where three pole tripping is used.
222 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes
Note:
Assertion of the Any Trip DDB signal or the Inhibit LOL DDB signal will prevent LOL tripping.
LOL Scheme
Enabled
En. On Ch1 Fail 1
&
En. On Ch2 Fail
En. All Ch Fail
En. Any Ch Fail &
&
&
317
Aid 1 Chan Fail
318 1
Aid 2 Chan Fail
Tripping Mode
3 Pole
491 1 18 ms
Inhibit LoL & SD
654
Q Loss ofLoad Trip
Any trip 522 R
LOL Window
1365
I> LoL A
1366
I> LoL B &
1367
tLOL
I> LoL C
966 &
Zone2 AN Element
967 &
Zone2 BN Element
968 &
Zone2 CN Element
1
969 &
Zone2 AB Element
970 &
Zone2 BC Element
971 &
Zone2 CA Element V02741
P446SV-TM-EN-1 223
Chapter 9 - Non-Aided Schemes P446SV
224 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 10
226 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter describes special blocking and protection functions, which use Power swing Analysis.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 227
Introduction to Power Swing Blocking 228
Power Swing Blocking 230
Out of Step Protection 241
P446SV-TM-EN-1 227
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV
Note:
Power swings do not involve earth, so only phase-phase impedances are affected.
For stable power swings, distance protection should not trip. To prevent tripping, a Power Swing Blocking (PSB)
function is usually provided to compliment Distance protection.
For unstable power swings, there may be a strategy for instigating a controlled system split. In this case, distance
protection should not trip during loss of stability. If unstable power swings or Pole-Slipping conditions might be
expected, certain points on the network may be designated as split points, where the network should be split if
unstable (or potentially unstable) conditions occur. Strategic splitting of the system can be achieved by means of
dedicated Out-of-Step Tripping protection (OOS or OST protection). Or it may be possible to achieve splitting by
strategically limiting the duration for which the operation of a specific distance protection is blocked during power
swing conditions.
A method often used to help understand power system stability and Pole Slipping is called Equal Area Criterion.
This is based on a number of operational curves as outlined in the figure below:
Power Curve 1
Area 2
F Area 1
A E G
Po
Out of step
D
Curve 2
Curve 3
C
B
θ
0º θ0 θ1 90º θ2 θ3 180º
Phase angle difference between two ends
V02762
Figure 117: Power transfer related to angular difference between two generation sources
The figure describes the behaviour of a power system with parallel lines connecting two sources of generation.
● Curve 1 represents pre-fault system operation through parallel lines where the transmitted power is Po.
● Curve 2 represents transmitted power during a phase-phase-earth fault.
● Curve 3 represents a new power curve when the faulted line is tripped.
228 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions
At fault inception, the operating point A moves to B, which is a reduced power transfer level. There is, therefore, a
surplus of power (A to B) at that sending end and a corresponding deficit of power at the receiving end. The
sending end generators start to speed up, and the receiving end generators start to slow down, so the phase
angle θ increases, and the operating point moves along curve 2 until the fault is cleared (point C). At this point, the
phase angle is θ1. The operating point now moves to point D on curve 3 which represents the power transfer curve
when just one line is in service. There is still a power surplus at the sending end and a deficit at the receiving end,
so the generators continue to lose synchronism and the operating point moves further along curve 3.
If, at some point between E and G (point F) the generators are rotating at the same speed, the phase angle will
stop increasing. According to the Equal Area Criterion, this occurs when Area 2 is equal to Area 1. The sending end
will now start to slow down and receiving end to speed up. Therefore, the phase angle starts to decrease and the
operating point moves back towards E. As the operating point passes E, the net sending end deficit again becomes
a surplus and the receiving end surplus becomes a deficit, so the sending end generators begin to speed up and
the receiving end generators begin to slow down. With no losses, the system operating point will oscillate around
point E on curve 3, but in practise the oscillation is damped, and the system eventually settles at operating point E.
So, if Area 1 is less than Area 2, the system will oscillate but will stay in synchronism. This swing is usually called a
recoverable, or stable, power swing. If, on the contrary, the system passes point G with a further increase in angle
difference between sending and receiving ends, the system loses synchronism and becomes unstable. This will
happen if the initial power transfer Po is so high that the Area 1 is greater than Area 2. This power swing is not
recoverable and is usually called an Out-of-Step condition or a Pole Slip condition. In such a case, only system
separation and subsequent re-synchronising of the generators can restore normal system operation.
The point G is shown at approximately 120°, but this can vary. If, for example, the pre-fault transmitted power (Po)
was high and the fault clearance was slow, Area 1 would be greater. For the system to recover from this case, the
angle θ would be closer to 90º. Similarly, if the pre-fault transmitted power Po was low and fault clearance fast,
Area 1 would be small, and the angle θ could go closer to 180º with the system remaining stable.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 229
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV
230 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions
Start of
power swing End of
power swing
i (t)
3 cycles
PH1
PH2
t1 t2 t3
t 2: Threshold 2 invoked. PH2 goes low on account of threshold being increased . PH1 remains high,
because there continues to be a D i
t 3: PH1 goes low as power swing has diminished and D i goes below threshold 1
V02769
Figure 118: Phase selector timing for power swing condition
i (t)
PH1
PH2
t1 t2 t3
t2: Fault current value appears in 2 cycle buffer . This equals present fault current value so D i is reduced to
zero. PH1 therefore goes low. PH2 remains high because value in PH 2 memory is a stored value .
t3: Fault is cleared so PH 2 goes low. PH1 stays low even though there is a new D I, because the absolute
current value is also taken into consideration .
V02770
P446SV-TM-EN-1 231
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV
Start of
power swing
i (t)
3 cycles
PH1
PH2
t1 t2 t3 t4 t5
t2: Threshold 2 invoked (10%In). PH2 goes low on account of threshold being increased (from 5%IN to 10%In).
PH1 remains high, because there continues to be a D i
Figure 120: Phase selector timing for fault during a power swing
Note:
If the Slow Swing feature is not Enabled, very slow power swings (< 0.5 Hz) may not be detected.
The Slow Swing method is based on changing impedance measurements and uses a pair of configurable
concentric quadrilateral zones on the impedance plane (Zone 7 and Zone 8). Since power swings don’t involve
earth, the impedance measurements are based on positive sequence quantities and only phase-phase
measurements are necessary. The characteristic is shown in the following figure:
232 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions
+jX
PSB Z8 Zone 8
PSB Z7 Zone 7
Dt
ZL
Z1 = V1/I1
PSB Z7'
PSB Z8'
V02744
The elapsed time defines the rate of change of impedance. If the rate of change is high, the change is due to a
fault. If the rate of change is low, the protection indicates a slow power swing. So, if the time taken for the
impedance trajectory to pass through zone 8 into zone 7 is greater than the time defined by the PSB timer, a slow
power swing is deemed to be in progress. If the time taken for the impedance trajectory to pass through zone 8
into zone 7 is less than that defined by the PSB timer, it is deemed to be a fault.
In other words, a power swing is indicated if the following condition is true:
Dt > PSB Timer
Both Zone 7 and Zone 8 characteristics are based on the positive sequence impedance measurement; Z1 = V1/I1.
The minimum current (sensitivity) needed for Zone 7 and Zone 8 measurements is 5%In.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 233
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV
The PSB timer setting defines the minimum time that the impedance trajectory must take to cross through zone 8
into zone 7 (Dt) before a power swing is deemed to have taken place. A power swing is indicated if Dt > PSB Timer.
234 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions
Note:
The PSB Unblock dly timer is common to all elements.
The PSB Unblock dly is used to time the duration for which the swing is present. The intention is to allow the
distinction between a stable and an unstable swing. If after the timeout period the swing has still not stabilised, the
block for selected zones can be released (unblocking), giving the opportunity to split the system. If no unblocking is
required, set to maximum (10 s).
There is a further timer associated with the PSB function. This is the PSB Reset Delay timer. This timer is provided to
maintain the power swing detection for a period after the superimposed current detection (ΔI) has reset. ΔI
naturally tends to zero twice during each power swing cycle (around the current maxima and minima in the swing
element). A short time delay ensures continued PSB pick-up during these ΔI minima.
The PSB Reset Delay is used to maintain the PSB status when DI naturally is low during the swing cycle (near the
current maxima and minima in the swing envelope). A typical setting of 0.2s is used to seal-in the detection until DI
has chance to appear again.
The WI Trip PSB setting determines what will happen if a power swing is detected whilst the Weak Infeed (WI)
tripping feature is being used and the WI condition is present for longer than the WI Trip Delay time. If Blocking
is selected, the weak infeed operation will be disabled for the duration of the swing. If Delayed Unblock is
chosen, the weak infeed element block will be removed after drop off timer PSB Unblock dly has expired, even if
the swing is still present. This allows system separation when swings fail to stabilise. In Allow trip mode, the
weak infeed element is unaffected by power swing detection.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 235
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV
jX
Zone x
-10°
Blind Region
Blind Region
20%
-jX
V02775
The area is defined by lines created with angles fixed at 10° closer to the resistive axis than those created by the
load blinder angle setting (Load/B Angle - 10°) and a circular arc with a radius concentric with, and equivalent
to 20% greater than, the load blinder impedance setting (Z< Blinder Imp + 20%).
This is clearly indicated with reference to the diagram.
Note:
This power swing conditions are completely independent of the slow swing associated with Zone 7 and Zone 8.
236 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions
Power Swing
Blocking
1691
Any Dist Start 3 cycles
t 0 1014
& P Swing Detector
Ph1 0 t
t
1 & Block selected element
0 &
PSB Unblocking
Enabled
PSB Z7
PSB Z8 607
Slow PSB
PSB Z 7' Detector
PSB Z 8' Module
Quad
PSB R7 characteristic
PSB R8 definition
PSB R7'
PSB R8'
Alpha
V02745
Note:
This is a simplified representation to highlight the outputs of the Power Swing Blocking function.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 237
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV
Whichever power swing detector is responsible for applying PSB, the removal of PSB is defined by two settings –
the PSB Reset Delay and (if an unblocking philosophy is employed) the PSB Unblock dly.
Maximum Load
½ Rx Ph. Resistive
V02750
a = ÐZT
238 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions
+jX
Zone 8
Zone 7
ZR
ZL α = ÐZ T
ZT
Resistive reverse (R’) Resistive forward (+R)
ZS
V02751
(θ1 − θ 2 ) ⋅ f nom
∆t =
f PS
where
● angles q1 and q2 are defined in the following figure
● fnom is the nominal frequency
● fPS is the maximum Power Swing frequency to be taken into account
Since any power swing with fPS >= 0.5Hz can be detected by the setting-free delta current algorithm, only power
swings with fPS < 0.5Hz Hz need to be considered for Slow Power Swing detection. We recommended setting fPS to
1Hz because this value provides sufficient security margin.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 239
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV
ZR Zone 7 Zone 8
ZL
ZT
2 q1
q2
ZT
ZS
V02752
240 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions
+jX
OST Z6 Zone 6
OST Z5 Zone 5
OST Z5'
OST Z6'
V02760
P446SV-TM-EN-1 241
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV
The OST principle uses positive sequence impedances. The positive sequence impedance is calculated as Z1 =
V1/I1, where V1 and I1 are the positive sequence voltage and current quantities derived from the measured phase
quantities. The concentric quadrilaterals are designated Zone 5 and Zone 6. Zone 5 encompasses possible system
fault impedances and sits within Zone 6. Because OST and Predictive OST quadrilaterals are based on positive
sequence impedances, all OST conditions are covered by a single measurement. Both quadrilaterals are
independent and have independent reach settings.
All four resistive blinders are parallel, using the common angle setting (a) that corresponds to the angle of the total
system impedance (ZT = ZS + ZL + ZR), where ZS and ZR are equivalent positive sequence impedances at the
sending and receiving ends and ZL positive sequence line impedance. The reactance lines are also parallel as
neither reactance line tilting nor esidual compensation is implemented.
In the figure, the purple solid impedance trajectory represents the locus for the non-recoverable power sawing,
known as a pole slip or Out Of Step condition. The dotted green impedance trajectory represents a recoverable
power swing.
As the tripping mode for the detected Out-of-Step condition is always three-phase, the Pred. OST and OST DDB
signals are mapped to the three-phase tripping signal in the default programmable scheme logic.
242 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions
The Out-of-Step tripping time delay (Tost), delays the OST tripping command until the angle between internal
voltages between the two ends are at 240 degrees closing towards 360 degrees. This limits the voltage stress
across the circuit breaker. If a fault occurs during the swing condition, the Out-of-Step tripping function is blocked.
The Out-of-Step algorithm is completely independent from the distance elements and the power swing detection
function. The load blinder does not affect the OST characteristics. In common with other similar functions, a
minimum positive sequence current of 5%In is needed for Out-of-Step operation.
OST Mode
553
OST Disabled & OST
& Polarity Reversed?
Pred. OST Trip
1 & Polarity detector
Pred. & OST Trip Reset function
& Not reversed
OST Trip & ≥
1 1 &
555
Start Z6
Setting OST Trip is the most commonly used approach when this protection is applied. OST Trip should be
used when Out-of-Step conditions are probable. If Out-of-Step conditions are detected, the OST command will be
issued to split the system at the pre-determined points. A disadvantage of the OST Trip option compared with
the ‘Predictive’ options is that tripping will take a little longer so that the power oscillations may escalate further
after separation and the split parts may become separately unstable. An advantage, however, is that the decision
P446SV-TM-EN-1 243
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV
to split the system will always be valid even if the accurate system data and setting parameters cannot be
obtained.
The predictive setting options Pred. OST Trip and Pred. & OST Trip are recommended for systems
where Out-of-Step conditions could possibly occur, and where an early system split should minimise the phase
shift between generation sources. This should maximise the chances for the separated parts of the system to
stabilise as quickly as possible. Special care must be taken when these settings are used to ensure that the circuit
breakers at the different terminals do not open when the voltages at different ends are in anti-phase. This is
because most circuit breakers are not designed to break current at double the nominal voltage. Attempting to
break the current at double the nominal voltage could lead to flash-over and circuit breaker damage.
‘Predictive’ settings are designed to detect and trip for fast power oscillations. When predictive tripping is used
with a circuit breaker capable of operating in typically two-cycles, the two voltages angles may rapidly move in
opposite directions at the time of opening the circuit breaker. So, if you use the predictive settings you need to
apply settings that will ensure that the circuit breaker opening occurs well before the phase difference between
the different terminals approaches 180º. This means that accurate settings can only be determined by exhaustive
system studies.
The setting Pred. & OST Trip provides two stages of OST. If a power system oscillation is very fast, the
combination of ∆R (the difference between the Zone 5 and Zone 6 resistive reaches), and the Delta T settings, must
be set so that Pred. OST Trip operates. If the oscillation is slower, the condition for the predictive OST is not
met and so tripping is dictated by the OST condition being met. For the OST condition to be met, the resistive
component of the impedance must leave Zone 5 with opposite polarity compared with when it entered. If the
polarity is opposite when Zone 5 resets, OST will trip. If the polarity is the same when Zone 5 resets, OST will not
trip. This distinguishes between a slower non-recoverable oscillation and recoverable swings.
You should disable OST for applications on lines where unrecoverable power oscillations are not expected, or not
expected to be severe. This is likely to apply to strong interconnected systems operating with three-phase tripping.
+jX
OST Z6 Zone 6
OST Z5 Zone 5
OST Z5'
OST Z6'
V02763
Figure 129: OST setting determination for the positive sequence resistive component OST R5
244 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions
ZT is the total system positive sequence impedance equal to ZS + ZL + ZR, where ZS and ZR are the equivalent
positive sequence impedances at the sending and receiving ends and ZL is the positive sequence line impedance.
θ is the angular difference between the voltages at the sending and receiving ends beyond which no system
recovery is possible.
To determine the settings for OST, the minimum inner resistive reach of OST R5 (R5min) needs to be calculated.
The figure above shows that:
R5min = (ZT/2) / tan(θ/2
Next the maximum (limit value) for the outer resistive reach OST R6 (R6 max) needs to be calculated. Referring to
the figure below, point A must not overlap with the load area for the worst assumed power factor of 0.85 and the
lowest possible ZT angle α.
+jX
OST Z6 Zone 6
ZT LOAD
OST Z6'
V02764
β = 32 + 90 – α
Z load min = OA
Where:
● Z load min is the minimum load impedance radius
● 32º is the load angle that corresponds to the lower power factor of 0.85
● α is the load blinder angle (Blinder Angle) that matches the ZT angle
Therefore:
R6max < Z load min(Cos β)
Starting from the limit values R5min and R6max, the actual OST R5 and OST R6 reaches will be set in conjunction
with the Delta T setting.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 245
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV
Note:
The R6max reach must be greater than the maximum resistive reach of any distance zone to ensure correct initiation of the
25 ms and Delta T timers. However, the R5min reach could be set below the distance maximum resistive reach (inside the
distance characteristic) if an extensive resistive coverage is required, meaning that Out-of-Step protection does not pose a
restriction to the quadrilateral applications.
For each zone, we receommend setting the positive and negative limits to be the same so, OST R5’ = OST R5, OST
Z5’ = OST Z5, OST R6’ = OST R6, and OST Z6’ = OST Z6.
Note:
You cannot assume that the rate-of-change of positive sequence impedance while crossing the OST R6 – OST R5 region is the
same as the average rate-of-change of positive sequence impedance for the whole swing cycle. A false assumumption could
lead to incorrect predictive OST operation.
Note:
For a fault, the OST R6 – OST R5 region will be crossed faster than 25ms, therefore even very fast oscillations up to 7Hz will
not be mistaken as a fault condition and predictive OST will not operate.
OST setting
For the OST Trip setting option, such a precise setting of the blinders and Delta T is not necessary. This is
because for a wide ∆R region and a short Delta T setting, any oscillation will be successfully detected. However,
the fault impedance must pass through the ∆R region faster than the Delta T setting.
246 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions
Therefore, for the OST Trip setting, assume that θ = 120° and set:
● OST R5 = OST R5’ = R5min = ZT/3.46
● OST R6 = OST R6’ = R6max
● Delta T = 30 ms
Delta T always expires. Therefore, the setting value given above will secure the detection of a wide range of
oscillations, starting from very slow oscillations (caused by recoverable swings) up to a fastest oscillation limit of
7Hz. Note that any fault impedance will pass the OST R6 – OST R5 region faster than the minimum settable Delta T
time of 30ms.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 247
Chapter 10 - Power Swing Functions P446SV
+jX
OST Z6 Zone 6
OST Z5 Zone 5
DR
OST trip
MOVs operation
ZL
OST R6' OST R5'
Resistive reverse (R’) OST R5 OST R6
Resistive forward (+R)
OST Z5'
OST Z6'
V02765
Note:
If the OST Trip setting is chosen, the timer when triggered, will eventually expire as the power oscillations progress, therefore
the MOV operation will not have any impact on Out-of-Step operation.
248 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 11
AUTORECLOSE
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
250 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
Selected models of this product provide sophisticated Autoreclose (AR) functionality. The purpose of this chapter is
to describe the operation of this functionality including the principles, logic diagrams and applications.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 251
Introduction to Autoreclose 252
Autoreclose Implementation 253
Autoreclose System Map 261
Logic Modules 289
Setting Guidelines 341
P446SV-TM-EN-1 251
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
2 INTRODUCTION TO AUTORECLOSE
Approximately 80 - 90% of faults on transmission lines and distribution feeders are transient in nature. This means
that most faults do not last long, and are self-clearing if isolated. A common example of a transient fault is an
insulator flashover, which may be caused, for example, by lightning, clashing conductors, or wind-blown debris.
Protection functions detecting the flashover will cause one or more circuit breakers to trip and may also remove
the fault. If the source is removed, the fault does not recur if the line is re-energised.
The remaining 10 – 20% of faults are either semi-permanent or permanent. A small tree branch falling onto the
line for example, could cause a semi-permanent fault. Here the cause of the fault would not be removed by
immediate tripping of the circuit, but could possibly be burnt away during a time-delayed trip. Permanent faults
could be broken conductors, transformer faults, cable faults or machine faults, which must be located and
repaired before the power supply can be restored. In many fault incidents, if the faulty line is immediately tripped
out, and time is allowed for the fault arc to de-ionise, reclosing the circuit breakers will result in the line being
successfully re-energised.
Autoreclose schemes are used to automatically reclose a circuit breaker a set time after it has been opened due to
operation of a protection element. On EHV transmission networks, Autoreclose is usually characterised by high-
speed single-phase operation for the first attempt at reclosure. This is intended to help maintain system stability
during a transient fault condition. On HV/MV distribution networks, Autoreclose is applied mainly to radial feeders,
where system stability problems do not generally arise, and is generally characterised by delayed three-phase
operation with potentially multiple reclosure attempts.
Autoreclosing provides an important benefit on circuits using time-graded protection, in that it allows the use of
instantaneous protection to provide a high speed first trip. With fast tripping, the duration of the power arc
resulting from an overhead line fault is reduced to a minimum. This lessens the chance of damage to the line,
which might otherwise cause a transient fault to develop into a permanent fault. Using instantaneous protection
also prevents blowing of fuses in teed feeders, as well as reducing circuit breaker maintenance by eliminating pre-
arc heating. When instantaneous protection is used with Autoreclose, the scheme is normally arranged to block
the instantaneous protection after the first trip. Therefore, if the fault persists after re-closure, the time-graded
protection will provide discriminative tripping resulting in the isolation of the faulted section. However, for certain
applications, where the majority of the faults are likely to be transient, it is common practise to allow more than
one instantaneous trip before the instantaneous protection is blocked.
Some schemes allow a number of re-closures and time-graded trips after the first instantaneous trip, which may
result in the burning out and clearance of semi-permanent faults. Such a scheme may also be used to allow fuses
to operate in teed feeders where the fault current is low.
When considering feeders that are partly overhead line and partly underground cable, any decision to install
Autoreclose should be subject to analysis of the data (knowledge of the frequency of transient faults). This is
because this type of arrangement probably has a greater proportion of semi-permanent and permanent
faults than for purely overhead feeders. In this case, the advantages of Autoreclose are small. It can even be
disadvantageous because re-closing on to a faulty cable is likely to exacerbate the damage.
252 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
3 AUTORECLOSE IMPLEMENTATION
Before describing this function it is first necessary to understand the following terminology:
● A Shot is an attempt to close a circuit breaker using the Autoreclose function.
● Multi-shot is where more than one Shot is attempted.
● Single-shot is where only one Shot is attempted.
● Dead Time denotes the time between initiation of the Autoreclose operation and the attempt to close the
circuit breaker.
● Reclaim time is the time following the initiation of the circuit breaker closing and the resetting of the
Autoreclose scheme should the Autoreclose attempt be successful and the protection does not detect a
subsequent fault condition.
● High-speed Autoreclose is generally regarded as an Autoreclose application where the Dead Time is less
than 1 second.
● Delayed Autoreclose is generally regarded as an Autoreclose application where the Dead Time is greater
than 1 second.
This product features a multiple-shot Autoreclose function, which is suitable for both High-speed Autoreclose and
Delayed Autoreclose.
The Autoreclose function can be set to perform a single-shot, two-shot, three-shot or four-shot cycle. Dead Times
for all shots can be adjusted independently.
If a circuit breaker closes successfully at the end of the Dead Time, a Reclaim Time starts. If the circuit breaker
does not trip again, the Autoreclose function resets at the end of the Reclaim Time. If the protection trips again
during the Reclaim Time, the sequence advances to the next shot in the programmed cycle. If all programmed
reclose attempts have been made and the circuit breaker does not remain closed, the Autoreclose function goes
into Lockout, whereupon manual intervention is required.
An Autoreclose cycle can be initiated by operation of an internal or external protection element provided it is
mapped correctly, and that the circuit breaker is closed when the protection operates.
You can choose to initiate the Dead Time on:
● Protection operation
● A protection reset
● A Line Dead condition
● Circuit breaker operation
At the end of the relevant Dead Time, provided system conditions are suitable, a circuit breaker close signal is
given. The system conditions to be met for closing are that:
● the system voltages are in synchronism
● or that the dead line/live bus or live line/dead bus conditions exist as indicated by the internal system check
synchronising element
● and that the circuit breaker closing spring, or other energy source, is fully charged as indicated by the circuit
breaker healthy input.
The circuit breaker close signal is removed when the circuit breaker closes.
If the protection trips and the circuit breaker opens during the Reclaim Time, the Autoreclose function either
advances to the next shot in the programmed cycle, or if all programmed reclose attempts have been made, goes
into Lockout. Each time a closure is attempted, a sequence counter is incremented by 1 and the Reclaim Time
starts again.
Autoreclose is configured in the AUTORECLOSE column of the relevant settings group. The function is disabled by
default. If you wish to use it you must enable it first in the CONFIGURATION column.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 253
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
The Autoreclose function is a logic controller implemented in software. It takes inputs and processes them
according to defined logic to generates appropriate outputs. The logic is controlled by user prescribed settings and
commands. The controlling logic is complex and so, in order to facilitate its design and understanding, it is
decomposed into smaller logic functions which, when combined together implement the complete scheme. This
section concludes with a summary of:
● the logic inputs to the Autoreclose function,
● the logic outputs from the Autoreclose function
● the Autoreclose operating sequence
● the high-level design of the system logic functionality
254 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
It can also be used if an Autoreclose cycle is likely to fail for conditions associated with the protected circuit, such
as during the Dead Time, if a circuit breaker indicates that it is not healthy to switch.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 255
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
Note:
In a multi-shot AR sequence, a number of Dead Timers are used (one for each shot). All Dead Timers are enabled when the
sequence is initiated, but each timer only starts when the particular shot with which it is associated is triggered.
Protection Trip
AR in Progress
CB Open
Dead Time
Auto -close
Reclaim Time
Successful Autoreclose
V03395
Following fault inception, the protection operates and issues a trip signal. At the same time the Autoreclose in
Progress signal is asserted. Shortly afterwards the circuit breaker will open as indicated by the CB Open signal.
Opening of the CB clears the fault and the protection resets. When this happens, the Dead Timer is started and the
output remains high until the Dead Time setting expires, whereupon it resets and the Autorecloser issues the Auto-
close command to close the circuit breaker. As the fault has been cleared, the circuit breaker closes and remains
closed. When the Auto-close pulse is removed, the Reclaim Timer starts. If no further fault is detected before the
Reclaim Timer expires, the Autoreclose is considered to be successful and this is indicated by the Successful
Autoreclose signal.
256 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
Protection Trip
AR in Progress
CB Open
Dead Time
Auto-close
Reclaim Time
Successful Autoreclose
Autoreclose Lockout
V03396
AR in Progress
CB Open
Dead Time
Auto -close
Reclaim Time
Successful Autoreclose
Autoreclose Lockout
V03397
Figure 134: Autoreclose sequence for an evolving or permanent fault - single-phase operation
P446SV-TM-EN-1 257
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
Protection Trip
CB1 AR in Progress
CB2 AR in Progress
CB1 Open
CB2 Open
Dead Time
Follower Time
Reclaim Time
V03398
Following fault inception, the protection operates and issues a trip signal. At the same time an Autoreclose in
Progress signal is asserted for each CB. Shortly afterwards, CB1 will open as indicated by the CB1 Open signal and
after a short delay CB2 opens. Opening of CB2 clears the fault and the protection resets. When this happens, the
Dead Timer is started and the output remains high until the Dead Time setting expires, whereupon it resets and the
Autorecloser issues the Auto-close command to close CB1. When CB1 closes, the Follower Timer starts. When the
Follower Timer expires, the Autorecloser issues the Autoclose command to close CB2. After CB2 has closed, as the
fault has been cleared, both CBs remain closed. When the Auto-close 2 pulse is removed, the Reclaim Timer starts.
If no further fault is detected before the Reclaim Timer expires, the Autoreclose is considered to be successful and
this is indicated by the Successful Autoreclose signals.
258 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
Protection Trip
CB1/CB2 AR in Progress
CB1 Open
CB2 Open
Follower Time
Reclaim Time
Lockout
V03399
CB1/CB2 AR 1 -ph in
Progress
CB1/CB2 AR 3-ph in
Progress
V03400
Figure 137: Autoreclose Sequence for a persistent fault on a multishot dual CB application set for single-phase
operation
P446SV-TM-EN-1 259
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
Note:
For three-phase Autoreclosing, for the first shot only, Autoreclose can be performed without checking that the voltages are in
synchronism using a setting. This setting, CB1L SC Shot 1 or CB2L SC Shot 1, can be enabled to perform synch-checks on shot
1 for CB1 or CB2, or disabled to not perform the checks.
260 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
P446SV-TM-EN-1 261
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
Key:
Energising Quantity AND gate &
Hardcoded setting
Pulse / Latch
Measurement Cell S
SR Latch Q
R
Internal Calculation
S
SR Latch Q
Derived setting Reset Dominant RD
Switch Multiplier X
Bandpass filter
Comparator for detecting
undervalues
262 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
V03393-1
P446SV-TM-EN-1 263
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
ResPRMem
Test Autoreclose AR Trip Test A
InitAR
AR Trip Test B
Init APh AR Test
Module 12 AR Trip Test C Trip Inputs A FltMem2 P
Init BPh AR Test Trip Test
Init CPh AR Test AR Trip Test 3Ph Ext Fault Aph FltMem3 P
Trip Inputs B
Init 3P AR Test
Ext Fault BPh
Module 15
Trip Inputs C Fault Memory
V03393-2 ResPRMem
264 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
V03393-3
P446SV-TM-EN-1 265
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
Control CloseCB1
DT Start by Prot DTOK All
CB1 AR Lockout
3PDTStart WhenLD DTOK CB1L 1P
CB1 Closed 3 ph
DTStart by CB Op DTOK CB1L 3P
CB1 Close Fail
Num CBs DTOK CB2L 1P
Control CloseCB2 Module 27
AR Start DTOK CB2L 3P Follower CB AR Enable
CB2 AR Lockout
OK Time 3P DeadLineLockout CB2 Close Fail
ARIP CB2 Closed 3 ph
CB1 AR Init
CB1FSPAR
CB2 AR Init
Module 22 CB1F3PAR
Dead Line
Dead Time Start Enable CB2FSPAR
CB1 AR 1p InProg
CB2F3PAR
CB2 AR 1p InProg
CB1 Open 3 ph Dynamic F/L 1PF TComp
CB2 Open 3 ph Follower Time 1P Follower Time
V03393-4
266 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
CB2FSPAR CB1SPDTComp
CB1F3PAR CB1SPFTComp
CB2F3PAR CB13PDTComp
CB1LFRC CB13PFTComp
CB2LFRC CB2SPDTComp
CB2SPFTComp
Any Trip Set CB1 Close
CB23PDTComp
CB1 AR Lockout Auto Close CB1 CB23PFTComp
CB1 Healthy CB1 Control
CB1 Open 3 ph Set CB2 Close Dynamic F/L 1P Reclaim TComp
CB1L SCOK Auto Close CB2 Close Pulse Time 1P Reclaim Time
V03393-5
P446SV-TM-EN-1 267
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
268 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
P446SV-TM-EN-1 269
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
270 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
V03393-9
P446SV-TM-EN-1 271
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
272 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
P446SV-TM-EN-1 273
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
274 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
P446SV-TM-EN-1 275
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
276 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
P446SV-TM-EN-1 277
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
AR CB2 No C/S 330 CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40) CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
AR CB2 Unhealthy 329 CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40) CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
AR Enable 1384 AR Enable (5)
AR Enable (5)
Leader Follower Logic (8)
AR Enable CB1 1609
AR Modes Enable (9)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
AR Enable (5)
AR OK (8)
AR Enable CB2 1605
AR Modes Enable (9)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
AR Force CB1 3P 858 Force 3-phase Trip (10) CB Trip Conversion (63)
AR Force CB2 3P 1485 Force 3-phase Trip (10) CB Trip Conversion (63)
Leader Follower Logic (8)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
AR Modes Enable (9)
AR In Service 1385 AR Enable (5)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
AR Mode 1P 1497 AR Modes Enable (9)
AR Mode 3P 1498 AR Modes Enable (9)
AR OFF Pulse 1383 AR Enable (5)
AR On Pulse 1382 AR Enable (5)
Fault Memory (15)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
Sequence Counter (18)
Dead Time Start Enable (22)
1-phase AR Dead Time (24)
AR Start 1541 CB1 AR In Progress (16)
3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Follower CB AR Enable (27)
Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28)
Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29)
AR Reset Successful (37)
CB2 AR Reset Successful (38)
AR Trip Test 3ph 576 Trip Test (12)
AR Trip Test A 577 Trip Test (12) AR Initiation (11)
AR Trip Test B 578 Trip Test (12) AR Initiation (11)
AR Trip Test C 579 Trip Test (12) AR Initiation (11)
1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19),
1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
Sequence Counter (18)
ARIP 1542 CB1 AR In Progress (16) Dead Time Start Enable (22)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB2 Autoclose (33)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
Reclaim Time (35)
Auto Close CB1 854 CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB Control (43)
278 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
Reclaim Time (35)
Auto Close CB2 1448 CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB2 Control (44)
Block CB1 AR 448 Autoreclose Lockout (55)
Block CB2 AR 1421 CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB1 3P Dtime 1560 3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Dead Time Start Enable (22)
CB1 AR 1p InProg 845 1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19),
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB1 AR 3p InProg 844 3-phase AR Cycle Selection (21)
Sequence Counter (18)
CB1 AR Init 1543 CB1 AR In Progress (16) Dead Time Start Enable (22)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB In Service (4)
Leader Follower Logic (8)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
Evolving Fault (20)
Follower CB AR Enable (27)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB1 AR Lockout 306 Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
AR Shot Counters (41)
Reset CB Lockout (57)
Pole Discrepancy (62)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB In Service (4)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
Evolving Fault (20)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB1 ARIP 1544 CB1 AR In Progress (16)
Reclaim Time (35)
AR Shot Counters (41)
CB Control (43)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
CB1Aux 3ph(52-A) 420 CB1 State Monitor (1)
CB1Aux 3ph(52-B) 424 CB1 State Monitor (1)
CB1Aux A(52-A) 421 CB1 State Monitor (1)
CB1Aux A(52-B) 425 CB1 State Monitor (1)
CB1Aux B(52-A) 422 CB1 State Monitor (1)
CB1Aux B(52-B) 426 CB1 State Monitor (1)
CB1Aux C(52-A) 423 CB1 State Monitor (1)
CB1Aux C(52-B) 427 CB1 State Monitor (1)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB1 Close Fail 303 CB Control (43) Leader Follower Logic (7)
Follower CB AR Enable (27)
CB1 Close inProg 842 CB Control (43)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 279
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
CB In Service (4)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
Evolving Fault (20)
Follower CB AR Enable (27)
CB1 Closed 3 ph 907 CB State Monitor (1)
Reclaim Time (35)
Successful AR Signals (36)
CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
CB Control (43)
CB Trip Time Monitor (53)
CB1 Closed A ph 908 CB State Monitor (1) CB Control (43)
CB1 Closed B ph 909 CB State Monitor (1) CB Control (43)
CB1 Closed C ph 910 CB State Monitor (1) CB Control (43)
CB1 Control 1566 CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB1 CS AngRotACW 1594 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS AngRotCW 1595 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS1 AngHigh- 1593 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS1 AngHigh+ 1592 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS1 Enabled 881 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS1 FL>FB 1590 Check Sync Signals (60)
3 Phase AR System Check (45)
CB1 CS1 OK 883 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB Manual Close System Check (51)
CB1 CS1 SlipF< 1579 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS1 SlipF> 1578 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS1 VL<VB 1588 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS1 VL>VB 1586 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS2 AngHigh- 1496 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS2 AngHigh+ 1495 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS2 Enabled 882 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS2 FL<FB 1494 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS2 FL>FB 1493 Check Sync Signals (60)
3 Phase AR System Check (45)
CB1 CS2 OK 884 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB Manual Close System Check (51)
CB1 CS2 SlipF< 1465 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS2 SlipF> 1464 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS2 VL<VB 1589 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB1 CS2 VL>VB 1587 Check Sync Signals (60)
3 Phase AR System Check (45)
CB1 Ext CS OK 900
CB Manual Close System Check (51)
CB1 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13),
CB1 Ext Trip A 535 CB1 AR In Progress (16),
CB Control (43)
CB1 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13),
CB1 Ext Trip B 536 CB1 AR In Progress (16),
CB Control (43)
280 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
CB1 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13),
CB1 Ext Trip C 537 CB1 AR In Progress (16),
CB Control (43)
CB1 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13),
CB1 Ext Trip3ph 534 CB1 AR In Progress (16),
CB Control (43)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB1 Fail Pr Trip 1575 CB Trip Time Monitor (53)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB1 Failed AR 1550 Evolving Fault (20)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
3 Phase AR System Check Leader (45)
CB1 Fast SCOK 1572 Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
3 Phase AR System Check Follower (47)
CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB1 Healthy 436 CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
CB Control (43)
Leader Follower Logic (8)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB1 In Service 1526 CB In Service (4)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB1 LO Alarm 860
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB1 Man SCOK 1574 Manual Close System Check (51) CB Control (43)
Leader Follower Logic (8) CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB1 NoAR 1528
Leader Follower Logic (7) Leader Follower Logic (7)
CB Open (3)
Dead Time Start Enable (22)
Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29)
CB1 Open 3 ph 903 CB State Monitor (1)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB Control (43)
CB Trip Time Monitor (53)
CB Open (3)
CB1 Open A ph 904 CB State Monitor (1) CB Control (43)
Pole Discrepancy
CB Open (3)
CB1 Open B ph 905 CB State Monitor (1) CB Control (43)
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB Open (3)
CB1 Open C ph 906 CB State Monitor (1) CB Control (43)
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB1 Status Alarm 301 CB State Monitor (1) Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB1 Succ 1P AR 1571 Successful AR Signals (36) AR Shot Counters (41)
CB1 Succ 3P AR 852 Successful AR Signals (36) AR Shot Counters (41)
CB1 Trip 3ph 526 CB Trip Conversion (63)
CB1 Trip AR MemA 1535 CB1 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13) CB1 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13)
CB1 Trip AR MemB 1536 CB1 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13) CB1 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13)
CB1 Trip AR MemC 1537 CB1 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13) CB1 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13)
CB1 Trip Fail 302 CB Control (43)
CB1 Trip IP 3Ph 529 CB Trip Conversion (63)
CB1 Trip Output A 523 CB Trip Conversion (63) CB1 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 281
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
CB1 Trip Output B 524 CB Trip Conversion (63) CB1 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
CB1 Trip Output C 525 CB Trip Conversion (63) CB1 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB1F SCOK 1491 3 Phase AR System Check (45) Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB1L SCOK 1573 3 Phase AR System Check (45) Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
CB Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
CB2 3P Dtime 1444 3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Dead Time Start Enable (22)
CB2 AR 1p InProg 855 1-phase AR Cycle Selection (19)
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB2 AR 3p InProg 1411 3-phase AR Cycle Selection (21)
Sequence Counter (18)
CB2 AR Init 1434 CB2 AR In Progress (17) Dead Time Start Enable (22)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB In Service (4)
Leader Follower Logic (8)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
Evolving Fault (20)
Follower CB AR Enable (27)
CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB2 AR Lockout 328 CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40)
CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
Reset CB2 Lockout (58)
Pole Discrepancy (62)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB In Service (4)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
Evolving Fault (20)
CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB2 ARIP 1435 CB2 AR In Progress (17) CB2 AR In Progress (17)
Reclaim Time (35)
CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
CB2 Control (44)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
CB2 Aux3ph(52-A) 428 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Aux3ph(52-B) 432 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Aux A(52-A) 429 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Aux A(52-B) 433 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Aux B(52-A) 430 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Aux B(52-B) 434 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Aux C(52-A) 431 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Aux C(52-B) 435 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB2 Close Fail 325 CB Control (44) Leader Follower Logic (7
Follower CB AR Enable (27))
CB2 Close inProg 1453 CB Control (44)
282 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
CB In Service (4)
CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
Evolving Fault (20)
Follower CB AR Enable (27)
CB2 Closed 3 ph 915 CB2 State Monitor (1)
Reclaim Time (35)
Successful AR Signals (36)
CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40)
CB Control (44)
CB2 Trip Time Monitor (54)
CB2 Closed A ph 916 CB2 State Monitor (2) CB Control (44)
CB2 Closed B ph 917 CB2 State Monitor (2) CB Control (44)
CB2 Closed C ph 918 CB2 State Monitor (2) CB Control (44)
CB2 Control 1450 CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB2 CS AngRotACW 1482 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS AngRotCW 1483 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS1 AngHigh- 1479 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS1 AngHigh+ 1478 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS1 Enabled 1426 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS1 Fl<FB 1476 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS1 Fl>FB 1474 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
3 Phase AR System Check Leader CB2 (46)
CB2 CS1 OK 1577 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61) 3 Phase AR System Check Follower CB2 (48)
CB2 Manual Close System Check (52)
CB2 CS1 SlipF< 1467 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS1 SlipF> 1466 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS1 VL<VB 1472 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS1 VL>VB 1470 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS2 AngHigh- 1481 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS2 AngHigh+ 1480 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS2 Enabled 1427 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS2 FL<FB 1476 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS2 FL>FB 1475 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
3 Phase AR System Check Leader CB2 (46)
CB2 CS2 OK 1463 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61) 3 Phase AR System Check Follower CB2 (48)
CB2 Manual Close System Check (52)
CB2 CS2 SlipF< 1469 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS2 SlipF> 1468 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS2 VL<VB 1473 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CB2 CS2 VL>VB 1471 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
3 Phase AR System Check Leader CB2 (46)
CB2 Ext CS OK 901 3 Phase AR System Check Follower CB2 (48)
CB2 Manual Close System Check (52)
CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB2 Ext Trip A 539
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
CB Control (44)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 283
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB2 Ext Trip B 540
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
CB Control (44)
CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB2 Ext Trip C 541
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
CB Control (44)
CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (14)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
CB2 Ext Trip3ph 538
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
CB Control (44)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB2 Fail Pr Trip 1459 CB2 Trip Time Monitor (54)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB2 Failed AR 1441 Evolving Fault (20)
3 Phase AR System Check Leader CB2 (46) CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB2 Fast SCOK 1454
3 Phase AR System Check Follower CB2 (48) CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40)
CB Autoclose (32)
CB2 Healthy 437 CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40)
CB Control (44)
Leader Follower Logic (8)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB2 In Service 1428 CB In Service (4)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
CB2 Lead 1408 Leader/Follower CB Selection (6)
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
CB2 LO Alarm 1599
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB2 Man SCOK 1458 CB2 Manual Close System Check (52) CB Control (44)
Leader Follower Logic (8) CB2 AR In Progress (17)
CB2 NoAR 1429
Leader Follower Logic (7) Leader Follower Logic (7)
CB Open (3)
Dead Time Start Enable (22)
Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29)
CB2 Open 3 ph 911 CB2 State Monitor (2)
CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB Control (44)
CB2 Trip Time Monitor (54)
CB Open (3)
CB2 Open A ph 912 CB2 State Monitor (2) CB Control (44)
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB Open (3)
CB2 Open B ph 913 CB2 State Monitor (2) CB Control (44)
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB Open (3)
CB2 Open C ph 914 CB2 State Monitor (2) CB Control (44)
Pole Discrepancy (62)
CB2 Status Alm 323 CB2 State Monitor (2) CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB2 Succ 1P AR 1451 Successful AR Signals (36) CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
CB2 Succ 3P AR 1452 Successful AR Signals (36) CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
CB2 Trip 3ph 1600 CB Trip Conversion (63)
CB2 Trip AR MemA 1499 CB2 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13) CB2 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13)
284 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
CB2 Trip AR MemB 1500 CB2 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13) CB2 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13)
CB2 Trip AR MemC 1501 CB2 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13) CB2 1-pole / 3-pole Trip (13)
CB2 Trip Fail 324 CB Control (44)
CB2 Trip IP 3Ph 1608 CB Trip Conversion (63)
CB2 Trip Output A 1601 CB Trip Conversion (63) CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
CB2 Trip Output B 1602 CB Trip Conversion (63) CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
CB2 Trip Output C 1603 CB Trip Conversion (63) CB2 1-pole / 3-pole trip (13)
CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB2F SCOK 1456 3 Phase AR System Check Follower CB2 (48) Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40)
CB2 Autoclose (33)
CB2L SCOK 1455 3 Phase AR System Check Leader CB2 (46) Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40)
Control CloseCB1 839 CB Control (43) Follower CB AR Enable (27)
Control CloseCB2 841 CB Control (44) Follower CB AR Enable (27)
Control TripCB1 838 CB Control (43) CB Control (43)
Control TripCB2 840 CB Control (44) CB2 Control (44)
CS VBus1> 1583 Check Sync Signals (60)
CS VBus1< 1582 Check Sync Signals (60)
CS VBus2< 1585 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CS VBus2> 1584 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
CS VLine< 1580 Check Sync Signals (60)
CS VLine> 1581 Check Sync Signals (60)
3 Phase AR System Check (45)
Dead Bus 1 887 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
CB Manual Close System Check (51)
3 Phase AR System Check CB2 (46)
Dead Bus 2 1462 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
CB2 Manual Close System Check (52)
Dead Time Start Enable (22)
3 Phase AR System Check (45)
3 Phase AR System Check CB2 (46)
Dead Line 889 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59) 3 Phase AR System Check (47)
3 Phase AR System Check CB2 (48)
CB Manual Close System Check (51)
CB2 Manual Close System Check (52)
1-phase AR Dead Time (24)
DTOK All 1551 Dead Time Start Enable (22)
3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
DTOK CB1L 1P 1552 Dead Time Start Enable (22) 1-phase AR Dead Time (24)
DTOK CB1L 3P 1553 Dead Time Start Enable (22) 3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
DTOK CB2L 1P 1442 Dead Time Start Enable (22) 1-phase AR Dead Time (24)
DTOK CB2L 3P 1443 Dead Time Start Enable (22) 3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28)
En CB1 Follower 1488 Follower CB AR Enable (27)
Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29)
Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28)
En CB2 Follower 1455 Follower CB AR Enable (27)
Follower 3-phase CB AR Time (29)
3-phase AR cycle selection (21)
Evolve 3Ph 1547 Evolving Fault (20) Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 285
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
Ext Fault Aph 1508 Fault Memory (15)
Ext Fault BPh 1509 Fault Memory (15)
Ext Fault CPh 1510 Fault Memory (15)
Ext Rst CB1 AROK 1517 AR Reset Successful (37)
Ext Rst CB1Shots 1518 AR Shot Counters (41)
Ext Rst CB2 AROK 1417 AR Reset Successful (37)
Ext Rst CB2Shots 1418 CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
Check Sync Signals (60)
F out of Range 319
CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
Foll AR Mode 1P 1409 AR Modes Enable (9)
Foll AR Mode 3P 1410 AR Modes Enable (9)
Follower CB1 1432 Leader Follower Logic (7) CB1 AR In Progress (16)
Follower CB2 1433 Leader Follower Logic (7) CB2 AR In Progress (17)
Force 3PTrip CB1 533 CB Trip Conversion (63)
Force 3PTrip CB2 1604 CB Trip Conversion (63)
IA< Start 864 AR Initiation (11)
IB< Start 865 AR Initiation (11)
IC< Start 866 AR Initiation (11)
Force 3-phase Trip (10) CB1 AR In Progress (16), CB2
Inhibit AR 1420
AR In Progress (17)
Inhibit DB1 1525 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
Inhibit DB2 1425 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
Inhibit DL 1523 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
Inhibit LB1 1524 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
Inhibit LB2 1424 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
Inhibit LL 1522 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
Init 3P AR Test 1507 Trip Test (12)
Init APh AR Test 1504 Trip Test (12)
Init BPh AR Test 1505 Trip Test (12)
Init Close CB1 440 CB Control (43)
Init Close CB2 442 CB2 Control (44)
Init CPh AR Test 1506 Trip Test (12)
Init Trip CB1 439 CB Control (43)
Init Trip CB2 441 Init Trip CB2
Invalid AR Mode 331 AR Modes Enable (9)
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
Leader CB1 1530 Leader Follower Logic (7)
AR Modes Enable (9)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
Leader Follower Logic (7)
Leader CB2 1431 Leader Follower Logic (7)
AR Modes Enable (9)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
3 Phase AR System Check (45)
Live Bus 1 886 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59) 3 Phase AR System Check (47)
CB1 Manual Close System Check (51)
286 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
3 Phase AR System Check CB2 (46)
Live Bus 2 1461 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59) 3 Phase AR System Check CB2 (48)
CB2 Manual Close System Check (52)
3 Phase AR System Check (45)
3 Phase AR System Check (46)
3 Phase AR System Check (47)
Live Line 888 System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
3 Phase AR System Check (48)
CB1 Manual Close System Check (51)
CB2 Manual Close System Check (52)
ManCB1 Unhealthy 304 CB Control (43)
ManCB2 Unhealthy 326 CB Control (44)
System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
MCB/VTS 438 Check Sync Signals (60)
CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
MCB/VTS CB1 CS 1521
Check Sync Signals (60)
System Checks Voltage Monitor (59)
MCB/VTS CB2 CS 1423
CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
NoCS CB1ManClose 305 CB Control (43)
NoCS CB2ManClose 327 CB Control (44)
Dead Time Start Enable (22)
CB1 Autoclose (32)
CB2 Autoclose (33)
OK Time 3P 1555 3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
CB1 Healthy and System Check Timers (39)
CB2 Healthy and System Check Timers (40)
Pole Dead A 892 CB Trip Conversion (63)
Pole Dead B 893 CB Trip Conversion (63)
Pole Dead C 894 CB Trip Conversion (63)
Pole Disc. CB1 Ext 451 Pole Discrepancy (62)
Pole Disc. CB2 Ext 1606 Pole Discrepancy (62)
Pole Discrep. CB1 699 Pole Discrepancy (62)
Pole Discrep. CB2 1607 Pole Discrepancy (62)
Rst CB1 CloseDly 443 CB Control (43)
Rst CB2 CloseDly 1419 CB2 Control (44)
Rst CB1 Lockout 446 Reset CB Lockout (57)
Rst CB2 Lockout 1420 Reset CB2 Lockout (58)
SChksInactiveCB1 880 Check Sync Signals (60)
SChksInactiveCB2 1484 CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
Seq Counter = 0 846 Sequence Counter (18) AR Modes Enable (9)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 287
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
DDB Signal Name DDB Signal Number Source Module (Module Number) Destination Module (Module Number.)
AR Modes Enable (9)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
Sequence Counter (18)
Evolving Fault (20)
1-phase AR Dead Time (24)
3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Seq Counter = 1 847 Sequence Counter (18) Follower 1-phase CB AR Time (28)
AR Shot Counters (41)
CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
3 Phase AR System Check (45)
3 Phase AR System Check CB2 (46)
3 Phase AR System Check (47)
3 Phase AR System Check CB2 (48)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Seq Counter = 2 848 Sequence Counter (18)
AR Shot Counters (41)
CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Seq Counter = 3 849 Sequence Counter (18)
AR Shot Counters (41)
CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
Force 3-phase Trip (10)
3-phase AR Dead Time (25)
Seq Counter = 4 850 Sequence Counter (18)
AR Shot Counters (41)
CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
Seq Counter > 4 851 Sequence Counter (18)
Autoreclose Lockout (55
Seq Counter>Set 1546 Sequence Counter (18)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56))
CB1 AR In Progress (16)
Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
Set CB1 Close 1565 CB1 Autoclose (32) AR Shot Counters (41)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
CB2 AR In Progress (17)
Prepare Reclaim Initiation (34)
Set CB2 Close 1449 CB2 Autoclose (33) CB2 AR Shot Counters (42)
Autoreclose Lockout (55)
CB2 Autoreclose Lockout (56)
Fault Memory (15)
Trip Inputs A 530
CB Trip Conversion (63)
Fault Memory (15)
Trip Inputs B 531
CB Trip Conversion (63)
Fault Memory (15)
Trip Inputs C 532
CB Trip Conversion (63)
Check Sync Signals (60)
VTS Fast Block 832
CB2 Check Sync Signals (61)
288 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
5 LOGIC MODULES
This section contains a complete set of logic diagrams, which will help to explain the Autoreclose function. Most of
the logic diagrams shown are logic modules that comprise the overall Autoreclose system. Some of the diagrams
shown are not directly related to Autoreclose functionality, however, they may use some inputs are produce
outputs that are used by the Autoreclose system. These diagrams are shown in this section for the sake of
completeness.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 289
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
424
CB1 Aux 3ph(52-B)
& 1 907
1 CB1 Closed 3 ph
XOR
&
&
&
421
CB1 Aux A(52-A)
&
425 908
CB1 Aux A(52-B) 1 CB1 Closed A ph
& 1
XOR
&
&
&
&
&
422 909
CB1 Aux B(52-A) 1 CB1 Closed B ph
905
Phase B 1 CB1 Open B ph
CB1 Status Input
(Same logic as phase A )
52A 1 pole
52B 1 pole
52A & 52B 1 pole
423 910
CB1 Aux C(52-A) 1 CB1 Closed C ph
906
Phase C 1 CB1 Open C ph
CB1 Status Input
(Same logic as phase A )
52A 1 pole
52B 1 pole 301
1 CB1 Status Alm
52A & 52B 1 pole
290 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
905
CB1 Open B ph 1 CB1Op1P
906
CB1 Open C ph
1 CB1OpAny
903
CB1 Open 3 ph
1 CB1 Op2/3P
³2
912
CB2 Open A ph
913
CB2 Open B ph 1 CB2Op1P
914
CB2 Open C ph
1 CB2OpAny
911
CB2 Open 3 ph
1 CB2 Op2/3P
³2
V03390
P446SV-TM-EN-1 291
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
V03303
Auto-Reclose
Enable
& AR DISABLED
HMI Comand
1383
AR OFF Pulse
1384
AR Enable
1609
AR Enable CB1 *
1
1605
AR Enable CB2 *
*Defaults to High if not mapped in PSL
V03301
292 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
Leader Select By
Menu
&
Select Leader
1 Pref LCB1
CB1
CB2
&
Leader Select By
Opto
&
1408 1 Pref LCB2
CB2 Lead
&
Leader Select By
Control
&
CB2 Lead
Set
V03306
P446SV-TM-EN-1 293
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
Reset L -F 1 & S
0.1s Q
R 1 SET LCB1
Pref LCB1
&
1429
CB2 NoAR
0.1 &
1544
CB1 ARIP
0 1
&
& S
Pref LCB2 Q
R 1 SET LCB2
&
CB1 NoAR 1528
0.1 &
1435
CB2 ARIP
0 1
&
1385
AR in Service
AR Enable CB 1 1609
1526 1528
CB1 in Service & CB1 NoAR
CB1 AR Lockout 306
BAR CB1
ARIP 1542 &
1 S 1530
& Q Leader CB1
Set LCB1 R
&
Reset L -F
0 .1s
294 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
P446SV-TM-EN-1 295
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
1497
&
AR Mode 1P Invalid AR Mode
1498 & 5s
AR Mode 3P 331
See Note Invalid AR Mode
1409 & 0
Foll AR Mode 1P
1410
&
Foll AR Mode 3P
1 CB1L3PAROK
1605 &
AR Enable CB2
& 1 CB2L3PAROK
846
Seq Counter = 0
847 1
Seq Counter = 1
CB2L SPAROK
& CB1F3PAROK
Fol SPAROK
1605
AR Enable CB2 & CB2 FSPAROK
&
Foll CB2
CB1L SPAROK
& CB2F3PAROK
Foll 3 PAROK
V03310
296 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
CB1 L SPAROK
1
CB1 F SPAROK
1554
CB1 ARIP
&
TARANY
847 &
Seq Counter = 1
1
Seq Counter = 2 848 &
1 858
849
& AR Force CB1 3P
Seq Counter = 3
306
CB1 AR Lockout
307
AR CB1 Unhealthy
1420
Inhibit AR
CB2Tripping Mode
3 Pole
&
1 and 3 pole
1431
Leader CB2
CB21 L SPAROK
1
CB2 F SPAROK
1435
CB2 ARIP
&
TARANY
847 &
Seq Counter = 1
1
Seq Counter = 2 848 &
1 1485
849 & AR Force CB2 3P
Seq Counter = 3
850
Seq Counter = 4
329
AR CB2 Unhealthy
1420
Inhibit AR
CB1Tripping Mode
3 Pole
&
1 and 3 pole
1530
Leader CB1
1585
AR In Service
NUM CBs
1
CB1 Only
Both CB1&CB2
1
CB2 Only
V03314
P446SV-TM-EN-1 297
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
298 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
Block AR
Initiate AR 1 Prot AR Block
Block AR 1 S
Q
Initiate AR R 1 INIT AR
864
IA< Start &
1
865
IB< Start
866
IC< Start
577
AR Trip Test A
1
578 &
AR Trip Test B
579
AR Trip Test C
522
Any Trip
V03315
1505
Init BPh AR Test
1 578
1 AR Trip Test B
1506
Init CPh AR Test
1 579
1 AR Trip Test C
1507
Init 3P AR Test 576
1 AR Trip Test 3Ph
Test Autoreclose
No Operation
Trip Pole A
Trip Pole B
Trip Pole C
Trip 3 Pole
V03304
P446SV-TM-EN-1 299
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
CB2 TARA
CB2 TARB 1
CB2 TARC
Num CBs
CB1 only ≥
TAR2/ 3PH
CB2 only 1 2
Both CB1&CB2
1 TARANY
Init AR
523
&
CB1 Trip OutputA 1 TARA
535 S
CB1 Ext Trip A 1535
Q CB1 Trip AR MemA
Init AR R
524
&
CB1 Trip OutputB 1 TARB
1542 0.01
ARIP
0.1
&
1 RESPRMEM
1 0.2
AR Disabled & S
0 Q
R
1
TARANY
1499
CB2 Trip AR MemA
1500
CB2 Trip AR MemB 1
1 TMEMANY
1501
CB2 Trip AR MemC
1536
CB1 Trip AR MemB 1
1537
CB1 Trip AR MemC
=
TMEM1Ph
1
≥
TMEM2 /3Ph
2
& TMEM3Ph
V03318
Figure 159: Autoreclose initiation by internal single and three phase trip or external trip for CB1 (Module 13)
Note:
For single-phase Autoreclose, these signals must be mapped as shown in the default PSL scheme.
300 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
Num CBs
CB1 only ≥
CB2 TAR2/3PH
CB2 only 1 2
Both CB1&CB2
Init AR
&
CB2 Trip OutputA 1 CB2 TARA
RESPRMEM
≥
CB2 TMEM2/3 Ph
2
Figure 160: Autoreclose initiation by internal single and three phase trip or external trip for CB2 (Module 14)
Note:
For single-phase Autoreclose, these signals must be mapped as shown in the default PSL scheme.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 301
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
TMEMANY 0
&
0.02 &
1 Prot ReOp
TARANY
&
& RESETL-F
Discrim Time
t
1554 &
1P DTime 0
Prot ReOp & Evolve Lock
847
Seq Counter = 1
576
& Evolve 3Ph
0
LastShot & S
0.02 Q 1550
306
R & CB1 Failed AR
CB1 AR Lockout
328 1
CB2 AR Lockout
Set CB1 CL
907 0 1
CB1 Closed 3 ph &
0.02
1544
CB1 ARIP
V03332
Figure 161: Protection Reoperation and Evolving Fault logic diagram (Module 20)
Trip Inputs A
1
Ext Fault APh & S
Q =
R FLTMEM 2P
Trip Inputs B 2
1
Ext Fault BPh & S
Q
R & FLTMEM 3P
Trip Inputs C
1
Ext Fault CPh & S
Q
R
AR Start
RESPRMEM
V03320
302 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
Init AR
TMEM2/3Ph
1
TMEM1Ph &
& & CB1 AR Init
CB1 Op2/3P
S
CB1L3 PAROK Q CB1 ARIP
1 R
CB1F3 PAROK
1 ARIP
Inhibit AR 1
CB1 LO Alarm
CB1 NoAR
CB1 ARSUCC
CBARCancel
0.02
CB1 OpAny
0 &
CB1 ARIP 1
AR Start &
Set CB1 Close
&
CB1 Closed 3 ph
CB2 ARIP
& CB1 LARIP
Leader CB1
1
& CB1 FARIP
Follower CB1
V03322
Figure 163: Autoreclose In Progress logic diagram for CB1 (Module 16)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 303
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
Init AR
CB2 TMEM2/3 Ph
1
CB2 TMEM1Ph &
& & CB2 AR Init
CB2 Op2/3P
S
CB2L3 PAROK Q CB2 ARIP
1 R
CB2 F3 PAROK
Inhibit AR 1
CB2 LO Alarm
CB2 NoAR
CB2 ARSUCC
CBARCancel
0.02
CB2 OpAny
0 &
CB2 ARIP 1
AR Start &
Set CB2 Close
&
CB2 Closed 3 ph
1
& CB2 FARIP
Follower CB2
V03324
Figure 164: Autoreclose In Progress logic diagram for CB2 (Module 17)
304 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
CB1 AR Init
1
CB2 AR Init &
1
ARIP &
AR Start
&
1P Dtime
&
Seq Counter = 1
Seq Counter = 0
& S
Prot Re-op Q LastShot
R
V03327
P446SV-TM-EN-1 305
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
ARIP S
Q LeaderSPAR
1 R
CB1 L 3 PAR
CB2 L 3 PAR
RESETL-F 1
CB1 L ARIP
& S
CB1 L SPAROK Q CB1 L SPAR
R
TMEM1PH
1
CB1 L 3 PAR
CB2 L ARIP
& S
CB2 L SPAROK Q CB2 L SPAR
R
CB2 TMEM1 PH
1
CB2 L 3 PAR 1 CB1 AR 1p InProg
CB1F ARIP
& S
CB2L SPAR Q CB1F SPAR
R
CB1F SPAROK
TMEM1PH
CB1F 3PAR
1 1 CB2 AR 1p InProg
CB2L 3PAR
CB2F ARIP
& S
CB1L SPAR Q CB2F SPAR
R
CB2F SPAROK
CB2 TMEM1 PH
CB2F 3PAR
1
CB1L 3PAR
V03330
Figure 166: Single-phase Autoreclose Cycle Selection logic diagram (Module 19)
306 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
CB1L ARIP
& S
CB1 L3 PAROK Q CB1L3PAR
R
Evolve 3Ph
TMEM3P 1
CB1 OP2 /3P
TMEM ANY
&
CB1 L SPAROK 1 CB1 AR 3p InProg
CB2L ARIP
& S
CB2L 3PAROK Q CB2L3PAR
R
CB2 TMEM 3 P
1
CB2 OP 2 /3P
1 CB2 AR 3p InProg
&
CB2L SPAROK
CB1F ARIP
& S
Q CB1F3PAR
CB1 F 3 PAROK R
1
CB1 OP 2 /3P
&
CB1F SPAROK
CB2F ARIP
& S
Q CB2F 3PAR
CB2F 3 PAROK R
1
CB2 OP 2 /3P
&
CB2F SPAROK
V03335
Figure 167: Three-phase Autoreclose Cycle Selection logic diagram (Module 21)
The DT Start by Prot determines how the protection action will initiate a dead time. The setting is always visible
and has three options Protection Reset, Protection Op (protection operation), and Disable which
should be selected if you don’t want protection action to start the dead time. These options set the basic
conditions for starting the dead time.
Selecting protection operation to start the dead time can, optionally, be qualified by a check that the line is dead.
Selecting protection reset to start the dead time can, optionally, be qualified by a check, that the circuit breaker is
open (DTStart by CB Op) before starting the dead time. For three-phase tripping applications, there is a further
option to check that the line is dead (3PDTStart WhenLD) before starting the dead time.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 307
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
If DT Start by Prot is disabled, the circuit breaker must be open for the dead time to start. For three-phase tripping
applications, there is an option to check that the line is dead (3PDTStart WhenLD) before starting the dead time. To
check that the line is dead, set 3PDTStart WhenLD to enabled. To check that the circuit breaker is open, set
DTStart by CB Op to Enabled.
DT Start by Prot
Disable
1
Protection Reset & DTOK All
&
Protection Op
AR Start
Dead Line Time
OKTimeSP &
S
Q
OK Time 3P 1 R
& S t
Q DeadLineLockout
ARIP R 0
CB1 AR Init 0 1
1
CB2 AR Init 0.02
Dead Line
1
3 PDTStart WhenLD
&
Enabled
Disabled
DT Start by Prot
Protection Reset
1
Disable &
CB1 AR 1p InProg
&
DTStart by CB Op
Disabled
1
Enabled
1 DTOK CB1L 1P
CB1OP1 P &
CB2OPAny
1
1 DTOK CB1L 3P
CB1 Open 3 ph &
CB2 Open 3 ph
1
1 DTOK CB2L 1P
CB2OP1P &
CB1OPAny
1
1 DTOK CB2L 3P
CB2 Open 3 ph &
CB1 Open 3 ph
1
Num CBs
CB1 Only
CB2 Only
V03338
Figure 168: Dead time Start Enable logic diagram (Module 22)
308 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
CB1LSPAR
&
DTOK CB1L 1P 1
& S
CB2LSPAR Q
& R & OKTimeSP
DTOK CB2L 1P
Seq Counter = 1
DTOK All
AR Start
1
DT Start by Prot
&
Protection Reset
CB1LSPAR
1
CB2LSPAR
CB1OP2/ 3P
&
CB2OP2/ 3P
Logic 1
&
CB1LSPAR 1
Logic 1
&
CB2LSPAR
t
0
1 Pole Dead Time
CB1LSPAR &
1 1P DTime
& CB1SPDTCOMP
CB2LSPAR &
& CB2SPDTCOMP
V03343
Figure 169: Single-phase Leader Dead Time logic diagram (Module 24)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 309
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
CB1L 3PAR
&
DTOK CB1L 3P
1
CB2L3PAR
&
DTOK CB2L 3P
& S
DTOK All Q
R & OK Time 3P
3PDTCOMP
AR Start
CB1L3PAR
1
CB2L3PAR Logic 1
&
1
Logic 1
&
3P AR DT Shot 1
t 1 3PDTCOMP
&
Seq Counter = 1 0
& 3P DTime1
3P AR DT Shot 2
t
&
Seq Counter = 2 0
& 3P DTime2
3P AR DT Shot 3
t
&
Seq Counter = 3 0
& 3P DTime3
3P AR DT Shot 4
t
&
Seq Counter = 4 0
& 3P DTime4
1 3P Dead Time IP
3PDTCOMP
Figure 170: Three-phase Leader CB Dead Time logic diagram (Module 25)
310 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
Control CloseCB1
& S
CB2 F SPAR Q
1 RD & En CB 2 Follower
CB2F 3PAR
CB2 Closed 3 ph 1
CB2 Close Fail
AR Start
BF if LFail Cls
Disabled
&
1
CB1 AR Lockout
CB1 Closed 3 ph
Logic 1
&
CB2 F SPAR 1
Logic 1
&
CB2F 3PAR
Control CloseCB2
& S
CB2 F SPAR Q
1 RD & En CB1 Follower
CB2F 3PAR
CB1 Closed 3 ph
1
CB1 Close Fail
AR Start
BF if LFail Cls
Disabled
&
1
CB2 AR Lockout
CB2 Closed 3 ph
Logic 1
&
CB1 F SPAR 1
Logic 1
&
CB1F 3PAR
V03346
P446SV-TM-EN-1 311
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
Dynamic F/L
Enabled
&
CB1 LFRC
1
CB2 LFRC
CB1OP1P
CB1FSPAR &
1
En CB 1 Follower
&
1PF TComp 1 1PF TComp
CB2OP1P & S
Q
R
CB2FSPAR
En CB 2 Follower
Seq Counter = 1
1 t
AR Start
0
CB1FSPAR
1
CB2FSPAR
CB1OP2/ 3P
&
CB2OP2/ 3P
Follower Time
CB1FSPAR &
1 1 P Follower Time
& CB1SPFTCOMP
CB2FSPAR &
& CB2SPFTCOMP
V03347
312 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
Dynamic F/L
Enabled
&
CB1 LFRC
1
CB2 LFRC
CB1 open 3 ph
CB1F3PAR &
1
En CB 1 Follower
&
3PF TComp 1 3PF TComp
En CB 2 Follower
1 t
AR Start
0
CB1FSPAR
1
CB2FSPAR
Follower Time
CB1F3PAR &
1 3 P Follower Time
CB2F3PAR &
V03348
P446SV-TM-EN-1 313
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
CB13PDTComp
1573 &
CB1 L SCOK 1
CB1 Fast SCOK 1572
1555
&
OK Time 3P
CB1FSPAR &
CB1SPFTComp
CB1F3PAR 1
&
CB13PFTComp
1491
CB1F SCOK
1562
Set CB1 Close
306 & S
CB1 AR Lockout Logic 1 Q 854
Auto Close CB1
R
ProtRe_Op
0.1s
1542
1
ARIP
1544
CB1 ARIP
1566
907 & CB1 Control
CB1 Closed 3 ph
522
Any Trip
328
CB2 AR Lockout &
&
CB2 Healthy 437
CB2SPDTComp If the DDB signal CB2 Healthy is not mapped in PSL , it defaults to
High.
CB2OP1P &
CB2L3PAR
911
CB2 Open 3 ph
CB23PDTComp
1455 &
CB2 L SCOK 1
1454
CB2 Fast SCOK
1555 &
OK Time 3P
CB2FSPAR &
CB2SPFTComp
CB2F3PAR 1
&
CB23PFTComp
1456
CB2F SCOK
1449
Set CB2 Close
328 & S
CB2 AR Lockout Logic 1 Q
1448
Auto Close CB2
R
ProtRe_Op
0.1s
1542 1
ARIP
1435
CB2 ARIP
1450
915
& CB2 Control
CB2 Closed 3 ph
V03350
Figure 174: Circuit Breaker Autoclose Logic Diagram (Modules 32 & 33)
314 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
for the next dead time to start when conditions are suitable. The operation also resets the signal that would set the
circuit breaker to close, and stops and resets the reclaim timer. The reclaim time starts again if the signal to set a
circuit breaker to close goes high following completion of a dead time in a subsequent Autoreclose cycle.
If the circuit breaker is closed and has not tripped again when the reclaim time expires, signals are generated to
indicate successful Autoreclose. These signals increment the relevant circuit breaker successful Autoreclose shot
counters and reset the relevant Autoreclose in progress signal.
The “successful Autoreclose” signals generated from the logic can be reset by various commands and settings
options available under CB CONTROL menu settings as follows:
If Res AROK by UI is set to Enabled, all the signals can be reset by user interface command Reset AROK Ind from
the CB CONTROL menu.
If Res AROK by NoAR is set to Enabled, the signals for each circuit breaker can be reset by temporarily
generating an Autoreclose disabled signal according to the logic shown.
If Res AROK by Ext is set to Enabled, the signals can be reset by activation of an external input signal
appropriately mapped in the PSL.
If Res AROK by TDly is set to Enabled, the signals are automatically reset after a time delay set in AROK Reset
Time.
CB1SPDTComp
1
CB1 SPFTComp & S
1565
Q SETCB1SPCl
Set CB1 Close R
CB13 PDTComp
1573
&
CB1 L SCOK
1572
CB1 Fast SCOK &
1555 & 1 S
OK Time 3P Q SETCB13 PCl
R
CB13PFTComp
1491 &
CB1F SCOK
CB2SPDTComp
1
CB2 SPFTComp & S
1449
Q SETCB2SPCl
Set CB2 Close R
CB23 PDTComp
1455
&
CB2 L SCOK
1454
CB2 Fast SCOK & S
1555 & 1
OK Time 3P Q SETCB23 PCl
R
CB23PFTComp
1456 &
CB2F SCOK
V03353
P446SV-TM-EN-1 315
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
SETCB1SPCL
CB2FARIP
SETCB2SPCL 1
TpsRécup RéencSP
SETCB23 PCL
Logique 1
CB1 LARIP
854
Réenc. DJ1 & t 1568
& T récup 1P term
Réenc. DJ2 1448 1 0
CB1FARIP
SETCB1SPCL 1
1567
SETCB13PCL & Tempo récup . 1P
SETCB2SPCL &
CB2LARIP
CB2 LFRC
&
SETCB1SPCL 1
&
CB1 LFRC
&
SETCB2SPCL 1
&
CB2 LFRC &
&
SETCB13 PCL
&
CB1 LFRC 1
&
SETCB23PCL
S/M dynamique
En Service
&
LeaderSPAR
SETCB13PCL
CB1LARIP t 1570
854 & T récup 3P term
Réenc. DJ1 & 1 0
1448
Réenc. DJ2
CB1FARIP 1569
1 & Tempo récup . 3P
SETCB13 PCL
SETCB2SPCL &
CB2 LARIP
1567
Tempo récup . 1P t
1569 1
Tempo récup. 3P 0
&
Prot Re-op & CBARCancel
907
DJ1 fermé 3 ph
1544
&
RÉENC EN CRS DJ1
915
DJ fermé 3 ph 1
1435
&
RÉENC EN CRS DJ2
V03356
316 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
ResCB1ARSucc 1 CB1ARSucc
1570
3P Reclaim TComp
1568
1
1P Reclaim TComp & S 852
Q CB1 Succ 3P AR
RD
SetCB13PCl 0
&
CB1OP2/3P 0.02S
907 & S
CB1 Closed 3 ph Q
R
1568
1
1P Reclaim TComp & S 1451
Q CB2 Succ 1P AR
RD
SetCB2SPCl 0
&
CB2OP1P 0.02S
915 & S
CB2 Closed 3 ph Q
R
ResCB2ARSucc 1 CB2ARSucc
1570
3P Reclaim TComp
1568
1
1P Reclaim TComp & S 1452
Q CB2 Succ 3P AR
RD
SetCB23PCl 0
&
CB2OP2/3P 0.02S
915 & S
CB2 Closed 3 ph Q
R
1
V03359
P446SV-TM-EN-1 317
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
CB1OPAny
1541 1
AR Start
1 ResCB1 ARSucc
Res AROK by UI
Enabled
&
Reset AROK Ind
Yes
CB2OPAny
1541
1
AR Start
1 ResCB2 ARSucc
Res AROK by UI
Enabled
&
Reset AROK Ind
Yes
Figure 178: Autoreclose Reset Successful Indication logic diagram (Modules 37 & 38)
318 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
Autoclose signal. If the circuit breaker synchronism-check OK signal stays low, then when the Autoreclose check
synchronism timer expires, an alarm is set to inform that the check synchronism is not satisfied and cancels the
Autoreclose cycle.
CB Healthy Time
CB1L 3PAR
1555
OK Time 3P 1
1572
CB1 Fast SCOK
CB1SPDTComp
1
CB1 SPFTComp & S t 307
Q AR CB1 Unhealthy
RD 0
CB13 PDTComp
CB13PFTComp
306
CB1 AR Lockout 1
907
CB1 Closed 3 Ph
CB13 PDTComp
1573
1 S
CB1 L SCOK Q t 308
RD 1 AR CB1 No C/S
0
306
CB1 AR Lockout
907 1
CB1 Closed 3 Ph
CB13PFTComp
1491
1 S Note : If the DDB signal CB1 Healthy is not mapped in PSL , it defaults to High .
CB1F SCOK Q
RD
306
CB1 AR Lockout
907
1
CB1 Closed 3 Ph
CB Healthy Time
CB2L 3PAR
1555
OK Time 3P 1
1454
CB2 Fast SCOK
CB2SPDTComp
1
CB2 SPFTComp & S t 329
Q AR CB2 Unhealthy
RD 0
CB23 PDTComp
CB23PFTComp
437
CB2 Healthy
328
CB2 AR Lockout 1
915
CB2 Closed 3 Ph
CB23 PDTComp
1455
1 S
CB2 L SCOK Q t 330
RD 1 AR CB2 No C/S
0
328
CB2 AR Lockout
915 1
CB2 Closed 3 Ph
CB23PFTComp
1456 1 S Note : If the DDB signal CB2 Healthy is not mapped in PSL , it defaults to High .
CB2F SCOK Q
RD
328
CB2 AR Lockout
915
1
CB2 Closed 3 Ph V03364
Figure 179: Circuit Breaker Healthy and System Check Timers Healthy logic diagram (Module 39)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 319
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
The counter values are accessible through the CB CONTROL column. The counters can be reset manually, or by
activation of an input appropriately mapped in the PSL.
The logic provides the following summary information for each circuit breaker
● Overall total number of shots (Number of Autoreclose attempts)
● Number of successful 1st shot single-phase Autoreclose sequences
● Number of successful 1st shot three-phase Autoreclose sequences
● Number of successful 2nd shot three-phase Autoreclose sequences
● Number of successful 3rd shot three-phase Autoreclose sequences
● Number of successful 4th shot three-phase Autoreclose sequences
● Number of failed Autoreclose cycles which forced a circuit breaker to lockout
320 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
1565
Set CB1 Close Increment
CB1 Total Shots Counter
Reset
1571
CB1 Succ 1P AR Increment
CB1 Successful SPAR Shot 1 Counter
852 Reset
CB1 Succ 3P AR
& Increment
848
Seq Counter = 2 CB1 Successful 3PAR Shot 2 Counter
Reset
849
& Increment
Seq Counter = 3 CB1 Successful 3PAR Shot 3 Counter
Reset
850
& Increment
Seq Counter = 4 CB1 Successful 3PAR Shot 1 Counter
Reset
1544
0
CB1 Arip
0.02 & Increment
CB1 Failed AR Counter
Reset
306
CB1 AR Lockout
1518
Ext Rst CB1Shots
1
Reset CB Shots
Yes
1449
Set CB2 Close Increment
CB2 Total Shots Counter
Reset
1451
CB2 Succ 1P AR Increment
CB2 Successful SPAR Shot 1 Counter
1452 Reset
CB2 Succ 3P AR
& Increment
848
Seq Counter = 2 CB2 Successful 3PAR Shot 2 Counter
Reset
849
& Increment
Seq Counter = 3 CB2 Successful 3PAR Shot 3 Counter
Reset
1418
Ext Rst CB2Shots
1
Reset CB Shots
Yes V03367
Figure 180: Autoreclose Shot Counters logic diagram (Modules 41 & 42)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 321
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
CB Control by
Opto
Note : If the DDB signal CB1 Healthy or CB2 Healthy is not mapped in PSL , it
Opto +Local defaults to High .
1
Opto+Remote
Opto+Rem+Local
Trip Pulse Time
838
HMI Trip Control TripCB1
1
& S t
439
& Q 302
Init Trip CB1 RD 0 & CB1 Trip Fail
440 &
Init close CB1 Man Close Delay Close Pulse Time
1 842
CB1 Close inProg
HMI Close
& S t
CB1 ARIP 1544 Q 839
RD 0 & Control CloseCB1
854
1 S t
Auto Close CB1 Q
RD 0
443
Rst CB1 CloseDly
522 303
Any Trip & CB1 Close Fail
1
838
Control TripCB1
534
CB1 Ext Trip3ph 1
1
535
CB1 Ext Trip A
536
CB1 Ext Trip B
537
CB1 Ext Trip C
1 1
903
CB1 Open 3 ph
904
CB1 Open A ph
905
CB1 Open B ph &
906
CB1 Open C ph
907
CB1 Closed 3 ph
1
908
CB1 Closed A ph
910
CB1 Closed C ph
t 304
436
& ManCB1 Unhealthy
CB1 Healthy 0
t 305
1574
& NoCS CB1ManClose
CB1 Man SCOK 0
V03370
322 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
CB Control by
Opto
Opto +Local Note: If the DDB signal CB 1 Healthy, or CB2 healthy is not mapped in PSL , it defaults to
1 High.
Opto+Remote
Opto+Rem+Local
Trip Pulse Time
840
HMI Trip Control TripCB2
1
& S t
441
& Q 324
Init Trip CB2 RD 0 & CB2 Trip Fail
442 &
Init close CB2 Man Close Delay Close Pulse Time
1 1453
CB2 Close inProg
HMI Close
& S t
CB2 ARIP 1435 Q 841
RD 0 & Control CloseCB2
1448
1 S t
Auto Close CB2 Q
RD 0
1419
Rst CB2 CloseDly
522 325
Any Trip & CB2 Close Fail
1
840
Control TripCB2
538
CB2 Ext Trip3ph 1
1
539
CB2 Ext Trip A
540
CB2 Ext Trip B
541
CB2 Ext Trip C
1 1
911
CB2 Open 3 ph
912
CB2 Open A ph
913
CB2 Open B ph &
914
CB2 Open C ph
915
CB2 Closed 3 ph
1
916
CB2 Closed A ph
918
CB2 Closed C ph
t 326
437
& ManCB2 Unhealthy
CB2 Healthy 0
t 327
1458
& NoCS CB2ManClose
CB2 Man SCOK 0
V03344
P446SV-TM-EN-1 323
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
TAR2/3Ph S t
Q 1575
RD 0 1 CB1 Fail Pr Trip
903
& S
CB1 Open 3 Ph Q
RD
907
CB1 Closed 3 Ph
TARA
& S
TMEM2 /3Ph Q t
RD 1
0
903 & S
CB1 Open 3 Ph Q
RD
907
CB1 Closed 3 Ph 1
TARB
& S
TMEM2 /3Ph Q
RD
903
& S
CB1 Open 3 Ph Q
RD
907
CB1 Closed 3 Ph 1
TARC
& S
TMEM2 /3Ph Q
RD
903 & S
CB1 Open 3 Ph Q
RD
907
CB1 Closed 3 Ph 1
TAR2/3Ph S t
Q 1459
RD 0 1 CB2 Fail Pr Trip
911 & S
CB2 Open 3 Ph Q
RD
915
CB2 Closed 3 Ph
TARA
& S
TMEM2 /3Ph Q t
RD 1
0
911 & S
CB2 Open 3 Ph Q
RD
915
CB2 Closed 3 Ph 1
TARB
& S
TMEM2 /3Ph Q
RD
911
& S
CB2 Open 3 Ph Q
RD
915
CB2 Closed 3 Ph 1
TARC
& S
TMEM2 /3Ph Q
RD
911 & S
CB2 Open 3 Ph Q
RD
915
CB2 Closed 3 Ph 1
V03377
Figure 183: Circuit Breaker Trip Time Monitoring logic diagram (Modules 53 & 54)
324 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
P446SV-TM-EN-1 325
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
FLTMEM3P
&
Multi Phase AR
BAR 3 Phase
1
BAR 2 and 3 ph
&
FLTMEM2P
303
CB1 Close Fail
BF if LFail Cls
& 306
CB1 AR Lockout
Enabled
CB2 LFRC
& 1385
CB1 FARIP AR In Service
&
CB2 AR Lockout 328
Num CBs & S
Q
R
CB1 Fail Pr Trip 1575 Both CB 1&CB2
1
CB1 Only
CB1OpAny
1544
CB1 ARIP & RESCB1LO
Block CB1 AR 448 &
307
AR CB1 Unhealthy
308
AR CB1 No C/S
1547 S
Evolve 3Ph
Q
PROTRE-OP R
LastShot &
1544
CB1 ARIP
ProtARBlock
1526
CB1 In Service
&
TMEM2/3Ph
CB1L3 PAROK 0
1
CB1F3 PAROK 0.02s
1526
CB1 In Service
&
TMEM1Ph
CB1 LSPAROK 0 Note: This diagram shows the logic for CB 1 only. The logic for CB2 follows the same
1 principles and is not repeated .
CB1 FSPAROK 0.02s
1546
Seq Counter >Set
301
CB1 Status Alm
CB2OpAny
1428
&
CB2 In Service
1526
CB1 In Service
&
Num CBs
&
Both CB1&CB2
CB2 Fail Pr Trip 1459
InvalidAR Mode
&
1543
CB1 AR Init
1544 1
CB1 ARIP
DeadLineLockout V03380
326 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
FltMem3P
&
Multi Phase AR
BAR 3 Phase
1
BAR 2 and 3 ph
&
FltMem2P
325
CB2 Close Fail
BF if LFail Cls
& 328
CB2 AR Lockout
Enabled
CB1 LFRC
& 1385
CB2FARIP AR In Service
&
CB1 AR Lockout 306
Num CBs & S
Q
R
CB2 Fail Pr Trip 1459 Both CB 1&CB2
1
CB1 Only
CB2OpAny
1435
CB2 ARIP & ResCB2Lo
Block CB2 AR 1421 &
329
AR CB2 Unhealthy
330
AR CB2 No C/S
1547 S
Evolve 3Ph
Q
ProtRe_Op R
LastShot &
1435
CB2 ARIP
ProtARBlock
1428
CB2 In Service
&
TMEM2/3Ph
CB2L3PAROK 0
1
CB2 F3PAROK 0.02s
1428
CB2 In Service
&
TMEM1Ph
CB2LSPAROK 0
1
CB2FSPAROK 0.02s
1546
Seq Counter >Set
323
CB2 Status Alm
CB1OpAny
1526
&
CB1 In Service
1428
CB2 In Service
&
Num CBs
&
Both CB1&CB2
CB1 Fail Pr Trip 1575
Invalid_AR_Mode
&
1434
CB2 AR Init
1435 1
CB2 ARIP
DeadLineLockout V03403
P446SV-TM-EN-1 327
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
If set to CB Close, a timer setting, CB mon LO RstDly, becomes visible. When the circuit breaker closes, the CB
mon LO RstDly time starts. The lockout is reset when the timer expires.
If set to User Interface then a command, CB mon LO reset, becomes visible. This command can be used to
reset the lockout from a user interface.
An Autoreclose lockout generates an Autoreclose lockout alarm. Autoreclose lockout conditions can be reset by
various commands and setting options found under the CB CONTROL column.
If Res LO by CB IS is set to Enabled, a lockout is reset if the circuit breaker is successfully closed manually. For
this, the circuit breaker must remain closed long enough so that it enters the “In Service” state.
If Res LO by UI is set to Enabled, the circuit breaker lockout can be reset from a user interface using the reset
circuit breaker lockout command in the CB CONTROL column.
If Res LO by NoAR is set to Enabled, the circuit breaker lockout can be reset by temporarily generating an AR
disabled signal.
If Res LO by TDelay is set to Enabled, the circuit breaker lockout is automatically reset after a time delay set in
the LO Reset Time setting.
If Res LO by ExtDDB is Enabled, the circuit breaker lockout can be reset by activation of an external input
mapped in the PSL to the relevant reset lockout DDB signal.
328 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
Res LO by CB IS
Enabled
&
CB1CRLo
Res LO by UI
Enabled
&
Reset CB1 LO
Yes
Res LO by NoAR
Enabled
& 1 ResCB1Lo
ARDisabled
1
Num CBs
CB2 Only
Res LO by ExtDDB
Enabled
&
446
Rst CB1 Lockout
Res LO by TDelay
Enabled
&
LO Reset Time
306
t
CB1 AR Lockout
0
Res LO by CB IS
Enabled
&
CB2CRLo
Res LO by UI
Enabled
&
Reset CB2 LO
Yes
Res LO by NoAR
Enabled
& 1 ResCB2Lo
ARDisabled
1
Num CBs
CB2 Only
Res LO by ExtDDB
Enabled
&
1422
Rst CB2 Lockout
Res LO by TDelay
Enabled
&
LO Reset Time
328
t
CB2 AR Lockout
0
V03383
Figure 186: Reset Circuit Breaker Lockout Logic Diagram (Modules 57 & 58)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 329
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
904
CB1 Open A ph
1
905
CB1 Open B ph
906
CB1 Open C ph
&
328
CB2 AR Lockout
1 0.04 1607
CB2 LO Alarm 1599 & Pole Discrep CB2
0
1606
Pol Disc CB2 Ext
855 &
CB2 AR 1p InProg
912
CB2 Open A ph
1
913
CB2 Open B ph
914
CB2 Open C ph
&
V03385
330 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
530
Trip Inputs A
1 S
1601
Q CB2 Trip OutputA
R
531
Trip Inputs B
1 S
1602
Q CB2 Trip OutputB
R
532
Trip Inputs C
1 S
1603
Q CB2 Trip OutputC
R
CB2Tripping Mode 1
&
3 Pole 1 S
1600
Q CB2 Trip 3ph
1485 R
AR Force CB2 3P 1
Force 3PTrip CB2 1604
1608
CB2 Trip I/P 3Ph
Dwell
522
1 Any Trip
530 100 ms
Trip Inputs A
531
Trip Inputs B
≥ S
Trip Inputs C 532 2 Q 527
2/3 Ph Fault
R
892
Pole Dead A &
1 S
528
Q 3 Ph Fault
R
893
& 1
Pole Dead B 1
&
894 1
Pole Dead C
&
V03387
Figure 188: Circuit Breaker Trip Conversion Logic Diagram (Module 63)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 331
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
System Checks
Enabled
VAN 888
Live Line & Live Line
VBN
VCN 889
Select Dead Line & Dead line
VAB
VBC 886
Live Bus 1 & Live Bus 1
VCA
VBus 2
1461
Live Bus 2 & Live Bus 2
MCB/VTS 438
1521 1462
MCB/VTS CB1 CS Dead Bus 2 & Dead Bus 2
1423
MCB/VTS CB2 CS
Voltage Monitors
1522 1
Inhibit LL
1523 1
Inhibit DL
1524 1
Inhibit LB 1
1525
1
Inhibit DB 1
1424 1
Inhibit LB 2
1425 1
Inhibit DB 2
V 01258
332 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
Sys checks CB 1
880
Disabled SChksInactiveCB 1
Enabled
CS1 Criteria OK
VAN &
VBN CS2 Criteria OK
&
VCN
Select CB1 CS1 SlipF> 1578
VAB & CB1 CS1 SlipF>
CS Vbus1< 1582
& CS Vbus<
CB1 CS1 Vl>Vb 1586
& CB1 CS1 Vl> Vb
CB1 CS1 Vl<Vb 1588
& CB1 CS1 Vl< Vb
CB1 CS1 Fl>Fb 1590
& CB1 CS1 Fl>Fb
CB1 CS1 Fl<Fb 1591
& CB1 CS1 Fl<Fb
CB1 CS1 AngHigh+ 1592
& CB1 CS1 AngHigh+
CB1 CS1 AngHigh- 1593
& CB1 CS1 AngHigh-
CB1 CS2 Fl>Fb 1493
& CB1 CS2 Fl>Fb
CB1 CS2 Fl<Fb 1494
& CB1 CS2 Fl<Fb
CB1 CS2 AngHigh+ 1495
& CB1 CS2 AngHigh+
CB1 CS2 AngHigh- 1496
& CB1 CS2 AngHigh-
CB1 CS AngRotACW 1594
& CB1 CS AngRotACW
1521
MCB/VTS CB CS CB1 CS AngRotCW 1595
438 & CB1 CS AngRotCW
MCB/VTS
832 CB1 CS2 Vl>Vb 1587
VTS Fast Block & CB1 CS2 Vl> Vb
1
319
F out of Range CB1 CS2 Vl<Vb 1589
& CB1 CS2 Vl< Vb
CB1 CS1 Status
883
Enabled & CB1 CS1 OK
881
CB1 CS1 Enabled
CB1 CS2 Status
884
Enabled & CB1 CS2 OK
882
CB1 CS2 Enabled V01260
Figure 190: Check Synchronisation Monitor for CB1 closure (Module 60)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 333
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
Sys checks CB 2
1484
Disabled SChksInactiveCB 2
Enabled
CS1 Criteria OK
VAN &
&
CS Vbus2> 1585
& CS Vbus2>
&
CS Vbus2<
Check Synchronisation Function
1584
& CS Vbus2<
CB2 CS1 Vl>Vb 1470
& CB2 CS1 Vl> Vb
CB2 CS1 Vl<Vb 1472
& CB2 CS1 Vl< Vb
CB2 CS1 Fl>Fb 1474
& CB2 CS1 Fl>Fb
CB2 CS1 Fl<Fb 1476
& CB2 CS1 Fl<Fb
CB2 CS1 AngHigh+ 1478
& CB2 CS1 AngHigh+
CB2 CS1 AngHigh- 1479
& CB2 CS1 AngHigh-
CB2 CS2 Fl>Fb 1475
& CB2 CS2 Fl>Fb
CB2 CS2 Fl<Fb 1477
& CB2 CS2 Fl<Fb
CB2 CS2 AngHigh+ 1480
& CB2 CS2 AngHigh+
CB2 CS2 AngHigh- 1481
& CB2 CS2 AngHigh-
CB2 CS AngRotACW 1482
& CB2 CS AngRotACW
1521
MCB/VTS CB CS CB2 CS AngRotCW 1483
438 & CB2 CS AngRotCW
MCB/VTS
832 CB2 CS2 Vl>Vb 1471
VTS Fast Block & CB2 CS2 Vl> Vb
1
319
F out of Range CB2 CS2 Vl<Vb 1473
& CB2 CS2 Vl< Vb
CB2 CS1 Status
1577
Enabled & CB2 CS1 OK
1426
CB2 CS1 Enabled
CB2 CS2 Status
884
Enabled & CB1 CS2 OK
1427
CB2 CS2 Enabled V01268
Figure 191: Check Synchronisation Monitor for CB2 closure (Module 61)
334 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
For single-phase Autoreclose no voltage or synchronism check is required as synchronising power is flowing in the
two healthy phases. Three-phase Autoreclose can be performed without checking that voltages are in
synchronism for the first shot (and only the first shot). The settings to permit Autoreclose without checking voltage
synchronism on the first shot are:
● CB1L SC Shot 1 for circuit breaker 1 as a leader,
● CB1F SC Shot 1 for circuit breaker 1 as a follower,
● CB2L SC Shot 1 for circuit breaker 2 as a leader,
● CB2L SC Shot 1 for circuit breaker 2 as a follower.
When the circuit breaker has closed, the Autoreclose function asserts a DDB signal Set CB1 Close, which indicates
that an attempt has been made to close the circuit breaker. At this point, the Reclaim Time starts. If the circuit
breaker remains closed after the reclaim timer expires, the Autoreclose cycle is complete, and signals are
generated to indicate that Autoreclose was successful. These are:
● CB1 Succ 1P AR (Single-phase Autoreclose CB1)
● CB2 Succ 1P AR (Single-phase Autoreclose CB2)
● CB1 Succ 3P AR (Three-phase Autoreclose CB1)
● CB2 Succ 3P AR (Three-phase Autoreclose CB2)
These signals increment the relevant circuit breaker successful Autoreclose shot counters, as well as resetting the
Autoreclose in progress signal.
The relevant circuit breaker successful Autoreclose shot counters are:
● CB1 SUCC SPAR (Single-phase Autoreclose CB1)
● CB1 SUCC 3PAR Shot1 (Three-phase Autoreclose CB1, Shot 1)
● CB1 SUCC 3PAR Shot2 (Three-phase Autoreclose CB1, Shot 2)
● CB1 SUCC 3PAR Shot3 (Three-phase Autoreclose CB1, Shot 3)
● CB1 SUCC 3PAR Shot4 (Three-phase Autoreclose CB1, Shot 4)
● CB2 SUCC SPAR (Single-phase Autoreclose CB2)
● CB2 SUCC 3PAR Shot1 (Three-phase Autoreclose CB2, Shot 1)
● CB2 SUCC 3PAR Shot2 (Three-phase Autoreclose CB2, Shot 2)
● CB2 SUCC 3PAR Shot3 (Three-phase Autoreclose CB2, Shot 3)
● CB1 SUCC 3PAR Shot4 (Three-phase Autoreclose CB2, Shot 4)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 335
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
CB1L SC ClsNoDly
Enabled 1572
& CB1 Fast SCOK
CB1 L SC CS1
Enabled 1
&
883
CB1 CS1 OK
CB1 L SC CS2
Enabled
&
884
CB1 CS2 OK
CB1L SC DLLB
Enabled
889 &
Dead Line
886
Live Bus 1
CB1L SC LLDB
Enabled
1573
888 & 1 CB1 L SCOK
Live Line
887
Dead Bus 1
CB1L SC DLDB
Enabled
889
&
Dead Line
887 Note: If the DDB signal CB1 Ext CS OK is not mapped in PSL , it defaults to High .
Dead Bus 1
CB1L SC Shot 1
Disabled
&
847
Seq Counter = 1
CB1L SC all
Disabled
&
900
CB1 Ext CS OK V03373
Figure 192: Three-phase AR System Check logic diagram for CB1 as leader (Module 45)
336 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
CB2L SC ClsNoDly
Enabled 1454
& CB2 Fast SCOK
CB2 L SC CS1
Enabled 1
&
1577
CB2 CS1 OK
CB2 L SC CS2
Enabled
&
1463
CB2 CS2 OK
CB2L SC DLLB
Enabled
889 &
Dead Line
1461
Live Bus 2
CB2L SC LLDB
Enabled
1455
888 & 1 CB2 L SCOK
Live Line
887
Dead Bus 1
CB2L SC DLDB
Enabled
889
&
Dead Line
1462
Dead Bus 2
CB2L SC Shot 1 Note: If the DDB signal CB2 Ext CS OK is not mapped in PSL , it defaults to
High.
Disabled
&
847
Seq Counter = 1
CB2L SC all
Disabled
&
901
CB2 Ext CS OK V03345
Figure 193: Three-phase AR System Check logic diagram for CB2 as leader (Module 46)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 337
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
&
CB1F SC CS1
Enabled 1
&
883
CB1 CS1 OK
CB1F SC CS2
Enabled
&
884
CB1 CS2 OK
CB1F SC DLLB
Enabled
889 &
Dead Line
886
Live Bus 1
CB1F SC LLDB
Enabled
1491
888
& 1 CB1F SCOK
Live Line
CB1 F SC DLDB
Enabled
889 &
Dead Line
Dead Bus 1 887 Note: If the DDB signal CB1 Ext CS OK is not mapped in PSL , it
defaults to High .
CB1 F SC Shot 1
Disabled
&
847
Seq Counter = 1
CB1F SC all
Disabled
&
900
CB1 Ext CS OK V03401
Figure 194: Three-phase AR System Check logic d for CB1 as follower (Module 47)
338 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
&
CB2F SC CS1
Enabled 1
&
1577
CB2 CS1 OK
CB2F SC CS2
Enabled
&
1463
CB2 CS2 OK
CB2F SC DLLB
Enabled
889 &
Dead Line
1461
Live Bus 2
CB2F SC LLDB
Enabled
1456
888
& 1 CB2F SCOK
Live Line
CB2 F SC DLDB
Enabled
889 &
Dead Line
Dead Bus 2 1462 Note: If the DDB signal CB2 Ext CS OK is not mapped in PSL , it
defaults to High .
CB2 F SC Shot 1
Disabled
&
847
Seq Counter = 1
CB2F SC all
Disabled
&
901
CB2 Ext CS OK V03402
Figure 195: Three-phase AR System Check logic diagram for CB2 as follower (Module 48)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 339
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
CB1 M SC CS1
Enabled
&
883
CB1 CS1 OK
CB1 M SC CS2
Enabled
&
884
CB1 CS2 OK
CB1M SC DLLB
Enabled
889
&
Dead Line
886
Live Bus 1
CB1M SC LLDB
Enabled
1574
888 & 1 CB1 Man SCOK
Live Line
887
Dead Bus 1
CB1M SC DLDB
Enabled Note: If the DDB signal CB1 Ext CS OK is not mapped in PSL , it
& defaults to High .
889
Dead Line
CB1M SC required
Disabled
&
900
CB1 Ext CS OK
CB2M SC CS1
Enabled
&
1577
CB2 CS1 OK
CB2 M SC CS2
Enabled
&
1463
CB2 CS2 OK
CB2M SC DLLB
Enabled
889 &
Dead Line
1461
Live Bus 2
CB2M SC LLDB
Enabled
1458
888 & 1 CB2 Man SCOK
Live Line
1462
Dead Bus 2
CB2 M SC DLDB
Enabled
889
&
Dead Line Note: If the DDB signal CB2 Ext CS OK is not mapped in PSL , it
defaults to High .
1462
Dead Bus 2
CB2M SC required
Disabled
&
901
CB2 Ext CS OK V03375
Figure 196: CB Manual Close System Check Logic Diagram (Modules 51 & 52)
340 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
6 SETTING GUIDELINES
P446SV-TM-EN-1 341
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
342 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 11 - Autoreclose
Note:
The Follower circuit breaker should only be reclosed if the system is healthy. In a dual circuit breaker scheme where the
system is healthy, the Follower circuit breaker acts more like a bus coupler. In this case there is no need for fast switching and
a time delay in excess of 1s is often appropriate. The default Follower time in this product is chosen as 5 s and this can
comfortably be applied to most applications.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 343
Chapter 11 - Autoreclose P446SV
344 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 12
CB FAIL PROTECTION
Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection P446SV
346 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
The device provides a Circuit Breaker Fail Protection function. This chapter describes the operation of this function
including the principles, logic diagrams and applications.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 347
Circuit Breaker Fail Protection 348
Circuit Breaker Fail Implementation 349
Circuit Breaker Fail Logic 351
Application Notes 355
P446SV-TM-EN-1 347
Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection P446SV
348 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection
You can configure the CBF elements CB Fail 1 Timer and CBF Fail 2 Timer to operate for trips triggered by
protection elements within the device. Alternatively you can use an external protection trip by allocating one of the
opto-inputs to the External Trip DDB signal in the PSL.
You can reset the CBF from a breaker open indication (from the pole dead logic) or from a protection reset. In these
cases resetting is only allowed if the undercurrent elements have also been reset. The resetting mechanism is
determined by the settings Volt Prot Reset and Ext Prot Reset.
The resetting options are summarised in the following table:
Initiation (Menu Selectable) CB Fail Timer Reset Mechanism
The resetting mechanism is fixed (e.g. 50/51/46/21/87)
Current based protection
IA< operates AND IB< operates AND IC< operates AND IN< operates
The resetting mechanism is fixed.
Sensitive Earth Fault element
ISEF< Operates
Three options are available:
● All I< and IN< elements operate
Non-current based protection (e.g. 27/59/81/32L)
● Protection element reset AND all I< and IN< elements operate
● CB open (all 3 poles) AND all I< and IN< elements operate
Three options are available.
● All I< and IN< elements operate
External protection
● External trip reset AND all I< and IN< elements operate
● CB open (all 3 poles) AND all I< and IN< elements operate
P446SV-TM-EN-1 349
Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection P446SV
after the circuit breaker in the primary system has opened ensuring that the only current flowing in the AC
secondary circuit is the subsidence current.
350 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection
WI Prot Reset
Enabled
ISEF<FastUndercurrent
ZCDStateA
ZCDStateB
ZCD function
ZCDStateC
ZCDStateSEF
V00729
P446SV-TM-EN-1 351
Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection P446SV
3
1
CB1 Ext Prot Rst
2 I< Only
&
CB Open & I<
904
CB1 Open A ph 1 Prot Reset & I<
&
Prot Reset OR I<
0 Rst OR CBOp & I<
IA<FastUndercurrent
4
LatchATripResetIncompCB1
2
&
1
&
0
Logic 0
V00740
Note:
This diagram shows only phase-A for the first CB (CB1) of a dual-CB device. The diagrams for phases B and C and for the
second CB (CB2) follow the same principle and are not repeated here.
352 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection
WIINFEEDA
TripStateExtA 1 TripStateACB1
& S
AnyTripPhaseA Q
RD
IA<FastUndercurrent
4
Latch3PhTripResetIncompCB1
3
2
&
IA<FastUndercurrent
IB<FastUndercurrent & 1
&
IC<FastUndercurrent
0
ExtTrip Only Ini 0
Enabled
874 & S
CBF Non I Trip
2 Q
&
RD
890
All Poles Dead
1 1
892 &
Pole Dead A CB1 Ext Prot Rst
893
0 I< Only
Pole Dead B &
CB Open & I<
894
Pole Dead C Prot Reset& I<
Prot Reset OR I<
IA<FastUndercurrent Rst OR CBOp & I<
IB<FastUndercurrent &
2
&
IC<FastUndercurrent LatchNonITripResetIncompCB1
1
&
0
Logic 0
V00741
Note:
This diagram shows only first CB (CB1) of a dual-CB device. The diagrams for the second CB (CB2) follow the same principle
and are not repeated here..
P446SV-TM-EN-1 353
Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection P446SV
835
1 CB1 Fail2 Trip
CB1 ZCD State A
WI INFEED A
1
TripStateA CB1
& & 1672
t 1 CB1 Fail1 Trip A
CB1 Fail1 Status
0
Enabled
1
& 1675
TripStateA t 1 CB1 Fail2 Trip A
&
0
CB1 Fail2 Status
Enabled
ZCD StateSEF
1
TripStateSEF
& &
t
CB1 Fail1 Status
0
Enabled
1
&
TripStateSEF t
&
0
CB1 Fail2 Status
Enabled
V00742
Note:
This diagram shows only phase-A for the first CB (CB1) of a dual-CB device. The diagrams for phases B and C and for the
second CB (CB2) follow the same principle and are not repeated here.
354 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection
5 APPLICATION NOTES
For any protection function requiring current to operate, the device uses operation of undercurrent elements to
detect that the necessary circuit breaker poles have tripped and reset the CB fail timers. However, the
undercurrent elements may not be reliable methods of resetting CBF in all applications. For example:
● Where non-current operated protection, such as under/overvoltage or under/overfrequency, derives
measurements from a line connected voltage transformer. Here, I< only gives a reliable reset method if the
protected circuit would always have load current flowing. In this case, detecting drop-off of the initiating
protection element might be a more reliable method.
● Where non-current operated protection, such as under/overvoltage or under/overfrequency, derives
measurements from a busbar connected voltage transformer. Again using I< would rely on the feeder
normally being loaded. Also, tripping the circuit breaker may not remove the initiating condition from the
busbar, and so drop-off of the protection element may not occur. In such cases, the position of the circuit
breaker auxiliary contacts may give the best reset method.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 355
Chapter 12 - CB Fail Protection P446SV
CBF resets:
1. Undercurrent element asserts
2. Undercurrent element asserts and the
breaker status indicates an open position
3. Protection resets and the undercurrent
Fault occurs element asserts
CBF Safety
Protection Maximum breaker reset margin
Normal operating time clearing time time time
operation
t
Local 86 Remote CB
operating clearing time
time
The following examples consider direct tripping of a 2-cycle circuit breaker. Typical timer settings to use are as
follows:
Typical Delay For 2 Cycle Circuit
CB Fail Reset Mechanism tBF Time Delay
Breaker
CB interrupting time + element reset time (max.) + error in tBF
Initiating element reset 50 + 50 + 10 + 50 = 160 ms
timer + safety margin
CB auxiliary contacts opening/ closing time (max.) + error in tBF
CB open 50 + 10 + 50 = 110 ms
timer + safety margin
CB interrupting time + undercurrent element (max.) + safety
Undercurrent elements 50 + 25 + 50 = 125 ms
margin operating time
Note:
All CB Fail resetting involves the operation of the undercurrent elements. Where element resetting or CB open resetting is
used, the undercurrent time setting should still be used if this proves to be the worst case.
Where auxiliary tripping relays are used, an additional 10-15 ms must be added to allow for trip relay operation.
356 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 13
358 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
The primary purpose of this product is not overcurrent protection. It does however provide a range of current
protection functions to be used as backup protection. This chapter assumes you are familiar with overcurrent
protection principles and does not provide detailed information here. If you require further information about
general overcurrent protection principles, please refer either to General Electric's NPAG publication, earlier
incarnations of this technical manual, or one of our technical manuals from our P40 Agile Modular distribution
range of products such as the P14x.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 359
Phase Fault Overcurrent Protection 360
Negative Sequence Overcurrent Protection 363
Earth Fault Protection 366
Sensitive Earth Fault Protection 371
High Impedance REF 376
Thermal Overload Protection 378
Broken Conductor Protection 382
P446SV-TM-EN-1 359
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV
360 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions
Under system fault conditions, the fault current vector lags its nominal phase voltage by an angle depending on
the system X/R ratio. The IED must therefore operate with maximum sensitivity for currents lying in this region. This
is achieved by using the IED characteristic angle (RCA). This is the is the angle by which the current applied to the
IED must be displaced from the voltage applied to the IED to obtain maximum sensitivity.
The device provides a setting I> Char Angle, which is set globally for all overcurrent stages. It is possible to set
characteristic angles anywhere in the range –95° to +95°.
A directional check is performed based on the following criteria:
Directional forward
-90° < (angle(I) - angle(V) - RCA) < 90°
Directional reverse
-90° > (angle(I) - angle(V) - RCA) > 90°
For close up three-phase faults, all three voltages will collapse to zero and no healthy phase voltages will be
present. For this reason, the device includes a synchronous polarisation feature that stores the pre-fault voltage
information and continues to apply this to the directional overcurrent elements for a time period of a few seconds.
This ensures that either instantaneous or time-delayed directional overcurrent elements will be allowed to operate,
even with a three-phase voltage collapse.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 361
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV
VBC
I>1 Direction
Directional
VTS Fast Block 832 check Timer Settings
I> Blocking &
VTS Blocks I>1
763
I>1 Start B
IB
VCA
I>1 Direction
Directional
VTS Fast Block 832 check Timer Settings
I> Blocking &
VTS Blocks I>1
764
I>1 Start C
IC
VAB 761
I>1 Direction
Directional 1 I>1 Start
401
I>1 Timer Block
Note: For the purpose of clarity , this diagram shows the first
relevant stage number for each signal and setting name .
V00735
362 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions
P446SV-TM-EN-1 363
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV
IDMT/DT
I2>1 Current Set 571
& & & I2>1 trip
928
CTS Block
562
I2 > Inhibit
I2>1 Direction
V2
Directional
I2> V2pol Set
check
833
VTS Slow block
I 2> VTS Blocking &
VTS Blocks I2>1
563
I2>1 Tmr Blk
Note: For the purpose of clarity , this diagram shows the first
relevant stage number for each signal and setting name .
V 00736
364 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions
Directionality is achieved by comparing the angle between the negative phase sequence voltage and the negative
phase sequence current and the element may be selected to operate in either the forward or reverse direction. A
suitable relay characteristic angle setting (I2> Char Angle) is chosen to provide optimum performance. This setting
should be set equal to the phase angle of the negative sequence current with respect to the inverted negative
sequence voltage (–V2), in order to be at the centre of the directional characteristic.
The angle that occurs between V2 and I2 under fault conditions is directly dependent on the negative sequence
source impedance of the system. However, typical settings for the element are as follows:
● For a transmission system the relay characteristic angle (RCA) should be set equal to –60°
● For a distribution system the relay characteristic angle (RCA) should be set equal to –45°
For the negative phase sequence directional elements to operate, the device must detect a polarising voltage
above a minimum threshold, I2> V2pol Set. This must be set in excess of any steady state negative phase
sequence voltage. This may be determined during the commissioning stage by viewing the negative phase
sequence measurements in the device.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 365
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV
Depending on the device model, it will provide one or more of the above means for Earth fault protection.
I
top = 5.8 − 1.35 log e
IN > Setting
where:
366 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions
Note:
Although the start point of the characteristic is defined by the "ΙN>" setting, the actual current threshold is a different setting
called "IDG Ιs". The "IDG Ιs" setting is set as a multiple of "ΙN>".
Note:
When using an IDG Operate characteristic, DT is always used with a value of zero for the Rest characteristic.
An additional setting "IDG Time" is also used to set the minimum operating time at high levels of fault current.
10
8 IDGIsIsSetting
IDG SettingRange
Range
time (seconds)
(seconds)
6
Operating time
5
Operating
3
IDG Time
IDG Time Setting
Setting Range
Range
2
0
1 10 100
I/IN>
V00611
P446SV-TM-EN-1 367
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV
Small levels of residual voltage could be present under normal system conditions due to system imbalances, VT
inaccuracies, device tolerances etc. For this reason, the device includes a user settable threshold (IN> VNPol set),
which must be exceeded in order for the DEF function to become operational. The residual voltage measurement
provided in the MEASUREMENTS 1 column of the menu may assist in determining the required threshold setting
during the commissioning stage, as this will indicate the level of standing residual voltage present.
Note:
Residual voltage is nominally 180° out of phase with residual current. Consequently, the DEF elements are polarised from the
"-Vres" quantity. This 180° phase shift is automatically introduced within the device.
368 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions
IDMT/ DT
IN>1 Current Set 671
& & & IN>1 Trip
CTS Block 928
467
Inhibit IN >1
IN>1 Directional
VN
IN Directional
check
Low Current
833
VTS Slow Block
IN> Blocking &
VTS Blocks IN>1
405
IN>1 Timer Blk
V2
I2
P446SV-TM-EN-1 369
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV
370 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions
P446SV-TM-EN-1 371
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV
EPATR Curve
1000
100
Time in Secs
10
1
0.1 1 10 100 1000
Current in Primary A (CT Ratio 100A/1A)
V00616
IDMT/ DT
ISEF>1 Current 671
& & & IN>1 Trip
CTS Block 928
1724
Inhibit ISEF>1
ISEF>1 Direction
VN
IN Directional
check
Low Current
833
VTS Slow Block
ISEF> Blocking &
VTS Blocks IN>1
409
ISEF>1 Timer Blk
ISEF> Blocking
AR Blks ISEF>3 *
Note: For the purpose of clarity , this diagram shows the first
V00738 * Stages 3 and 4 only relevant stage number for each signal and setting name .
372 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions
Ia1
Ib1
IR1
jXc1
IH1
Ia2
Ib2
IR2
jXc2
IH2
Ia3
Ib3
IH1 + IH2 + IH3
IR3
jXc3
E00627
The protection elements on the healthy feeder see the charging current imbalance for their own feeder. The
protection element on the faulted feeder, however, sees the charging current from the rest of the system (IH1 and
IH2 in this case). Its own feeder's charging current (IH3) is cancelled out.
With reference to the associated vector diagram, it can be seen that the C-phase to earth fault causes the
voltages on the healthy phases to rise by a factor of √3. The A-phase charging current (Ia1), leads the resultant A
phase voltage by 90°. Likewise, the B-phase charging current leads the resultant Vb by 90°.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 373
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV
Vaf
Restrain
Vapf
IR1
Ib1
Operate
Ia1
Vbf
Vcpf Vbpf
Vres
(= 3Vo)
Figure 209: Phasor diagrams for insulated system with C phase fault
The current imbalance detected by a core balanced current transformer on the healthy feeders is the vector
addition of Ia1 and Ib1. This gives a residual current which lags the polariing voltage (–3Vo) by 90°. As the healthy
phase voltages have risen by a factor of Ö3, the charging currents on these phases are also Ö3 times larger than
their steady state values. Therefore, the magnitude of the residual current IR1, is equal to 3 times the steady state
per phase charging current.
The phasor diagram indicates that the residual currents on the healthy and faulted feeders (IR1 and IR3
respectively) are in anti-phase. A directional element (if available) could therefore be used to provide discriminative
earth fault protection.
If the polarising is shifted through +90°, the residual current seen by the relay on the faulted feeder will lie within
the operate region of the directional characteristic and the current on the healthy feeders will fall within the
restrain region.
The required characteristic angle setting for the SEF element when applied to insulated systems, is +90°. This is for
the case when the protection is connected such that its direction of current flow for operation is from the source
busbar towards the feeder. If the forward direction for operation were set such that it is from the feeder into the
busbar, then a –90° RCA would be required.
Note:
Discrimination can be provided without the need for directional control. This can only be achieved, however, if it is possible to
set the IED in excess of the charging current of the protected feeder and below the charging current for the rest of the system.
374 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions
Cable gland
Cable box
Cable gland/shealth
earth connection
“Incorrect”
No operation
SEF
“Correct”
Operation
SEF
E00614
If the cable sheath is terminated at the cable gland and directly earthed at that point, a cable fault (from phase to
sheath) will not result in any unbalanced current in the core balance CT. Therefore, prior to earthing, the
connection must be brought back through the CBCT and earthed on the feeder side. This then ensures correct
relay operation during earth fault conditions.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 375
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV
Healthy CT Saturated CT
Protected
circuit
A-G
Zm1 Zm2
I = Is + IF
RCT1 RCT2
I IF
RL1 IS RL3
Vs RST
R
RL2 RL4
V00671
When subjected to heavy through faults the line current transformer may enter saturation unevenly, resulting in
imbalance. To ensure stability under these conditions a series connected external resistor is required, so that most
of the unbalanced current will flow through the saturated CT. As a result, the current flowing through the device
will be less than the setting, therefore maintaining stability during external faults.
Voltage across REF element Vs = IF (RCT2 + RL3 + RL4)
Stabilising resistor RST = Vs/Is –RR
where:
● IF = maximum secondary through fault current
● RR = device burden
● RCT = CT secondary winding resistance
● RL2 and RL3 = Resistances of leads from the device to the current transformer
● RST = Stabilising resistor
High Impedance REF can be used for either delta windings or star windings in both solidly grounded and
resistance grounded systems. The connection to a modern IED are as follows:
376 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions
Phase A
Phase A
Phase B
Phase B
Phase C
Phase C
I Phase A
I Phase B
I Phase C
RSTAB I Neutral
I Neutral RSTAB
IED IED
Connecting IED to star winding for High Connecting IED to delta winding for High
Impedance REF Impedance REF
V00680
P446SV-TM-EN-1 377
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV
I 2 − ( KI FLC )2
t = −τ log
I 2 − I p2
e
where:
● t = time to trip, following application of the overload current I
● t = heating and cooling time constant of the protected plant
● I = largest phase current
● IFLC full load current rating (the Thermal Trip setting)
● K = a constant with the value of 1.05
● Ip = steady state pre-loading before application of the overload
( − t / τ1 ) ( −t / τ 2 )
I 2 − ( KI FLC )2
0.4e + 0.6e = 2 2
I − I p
where:
● t1 = heating and cooling time constant of the transformer windings
● t2 = heating and cooling time constant of the insulating oil
378 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions
IA
IB Max RMS
Thermal State
IC
Thermal Trip
680
Thermal Trip
Characteristic Thermal trip
Disabled Thermal threshold
Single Calculation
Dual
Time Constant 1
Time Constant 2
445
Reset Thermal
785
Thermal Alarm
Thermal Alarm
V00630
The magnitudes of the three phase input currents are compared and the largest magnitude is taken as the input
to the thermal overload function. If this current exceeds the thermal trip threshold setting a start condition is
asserted.
The Start signal is applied to the chosen thermal characteristic module, which has three outputs signals; alarm trip
and thermal state measurement. The thermal state measurement is made available in one of the MEASUREMENTS
columns.
The thermal state can be reset by either an opto-input (if assigned to this function using the programmable
scheme logic) or the HMI panel menu.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 379
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV
Figures based
on equation
E00728
Figure 214: Spreadsheet calculation for dual time constant thermal characteristic
100000
100
10
1
1 10
Current as a Multiple of Thermal Setting
V00629
380 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions
Note:
The thermal time constants given in the above tables are typical only. Reference should always be made to the plant
manufacturer for accurate information.
θ − θ p
e( − t / τ ) =
e
θ −1
where:
● θ = thermal state = I2/K2IFLC2
● θp = pre-fault thermal state = Ip2/K2IFLC2
Note:
A current of 105%Is (KIFLC) has to be applied for several time constants to cause a thermal state measurement of 100%.
Area mm2 6 - 11 kV 22 kV 33 kV 66 kV
25 – 50 10 minutes 15 minutes 40 minutes –
70 – 120 15 minutes 25 minutes 40 minutes 60 minutes
150 25 minutes 40 minutes 40 minutes 60 minutes
185 25 minutes 40 minutes 60 minutes 60 minutes
240 40 minutes 40 minutes 60 minutes 60 minutes
300 40 minutes 60 minutes 60 minutes 90 minutes
P446SV-TM-EN-1 381
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV
I2/I1
679
I2/I1 Setting & Broken Wire Trip
I2
Low Current
928
CTS Block
V00739
382 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions
Note:
A minimum value of 8% negative phase sequence current is required for successful operation.
Since sensitive settings have been employed, we can expect that the element will operate for any unbalanced
condition occurring on the system (for example, during a single pole autoreclose cycle). For this reason, a long time
delay is necessary to ensure co-ordination with other protection devices. A 60 second time delay setting may be
typical.
The following example was recorded by an IED during commissioning:
Ifull load = 500A
I2 = 50A
therefore the quiescent I2/I1 ratio = 0.1
To allow for tolerances and load variations a setting of 20% of this value may be typical: Therefore set:
I2/I1 = 0.2
In a double circuit (parallel line) application, using a 40% setting will ensure that the broken conductor protection
will operate only for the circuit that is affected. A setting of 0.4 results in no pick-up for the parallel healthy circuit.
Set I2/I1 Time Delay = 60 s to allow adequate time for short circuit fault clearance by time delayed protections.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 383
Chapter 13 - Current Protection Functions P446SV
384 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 14
386 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
The device provides a wide range of voltage protection functions. This chapter describes the operation of these
functions including the principles, logic diagrams and applications.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 387
Undervoltage Protection 388
Overvoltage Protection 391
Compensated Overvoltage 394
Residual Overvoltage Protection 395
P446SV-TM-EN-1 387
Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions P446SV
2 UNDERVOLTAGE PROTECTION
Undervoltage conditions may occur on a power system for a variety of reasons, some of which are outlined below:
● Undervoltage conditions can be related to increased loads, whereby the supply voltage will decrease in
magnitude. This situation would normally be rectified by voltage regulating equipment such as AVRs (Auto
Voltage Regulators) or On Load Tap Changers. However, failure of this equipment to bring the system
voltage back within permitted limits leaves the system with an undervoltage condition, which must be
cleared.
● If the regulating equipment is unsuccessful in restoring healthy system voltage, then tripping by means of
an undervoltage element is required.
● Faults occurring on the power system result in a reduction in voltage of the faulty phases. The proportion by
which the voltage decreases is dependent on the type of fault, method of system earthing and its location.
Consequently, co-ordination with other voltage and current-based protection devices is essential in order to
achieve correct discrimination.
● Complete loss of busbar voltage. This may occur due to fault conditions present on the incomer or busbar
itself, resulting in total isolation of the incoming power supply. For this condition, it may be necessary to
isolate each of the outgoing circuits, such that when supply voltage is restored, the load is not connected.
Therefore, the automatic tripping of a feeder on detection of complete loss of voltage may be required. This
can be achieved by a three-phase undervoltage element.
● Where outgoing feeders from a busbar are supplying induction motor loads, excessive dips in the supply
may cause the connected motors to stall, and should be tripped for voltage reductions that last longer than
a pre-determined time.
The undervoltage stages can be configured either as phase-to-neutral or phase-to-phase voltages in the V<
Measur't Mode cell.
There is no Timer Hold facility for Undervoltage.
Stage 2 can have definite time characteristics only. This is set in the V<2 Status cell.
Outputs are available for single or three-phase conditions via the V< Operate Mode cell for each stage.
388 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions
832
VTS Fast Block 1
&
414
V<1 Timer Block 1 683
V<1 Trip
&
V< Operate Mode &
Any Phase
Three Phase
Note: This diagram does not show all stages . Other stages follow similar principles.
VTS Fast Block only applies for directional models .
V00803
Figure 217: Undervoltage - single and three phase tripping mode (single stage)
The Undervoltage protection function detects when the voltage magnitude for a certain stage falls short of a set
threshold. If this happens a Start signal, signifying the "Start of protection", is produced. This Start signal can be
blocked by the VTS Fast Block signal and an All Poles Dead signal. This Start signal is applied to the timer module
to produce the Trip signal, which can be blocked by the undervoltage timer block signal (V<(n) Timer Block). For
each stage, there are three Phase undervoltage detection modules, one for each phase. The three Start signals
from each of these phases are OR'd together to create a 3-phase Start signal (V<(n) Start), which can be be
activated when any of the three phases start (Any Phase), or when all three phases start (Three Phase), depending
on the chosen V< Operate Mode setting.
The outputs of the timer modules are the trip signals which are used to drive the tripping output relay. These
tripping signals are also OR'd together to create a 3-phase Trip signal, which are also controlled by the V< Operate
Mode setting.
If any one of the above signals is low, or goes low before the timer has counted out, the timer module is inhibited
(effectively reset) until the blocking signal goes high.
In some cases, we do not want the undervoltage element to trip; for example, when the protected feeder is de-
energised, or the circuit breaker is opened, an undervoltage condition would obviously be detected, but we would
not want to start protection. To cater for this, an All Poles Dead signal blocks the Start signal for each phase. This
is controlled by the V<Poledead Inh cell, which is included for each of the stages. If the cell is enabled, the relevant
stage will be blocked by the integrated pole dead logic. This logic produces an output when it detects either an
open circuit breaker via auxiliary contacts feeding the opto-inputs or it detects a combination of both
undercurrent and undervoltage on any one phase.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 389
Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions P446SV
390 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions
3 OVERVOLTAGE PROTECTION
Overvoltage conditions are generally related to loss of load conditions, whereby the supply voltage increases in
magnitude. This situation would normally be rectified by voltage regulating equipment such as AVRs (Auto Voltage
Regulators) or On Load Tap Changers. However, failure of this equipment to bring the system voltage back within
permitted limits leaves the system with an overvoltage condition which must be cleared.
Note:
During earth fault conditions on a power system there may be an increase in the healthy phase voltages. Ideally, the system
should be designed to withstand such overvoltages for a defined period of time.
The overvoltage stages can be configured either as phase-to-neutral or phase-to-phase voltages in the V>
Measur't Mode cell.
There is no Timer Hold facility for Overvoltage.
Stage 2 can have definite time characteristics only. This is set in the V>2 Status cell.
Outputs are available for single or three-phase conditions via the V> Operate Mode cell for each stage.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 391
Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions P446SV
1
&
V>1 Timer Block 1 V>1 Trip
&
V> Operate mode &
Any Phase
Three Phase
Notes: This diagram does not show all stages . Other stages follow similar principles.
VTS Fast Block only applies for directional models .
V 00804
Figure 218: Overvoltage - single and three phase tripping mode (single stage)
The Overvoltage protection function detects when the voltage magnitude for a certain stage exceeds a set
threshold. If this happens a Start signal, signifying the "Start of protection", is produced. This Start signal can be
blocked by the VTS Fast Block signal. This start signal is applied to the timer module to produce the Trip signal,
which can be blocked by the overvoltage timer block signal (V>(n) Timer Block). For each stage, there are three
Phase overvoltage detection modules, one for each phase. The three Start signals from each of these phases are
OR'd together to create a 3-phase Start signal (V>(n) Start), which can then be activated when any of the three
phases start (Any Phase), or when all three phases start (Three Phase), depending on the chosen V> Operate Mode
setting.
The outputs of the timer modules are the trip signals which are used to drive the tripping output relay. These
tripping signals are also OR'd together to create a 3-phase Trip signal, which are also controlled by the V> Operate
Mode setting.
If any one of the above signals is low, or goes low before the timer has counted out, the timer module is inhibited
(effectively reset) until the blocking signal goes high.
392 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions
This type of protection must be co-ordinated with any other overvoltage devices at other locations on the system.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 393
Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions P446SV
4 COMPENSATED OVERVOLTAGE
The Compensated Overvoltage function calculates the positive sequence voltage at the remote terminal using the
positive sequence local current and voltage and the line impedance and susceptance. This can be used on long
transmission lines where Ferranti Overvoltages can develop under remote circuit breaker open conditions.
The Compensated overvoltage protection function can be set in the VOLT PROTECTION column under the sub
heading COMP OVERVOLTAGE. The remote voltage is calculated using line impedance settings and the line
charging admittance in the LINE PARAMETERS column.
The IED uses the [A,B,C,D] transmission line equivalent model given the following parameters:
● Total Impedance Z = zÐq ohms
● Total Susceptance Y = yÐ90°
● Line Length l
Vr D − C Vs
= ×
Ir
− BA Is
where
● Vr is the voltage at the receiving end
● Ir is the current at the receiving end
● Vs is the measured voltage at the sending end
● Is is the measured current at the sending end
● A= D = cosh(y.l)
● B = Zc.sinh(y.l)
● C = Yc.sinh(y.l)
● y.l = Ö(Z.Y)
● Zc = 1/Yc = Ö(Z/Y)
● Y = total line capacitive charging susceptance
● Zc = characteristic impedance of the line (surge impedance)
There are two stages to provide both alarm and trip stages where required. Both stages can be set independently.
Stage 1 can be set to IDMT, DT or Disabled, in the V1>1 Cmp Funct cell. Stage 2 is DT only and is enabled or
disabled in the V1>2 Cmp Status cell.
The IDMT characteristic on the first stage is defined by the following formula:
t = K/(M - 1)
where:
● K = Time multiplier setting
● t =Operating time in seconds
● M = Remote Calculated voltage / IED setting voltage
394 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions
P446SV-TM-EN-1 395
Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions P446SV
804
VN>1 Start
VN
VN>1 Voltage Set & 700
& IDMT/DT VN>1 Trip
832
VTS Fast Block
418
VN>1 Timer Blk
V00802
The Residual Overvoltage module (VN>) is a level detector that detects when the voltage magnitude exceeds a set
threshold, for each stage. When this happens, the comparator output produces a Start signal (VN>(n) Start), which
signifies the "Start of protection". This can be blocked by a VTS Fast block signal. This Start signal is applied to the
timer module. The output of the timer module is the VN> (n) Trip signal which is used to drive the tripping output
relay.
396 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions
E S IED F
ZS ZL
VA
VA
VC VB VC VB VC VB
VA VRES
VRES
VA
VB VB VB
VC VC VC
VRES = ZS0
X3E
2ZS1 + ZS0 + 2ZL1 + ZL0
E00800
As can be seen from the above diagram, the residual voltage measured on a solidly earthed system is solely
dependent on the ratio of source impedance behind the protection to the line impedance in front of the protection,
up to the point of fault. For a remote fault far away, the ZS/ZL: ratio will be small, resulting in a correspondingly
small residual voltage. Therefore, the protection only operates for faults up to a certain distance along the system.
The maximum distance depends on the device setting.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 397
Chapter 14 - Voltage Protection Functions P446SV
E S IED F
ZS ZL
N
ZE
VA - G
S R VA - G
G,F G,F
G,F
VC - G VC - G VC - G
VB - G VB - G VB - G
VB - G VB - G VB - G
VA - G VA - G
VC - G VC - G VC - G
ZS0 + 3ZE
VRES = X3E
2ZS1 + ZS0 + 2ZL1 + ZL0 + 3Z
E
E00801
An impedance earthed system will always generate a relatively large degree of residual voltage, as the zero
sequence source impedance now includes the earthing impedance. It follows then that the residual voltage
generated by an earth fault on an insulated system will be the highest possible value (3 x phase-neutral voltage),
as the zero sequence source impedance is infinite.
398 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 15
400 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 15 - Frequency Protection Functions
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
The device provides a range of frequency protection functions. This chapter describes the operation of these
functions including the principles, logic diagrams and applications.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 401
Frequency Protection 402
Independent R.O.C.O.F Protection 405
P446SV-TM-EN-1 401
Chapter 15 - Frequency Protection Functions P446SV
2 FREQUENCY PROTECTION
Power generation and utilisation needs to be well balanced in any industrial, distribution or transmission network.
These electrical networks are dynamic entities, with continually varying loads and supplies, which are continually
affecting the system frequency. Increased loading reduces the system frequency and generation needs to be
increased to maintain the frequency of the supply. Conversely decreased loading increases the system frequency
and generation needs to be reduced. Sudden fluctuations in load can cause rapid changes in frequency, which
need to be dealt with quickly.
Unless corrective measures are taken at the appropriate time, frequency decay can go beyond the point of no
return and cause widespread network collapse, which has dire consequences.
Normally, generators are rated for a particular band of frequency. Operation outside this band can cause
mechanical damage to the turbine blades. Protection against such contingencies is required when frequency does
not improve even after load shedding steps have been taken. This type of protection can be used for operator
alarms or turbine trips in case of severe frequency decay.
Clearly a range of methods is required to ensure system frequency stability. The frequency protection in this device
provides both underfrequency and overfrequency protection.
Frequency Protection is implemented in the FREQ PROTECTION column of the relevant settings group.
402 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 15 - Frequency Protection Functions
Freq 1155
Averaging F<1 Start
DT
1161
F<1 Setting & F<1 Trip
F<1 Status
Enabled
890
All Poles Dead
1
Freq Not Found 1370
1149
F<1 Timer Block
V00861
If the frequency is below the setting and not blocked the DT timer is started. If the frequency cannot be
determined, the function is blocked.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 403
Chapter 15 - Frequency Protection Functions P446SV
1159
Freq Averaging F>1 Start
DT
1165
F>1 Setting & F>1 Trip
F>1 Status
Enabled
890
All Poles Dead
1
Freq Not Found 1370
1153
F>1 Timer Block
V00862
If the frequency is above the setting and not blocked, the DT timer is started and after this has timed out, the trip is
produced. If the frequency cannot be determined, the function is blocked.
404 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 15 - Frequency Protection Functions
● df/dt>1 Dir'n: sets the direction of change you wish to check (positive, negative, or both)
In addition, start, trip and timer block DDB signals are available for each stage, as well as an inhibit signal to inhibit
all four stages.
Frequency 597
V df/dt df/dt >1 Start
determination
& 601
df /dt Avg . Cycles 1 df /dt>1 Trip
-1
df /dt>1 Dir’n 1
Positive
Both
1
Negative
1370
Freq Not Found
1368
Freq High 1
Freq Low 1369
V00869
P446SV-TM-EN-1 405
Chapter 15 - Frequency Protection Functions P446SV
406 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 16
408 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
As well as providing a range of protection functions, the product includes comprehensive monitoring and control
functionality.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 409
Event Records 410
Disturbance Recorder 414
Measurements 415
CB Condition Monitoring 416
CB State Monitoring 427
Circuit Breaker Control 429
Pole Dead Function 435
System Checks 436
P446SV-TM-EN-1 409
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
2 EVENT RECORDS
General Electric devices record events in an event log. This allows you to establish the sequence of events that led
up to a particular situation. For example, a change in a digital input signal or protection element output signal
would cause an event record to be created and stored in the event log. This could be used to analyse how a
particular power system condition was caused. These events are stored in the IED's non-volatile memory. Each
event is time tagged.
The event records can be displayed on an IED's front panel but it is easier to view them through the settings
application software. This can extract the events log from the device and store it as a single .evt file for analysis on
a PC.
The event records are detailed in the VIEW RECORDS column. The first event (0) is always the latest event. After
selecting the required event, you can scroll through the menus to obtain further details.
If viewing the event with the settings application software, simply open the extracted event file. All the events are
displayed chronologically. Each event is summarised with a time stamp (obtained from the Time & Date cell) and a
short description relating to the event (obtained from the Event Text cell. You can expand the details of the event
by clicking on the + icon to the left of the time stamp.
The following table shows the correlation between the fields in the setting application software's event viewer and
the cells in the menu database.
Field in Event Viewer Equivalent cell in menu DB Cell reference User settable?
Left hand column header VIEW RECORDS ® Time & Date 01 03 No
Right hand column header VIEW RECORDS ® Event Text 01 04 No
Description SYSTEM DATA ® Description 00 04 Yes
Plant reference SYSTEM DATA ® Plant Reference 00 05 Yes
Model number SYSTEM DATA ® Model Number 00 06 No
Address Displays the Courier address relating to the event N/A No
Event type VIEW RECORDS ® Menu Cell Ref 01 02 No
Event Value VIEW RECORDS ® Event Value 01 05 No
Evt Unique Id VIEW RECORDS ® Evt Unique ID 01 FE No
410 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
Standard events are further sub-categorised internally to include different pieces of information. These are:
● Protection events (starts and trips)
● Maintenance record events
● Platform events
Note:
The first event in the list (event 0) is the most recent event to have occurred.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 411
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
V01234
The event is logged as soon as the fault recorder stops. The time stamp assigned to the fault corresponds to the
start of the fault. The timestamp assigned to the fault record event corresponds to the time when the fault
recorder stops.
Note:
We recommend that you do not set the triggering contact to latching. This is because if you use a latching contact, the fault
record would not be generated until the contact has been fully reset.
412 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
The Event Value cell for this type of event is a 32 bit binary string representing the state of the relevant DDB
signals. These binary strings can also be viewed in the COMMISSION TESTS column in the relevant DDB batch cells.
Not all DDB signals can generate an event. Those that can are listed in the RECORD CONTROL column. In this
column, you can set which DDBs generate events.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 413
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
3 DISTURBANCE RECORDER
The disturbance recorder feature allows you to record selected current and voltage inputs to the protection
elements, together with selected digital signals. The digital signals may be inputs, outputs, or internal DDB signals.
The disturbance records can be extracted using the disturbance record viewer in the settings application software.
The disturbance record file can also be stored in the COMTRADE format. This allows the use of other packages to
view the recorded data.
The integral disturbance recorder has an area of memory specifically set aside for storing disturbance records. The
number of records that can be stored is dependent on the recording duration. The minimum duration is 0.1 s and
the maximum duration is 10.5 s.
When the available memory is exhausted, the oldest records are overwritten by the newest ones.
Each disturbance record consists of a number of analogue data channels and digital data channels. The relevant
CT and VT ratios for the analogue channels are also extracted to enable scaling to primary quantities.
The fault recording times are set by a combination of the Duration and Trigger Position cells. The Duration cell
sets the overall recording time and the Trigger Position cell sets the trigger point as a percentage of the duration.
For example, the default settings show that the overall recording time is set to 1.5 s with the trigger point being at
33.3% of this, giving 0.5 s pre-fault and 1 s post fault recording times.
With the Trigger Mode set to Single, if further triggers occurs whilst a recording is taking place, the recorder will
ignore the trigger. However, with the Trigger Mode set to Extended, the post trigger timer will be reset to zero,
extending the recording time.
You can select any of the IED's analogue inputs as analogue channels to be recorded. You can also map any of the
opto-inputs output contacts to the digital channels. In addition, you may also map a number of DDB signals such
as Starts and LEDs to digital channels.
You may choose any of the digital channels to trigger the disturbance recorder on either a low to high or a high to
low transition, via the Input Trigger cell. The default settings are such that any dedicated trip output contacts will
trigger the recorder.
It is not possible to view the disturbance records locally via the front panel LCD. You must extract these using
suitable setting application software such as MiCOM S1 Agile.
414 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
4 MEASUREMENTS
P446SV-TM-EN-1 415
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
5 CB CONDITION MONITORING
The device records various statistics related to each circuit breaker trip operation, allowing an accurate
assessment of the circuit breaker condition to be determined. These statistics are available in the CB CONDITION
column. The menu cells are register values only and cannot be set directly. They may be reset, however, during
maintenance. The statistics monitored are:
● Total Current Broken: A register stores the total amount of current that the CB has broken is stored in an
accumulator, giving at any time a measure of the total amount of current that the CB has broken since the
value was last reset.
● Number of CB operations: A counter registers the number of CB trips that have been performed for each
phase, giving at any time the total number of trips that the CB has performed since the value was last reset.
● CB Operate Time: A register stores the total amount of time the CB has transitioned from closed to open is
stored in an accumulator, giving at any time a measure of the total time that the CB has spent tripping since
the values was last reset.
● Excessive Fault Frequency: A counter registers the number of CB trips that have been performed for all
phases, giving at any time the total number of trips performed since the value was last reset.
These statistics are available in the CB CONDITION column. The menu cells are register values only and cannot be
set directly. They may be reset, however, during maintenance.
Note:
When in Commissioning test mode the CB condition monitoring registers are not updated.
Circuit breaker lockout, can be caused by the following circuit breaker condition monitoring functions:
● Maintenance lockout
● Excessive fault frequency lockout
● Broken current lockout
If the circuit breaker is locked out, the logic generates a lockout alarm
416 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
CB1PhaseBCurrent
Set Set CB1 Cumulative IB broken In
Reset
CB1PhaseCCurrent
Set Set CB 1 Cumulative IC broken In
526
CB1 Trip 3ph t Reset
534
1
CB1 Ext Trip3ph 0
523 Note: Broken current totals not incremented when device is in test mode
CB1 Trip OutputA t 1
535 1
CB1 Ext Trip A 0
524
CB1 Trip OutputB t 1
536 1
CB1 Ext Trip B 0
525
CB1 Trip OutputC t 1
537
1
CB1 Ext Trip C 0
Reset CB Data
447
1
Reset CB Data
CB2PhaseACurrent
Set Set CB2 Cumulative IA broken In
Reset
CB2PhaseBCurrent
Set Set CB2 Cumulative IB broken In
Reset
CB2PhaseCCurrent
Set Set CB 2 Cumulative IC broken In
1600
CB2 Trip 3ph t Reset
538
1
CB2 Ext Trip3 ph 0
P446SV-TM-EN-1 417
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
523
Sortie Déc A DJ1 1 Incrément
535 1 DJ1 Compteur de
Déc. ext A DJ1
déclenchement Phase A
Réinit
524
Sortie Déc B DJ1 1 Incrément
536 1 DJ1 Compteur de
Déc. ext B DJ1
déclenchement Phase B
Réinit
525
Sortie Déc C DJ1 1 Incrément
537 1 DJ1 Compteur de
Déc. ext C DJ1
déclenchement Phase C
Réinit
RAZ Infos DJ1
447
1
RAZ Infos DJ1
1600
Déc 3ph DJ2
538
1
Déc. ext 3ph DJ2
1601
Sortie Déc A DJ2 1 Incrément
539 1 DJ2 Compteur de
Déc.2 Extern A
déclenchement Phase A
Réinit
1602
Sortie Déc B DJ2 1 Incrément
540 1 DJ2 Compteur de
Déc.2 Extern B
déclenchement Phase B
Réinit
1603
Sortie Déc C DJ2 1 Incrément
541 1 DJ2 Compteur de
Déc.2 Extern C
déclenchement Phase C
Réinit
RAZ Infos DJ2
1597
1
RAZ Données DJ2
V01277
418 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
523
CB1 Trip OutputA 1 Start
524
CB1 Trip OutputB 1 Start
1600
CB2 Trip 3ph
538 1
CB2 Ext Trip3ph
1601
CB2 Trip OutputA 1 Start
1602
CB2 Trip OutputB 1 Start
1603
CB2 Trip OutputC 1 Start
P446SV-TM-EN-1 419
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
CB1 LO Alarm
CB1FltFreqTime
CB2 LO Alarm
CB2FltFreqTime
V01279
420 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
CB1 Closed 3 ph
1
CB1 Closed A ph
CB1 Closed C ph
Rst CB mon LO by
CB Close
CB mon LO RstDly
CB mon LO reset
Yes
1 Reset CB2 Lockout Alarm
Clear Alarms
CB2 Closed 3 ph
1
CB2 Closed A ph
CB2 Closed C ph
Rst CB mon LO by
CB Close
CB mon LO RstDly
V01281
P446SV-TM-EN-1 421
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
CB1 I^ Maint S
Q 1 CB1 Monitor Alm
R
CB1 I^ Lockout
Alarm Enabled
& CB1 I^ Lockout
CB1 I^ Lockout
&
1 CB1 Pre-Lockout
-1
CB1FltFreqLock
Alarm Enabled
& S
Fault frequency count Q CB1 FaultFreqLock
R
CB1FltFreqCount
&
-1 1 CB1 Mon LO Alarm
CB1 Time Maint
Alarm Enabled
&
Greatest CB operate time & CB1 Time Maint
S
CB1 Time Maint Q
R
CB1 Time Lockout
Alarm Enabled
& CB1 Time Lockout
Clear Alarms 1
422 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
CB2 I^ Maint
Alarm Enabled
&
Greatest broken current total & CB2 I^ Maint
CB2 I^ Maint S
Q 1 CB2 Monitor Alm
R
CB2 I^ Lockout
Alarm Enabled
& CB2 I^ Lockout
CB2 I^ Lockout
&
1 CB2 Pre-Lockout
-1
CB2FltFreqLock
Alarm Enabled
& S
Fault frequency count
Q CB2 FaultFreqLock
R
CB2FltFreqCount
&
-1 1 CB2 Mon LO Alarm
CB2 Time Maint
Alarm Enabled
&
Greatest CB operate time & CB2 Time Maint
S
CB2 Time Maint Q
R
CB2 Time Lockout
Alarm Enabled
& CB2 Time Lockout
Clear Alarms 1
P446SV-TM-EN-1 423
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
If Res LO by CB IS is set to Enabled, a lockout is reset if the circuit breaker is successfully closed manually. For
this, the circuit breaker must remain closed long enough so that it enters the “In Service” state.
If Res LO by UI is set to Enabled, the circuit breaker lockout can be reset from a user interface using the reset
circuit breaker lockout command in the CB CONTROL column.
If Res LO by NoAR is set to Enabled, the circuit breaker lockout can be reset by temporarily generating an AR
disabled signal.
If Res LO by TDelay is set to Enabled, the circuit breaker lockout is automatically reset after a time delay set in
the LO Reset Time setting.
If Res LO by ExtDDB is Enabled, the circuit breaker lockout can be reset by activation of an external input
mapped in the PSL to the relevant reset lockout DDB signal.
424 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
Res LO by CB IS
Enabled
&
CB1CRLo
Res LO by UI
Enabled
&
Reset CB1 LO
Yes
Res LO by NoAR
Enabled
& 1 ResCB1Lo
ARDisabled
1
Num CBs
CB2 Only
Res LO by ExtDDB
Enabled
&
446
Rst CB1 Lockout
Res LO by TDelay
Enabled
&
LO Reset Time
306
t
CB1 AR Lockout
0
Res LO by CB IS
Enabled
&
CB2CRLo
Res LO by UI
Enabled
&
Reset CB2 LO
Yes
Res LO by NoAR
Enabled
& 1 ResCB2Lo
ARDisabled
1
Num CBs
CB2 Only
Res LO by ExtDDB
Enabled
&
1422
Rst CB2 Lockout
Res LO by TDelay
Enabled
&
LO Reset Time
328
t
CB2 AR Lockout
0
V03383
Figure 233: Reset Circuit Breaker Lockout Logic Diagram (Modules 57 & 58)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 425
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
The dielectric withstand of the oil generally decreases as a function of I2t, where ‘I’ is the broken fault current and
‘t’ is the arcing time within the interrupter tank. The arcing time cannot be determined accurately, but is generally
dependent on the type of circuit breaker being used. Instead, you set a factor (Broken I^) with a value between 1
and 2, depending on the circuit breaker.
Most circuit breakers would have this value set to '2', but for some types of circuit breaker, especially those
operating on higher voltage systems, a value of 2 may be too high. In such applications Broken I^ may be set
lower, typically 1.4 or 1.5.
The setting range for Broken I^ is variable between 1.0 and 2.0 in 0.1 steps.
Note:
Any maintenance program must be fully compliant with the switchgear manufacturer’s instructions.
426 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
6 CB STATE MONITORING
CB State monitoring is used to verify the open or closed state of a circuit breaker. Most circuit breakers have
auxiliary contacts through which they transmit their status (open or closed) to control equipment such as IEDs.
These auxiliary contacts are known as:
● 52A for contacts that follow the state of the CB
● 52B for contacts that are in opposition to the state of the CB
This device can be set to monitor both of these types of circuit breaker state indication. If the state is unknown for
some reason, an alarm can be raised.
Some CBs provide both sets of contacts. If this is the case, these contacts will normally be in opposite states.
Should both sets of contacts be open, this would indicate one of the following conditions:
● Auxiliary contacts/wiring defective
● Circuit Breaker (CB) is defective
● CB is in isolated position
Should both sets of contacts be closed, only one of the following two conditions would apply:
● Auxiliary contacts/wiring defective
● Circuit Breaker (CB) is defective
If any of the above conditions exist, an alarm will be issued after a 5 s time delay. An output contact can be
assigned to this function via the programmable scheme logic (PSL). The time delay is set to avoid unwanted
operation during normal switching duties.
In the CB CONTROL column there is a setting called CB Status Input. This cell can be set at one of the following
four options:
● None
● 52A
● 52B
● Both 52A and 52B
Where None is selected no CB status is available. Where only 52A is used on its own then the device will assume a
52B signal opposite to the 52A signal. Circuit breaker status information will be available in this case but no
discrepancy alarm will be available. The above is also true where only a 52B is used. If both 52A and 52B are used
then status information will be available and in addition a discrepancy alarm will be possible, according to the
following table:
Auxiliary Contact Position CB State Detected Action
52A 52B
Open Closed Breaker open Circuit breaker healthy
Closed Open Breaker closed Circuit breaker healthy
Alarm raised if the condition persists for greater than
Closed Closed CB failure
5s
Alarm raised if the condition persists for greater than
Open Open State unknown
5s
P446SV-TM-EN-1 427
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
424
CB1 Aux 3ph(52-B)
& 1 907
1 CB1 Closed 3 ph
XOR
&
&
&
421
CB1 Aux A(52-A)
&
425 908
CB1 Aux A(52-B) 1 CB1 Closed A ph
& 1
XOR
&
&
&
&
&
422 909
CB1 Aux B(52-A) 1 CB1 Closed B ph
905
Phase B 1 CB1 Open B ph
CB1 Status Input
(Same logic as phase A )
52A 1 pole
52B 1 pole
52A & 52B 1 pole
423 910
CB1 Aux C(52-A) 1 CB1 Closed C ph
906
Phase C 1 CB1 Open C ph
CB1 Status Input
(Same logic as phase A )
52A 1 pole
52B 1 pole 301
1 CB1 Status Alm
52A & 52B 1 pole
428 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
Circuit Breaker control is only possible if the circuit breaker in question provides auxiliary contacts. The CB Status
Input cell in the CB CONTROL column must be set to the type of circuit breaker. If no CB auxiliary contacts are
available then this cell should be set to None, and no CB control will be possible.
For local control, the CB control by cell should be set accordingly.
The output contact can be set to operate following a time delay defined by the setting Man Close Delay. One
reason for this delay is to give personnel time to safely move away from the circuit breaker following a CB close
command.
The control close cycle can be cancelled at any time before the output contact operates by any appropriate trip
signal, or by activating the Reset Close Dly DDB signal.
The length of the trip and close control pulses can be set via the Trip Pulse Time and Close Pulse Time settings
respectively. These should be set long enough to ensure the breaker has completed its open or close cycle before
the pulse has elapsed.
If an attempt to close the breaker is being made, and a protection trip signal is generated, the protection trip
command overrides the close command.
The Reset Lockout by setting is used to enable or disable the resetting of lockout automatically from a manual
close after the time set by Man Close RstDly.
If the CB fails to respond to the control command (indicated by no change in the state of CB Status inputs) an
alarm is generated after the relevant trip or close pulses have expired. These alarms can be viewed on the LCD
display, remotely, or can be assigned to output contacts using the programmable scheme logic (PSL).
Note:
The CB Healthy Time and Sys Check time set under this menu section are applicable to manual circuit breaker operations
only. These settings are duplicated in the AUTORECLOSE menu for autoreclose applications.
The Lockout Reset and Reset Lockout by settings are applicable to CB Lockouts associated with manual circuit
breaker closure, CB Condition monitoring (Number of circuit breaker operations, for example) and autoreclose
lockouts.
The device includes the following options for control of a single circuit breaker:
● The IED menu (local control)
● The Hotkeys (local control)
● The function keys (local control)
● The opto-inputs (local control)
● SCADA communication (remote control)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 429
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
For this to work you have to set the CB control by cell to option 1 Local, option 3 Local + Remote, option 5
Opto+Local, or option 7 Opto+Local+Remote in the CB CONTROL column.
If the CB is currently closed, the command text on the bottom right of the LCD screen will read Trip. Conversely, if
the CB is currently open, the command text will read Close.
If you execute a Trip, a screen with the CB status will be displayed once the command has been completed. If
you execute a Close, a screen with a timing bar will appear while the command is being executed. This screen
also gives you the option to cancel or restart the close procedure. The time delay is determined by the Man Close
Delay setting in the CB CONTROL menu. When the command has been executed, a screen confirming the present
status of the circuit breaker is displayed. You are then prompted to select the next appropriate command or exit.
If no keys are pressed for a period of 5 seconds while waiting for the command confirmation, the device will revert
to showing the CB Status. If no key presses are made for a period of 25 seconds while displaying the CB status
screen, the device will revert to the default screen.
To avoid accidental operation of the trip and close functionality, the hotkey CB control commands are disabled for
10 seconds after exiting the hotkey menu.
The hotkey functionality is summarised graphically below:
Default Display
HOTKEY CB CTRL
Hotkey Menu
CB closed CB open
TRIP EXIT CONFIRM CANCEL EXIT CLOSE CANCEL CONFIRM CANCEL RESTART
E01209
430 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
default PSL is set up such that Function key 2 initiates a trip and Function key 3 initiates a close. For this to work
you have to set the CB control by cell to option 5 Opto+Local, or option 7 Opto+Local+Remote in the CB
CONTROL column.
As shown below, function keys 2 and 3 have already been assigned to CB control in the default PSL.
The programmable function key LEDs have been mapped such that they will indicate yellow whilst the keys are
activated.
Note:
Not all models provide function keys.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 431
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
Protection Trip
Trip
Remote
Control
Trip Close
Remote
Control
Close
Local
Remote
Trip Close
E01207
432 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
Following manual circuit breaker closure, if either a single phase or a three phase fault occur, the circuit breaker is
tripped three phase, but Autoreclose is not locked out for this condition.
440 &
Init close CB1 Man Close Delay Close Pulse Time
1 842
CB1 Close inProg
HMI Close
& S t
CB1 ARIP 1544 Q 839
RD 0 & Control CloseCB1
854
1 S t
Auto Close CB1 Q
RD 0
443
Rst CB1 CloseDly
522 303
Any Trip & CB1 Close Fail
1
838
Control TripCB1
534
CB1 Ext Trip3ph 1
1
535
CB1 Ext Trip A
536
CB1 Ext Trip B
537
CB1 Ext Trip C
1 1
903
CB1 Open 3 ph
904
CB1 Open A ph
905
CB1 Open B ph &
906
CB1 Open C ph
907
CB1 Closed 3 ph
1
908
CB1 Closed A ph
910
CB1 Closed C ph
t 304
436
& ManCB1 Unhealthy
CB1 Healthy 0
t 305
1574
& NoCS CB1ManClose
CB1 Man SCOK 0
V03370
P446SV-TM-EN-1 433
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
CB Control by
Opto
Opto +Local Note: If the DDB signal CB 1 Healthy, or CB2 healthy is not mapped in PSL , it defaults to
1 High.
Opto+Remote
Opto+Rem+Local
Trip Pulse Time
840
HMI Trip Control TripCB2
1
& S t
441
& Q 324
Init Trip CB2 RD 0 & CB2 Trip Fail
442 &
Init close CB2 Man Close Delay Close Pulse Time
1 1453
CB2 Close inProg
HMI Close
& S t
CB2 ARIP 1435 Q 841
RD 0 & Control CloseCB2
1448
1 S t
Auto Close CB2 Q
RD 0
1419
Rst CB2 CloseDly
522 325
Any Trip & CB2 Close Fail
1
840
Control TripCB2
538
CB2 Ext Trip3ph 1
1
539
CB2 Ext Trip A
540
CB2 Ext Trip B
541
CB2 Ext Trip C
1 1
911
CB2 Open 3 ph
912
CB2 Open A ph
913
CB2 Open B ph &
914
CB2 Open C ph
915
CB2 Closed 3 ph
1
916
CB2 Closed A ph
918
CB2 Closed C ph
t 326
437
& ManCB2 Unhealthy
CB2 Healthy 0
t 327
1458
& NoCS CB2ManClose
CB2 Man SCOK 0
V03344
434 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
It can also be used to block operation of underfrequency and undervoltage elements where applicable.
V<
CB1 Open A ph
&
CB2 Open A ph
IB 20 ms
V<
CB1 Open B ph
&
CB2 Open B ph
IC 20 ms
CB1 Open 3 ph
&
CB2 Open 3 ph
V01269
If both the line current and voltage values fall below a certain threshold, or a CB Open condition is asserted from
the state control logic, the device initiates a Pole Dead condition. The current and voltage thresholds can be set
with the I< Current Set and the V< settings respectively, in the CBFAIL&P.DEAD column.
If one or more poles are dead, the device indicates which phase is dead and asserts the Any Pole Dead DDB
signal. If all phases are dead the Any Pole Dead signal is accompanied by the All Poles Dead signal.
If the VT fails, a VTS Slow Block signal is taken from the VTS logic to block the Pole Dead indications that would be
generated by the undervoltage and undercurrent thresholds.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 435
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
9 SYSTEM CHECKS
In some situations it is possible for both "bus" and "line" sides of a circuit breaker to be live when a circuit breaker is
open - for example at the ends of a feeder that has a power source at each end. Therefore, it is normally necessary
to check that the network conditions on both sides are suitable, before closing the circuit breaker. This applies to
both manual circuit breaker closing and autoreclosing. If a circuit breaker is closed when the line and bus voltages
are both live, with a large phase angle, frequency or magnitude difference between them, the system could be
subjected to an unacceptable shock, resulting in loss of stability, and possible damage to connected machines.
The System Checks functionality involves monitoring the voltages on both sides of a circuit breaker, and if both
sides are live, performing a synchronisation check to determine whether any differences in voltage magnitude,
phase angle or frequency are within permitted limits.
The pre-closing system conditions for a given circuit breaker depend on the system configuration, and for
autoreclosing, on the selected autoreclose program. For example, on a feeder with delayed autoreclosing, the
circuit breakers at the two line ends are normally arranged to close at different times. The first line end to close
usually has a live bus and a dead line immediately before reclosing. The second line end circuit breaker now sees a
live bus and a live line.
If there is a parallel connection between the ends of the tripped feeder the frequencies will be the same, but any
increased impedance could cause the phase angle between the two voltages to increase. Therefore just before
closing the second circuit breaker, it may be necessary to perform a synchronisation check, to ensure that the
phase angle between the two voltages has not increased to a level that would cause unacceptable shock to the
system when the circuit breaker closes.
If there are no parallel interconnections between the ends of the tripped feeder, the two systems could lose
synchronism altogether and the frequency at one end could "slip" relative to the other end. In this situation, the
second line end would require a synchronism check comprising both phase angle and slip frequency checks.
If the second line-end busbar has no power source other than the feeder that has tripped; the circuit breaker will
see a live line and dead bus assuming the first circuit breaker has re-closed. When the second line end circuit
breaker closes the bus will charge from the live line (dead bus charge).
9.1.1 VT CONNECTIONS
The device provides inputs for a three-phase "Main VT" and at least one single-phase VT for check synchronisation.
Depending on the primary system arrangement, the Main VT may be located on either the line-side of the busbar-
side of the circuit breaker, with the Check Sync VT on the other. Normally, the Main VT is located on the line-side (as
per the default setting), but this is not always the case. For this reason, a setting is provided where you can define
this. This is the Main VT Location setting, which is found in the CT AND VT RATIOS column.
436 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
The Check Sync VT may be connected to one of the phase-to-phase voltages or phase-to-neutral voltages. This
needs to be defined using the CS Input setting in the CT AND VT RATIOS column. Options are, A-B, B-C, C-A, A-N, B-
N, or C-N.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 437
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
0º
Check Sync
Stage 2 Limits
Check Sync
Stage 1 Limits
V
BUS
Live Volts
Rotating
Vector
Nomical
Volts
V LINE
Dead Volts
±180º
System Split
E01204 Limits
438 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
VAN 888
Live Line & Live Line
VBN
VCN 889
Select Dead Line & Dead line
VAB
VBC 886
Live Bus 1 & Live Bus 1
VCA
VBus 2
1461
Live Bus 2 & Live Bus 2
MCB/VTS 438
1521 1462
MCB/VTS CB1 CS Dead Bus 2 & Dead Bus 2
1423
MCB/VTS CB2 CS
Voltage Monitors
1522 1
Inhibit LL
1523 1
Inhibit DL
1524 1
Inhibit LB 1
1525
1
Inhibit DB 1
1424 1
Inhibit LB 2
1425 1
Inhibit DB 2
V 01258
P446SV-TM-EN-1 439
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
CS Vbus1< 1582
& CS Vbus<
CB1 CS1 Vl>Vb 1586
& CB1 CS1 Vl> Vb
CB1 CS1 Vl<Vb 1588
& CB1 CS1 Vl< Vb
CB1 CS1 Fl>Fb 1590
& CB1 CS1 Fl>Fb
CB1 CS1 Fl<Fb 1591
& CB1 CS1 Fl<Fb
CB1 CS1 AngHigh+ 1592
& CB1 CS1 AngHigh+
CB1 CS1 AngHigh- 1593
& CB1 CS1 AngHigh-
CB1 CS2 Fl>Fb 1493
& CB1 CS2 Fl>Fb
CB1 CS2 Fl<Fb 1494
& CB1 CS2 Fl<Fb
CB1 CS2 AngHigh+ 1495
& CB1 CS2 AngHigh+
CB1 CS2 AngHigh- 1496
& CB1 CS2 AngHigh-
CB1 CS AngRotACW 1594
& CB1 CS AngRotACW
1521
MCB/VTS CB CS CB1 CS AngRotCW 1595
438 & CB1 CS AngRotCW
MCB/VTS
832 CB1 CS2 Vl>Vb 1587
VTS Fast Block & CB1 CS2 Vl> Vb
1
319
F out of Range CB1 CS2 Vl<Vb 1589
& CB1 CS2 Vl< Vb
CB1 CS1 Status
883
Enabled & CB1 CS1 OK
881
CB1 CS1 Enabled
CB1 CS2 Status
884
Enabled & CB1 CS2 OK
882
CB1 CS2 Enabled V01260
Figure 243: Check Synchronisation Monitor for CB1 closure (Module 60)
440 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
Sys checks CB 2
1484
Disabled SChksInactiveCB 2
Enabled
CS1 Criteria OK
VAN &
&
CS Vbus2> 1585
& CS Vbus2>
&
CS Vbus2<
Check Synchronisation Function
1584
& CS Vbus2<
CB2 CS1 Vl>Vb 1470
& CB2 CS1 Vl> Vb
CB2 CS1 Vl<Vb 1472
& CB2 CS1 Vl< Vb
CB2 CS1 Fl>Fb 1474
& CB2 CS1 Fl>Fb
CB2 CS1 Fl<Fb 1476
& CB2 CS1 Fl<Fb
CB2 CS1 AngHigh+ 1478
& CB2 CS1 AngHigh+
CB2 CS1 AngHigh- 1479
& CB2 CS1 AngHigh-
CB2 CS2 Fl>Fb 1475
& CB2 CS2 Fl>Fb
CB2 CS2 Fl<Fb 1477
& CB2 CS2 Fl<Fb
CB2 CS2 AngHigh+ 1480
& CB2 CS2 AngHigh+
CB2 CS2 AngHigh- 1481
& CB2 CS2 AngHigh-
CB2 CS AngRotACW 1482
& CB2 CS AngRotACW
1521
MCB/VTS CB CS CB2 CS AngRotCW 1483
438 & CB2 CS AngRotCW
MCB/VTS
832 CB2 CS2 Vl>Vb 1471
VTS Fast Block & CB2 CS2 Vl> Vb
1
319
F out of Range CB2 CS2 Vl<Vb 1473
& CB2 CS2 Vl< Vb
CB2 CS1 Status
1577
Enabled & CB2 CS1 OK
1426
CB2 CS1 Enabled
CB2 CS2 Status
884
Enabled & CB1 CS2 OK
1427
CB2 CS2 Enabled V01268
Figure 244: Check Synchronisation Monitor for CB2 closure (Module 61)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 441
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
SysChks Inactive
Check Sync 1 OK
Check Sync 2 OK
&
Dead Line
&
Live Bus
V02028
442 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control
P446SV-TM-EN-1 443
Chapter 16 - Monitoring and Control P446SV
444 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 17
SUPERVISION
Chapter 17 - Supervision P446SV
446 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 17 - Supervision
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter describes the supervison functions.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 447
Voltage Transformer Supervision 448
Current Transformer Supervision 452
Trip Circuit Supervision 454
P446SV-TM-EN-1 447
Chapter 17 - Supervision P446SV
The first condition would require VTS to block the voltage-dependent functions.
In the second condition, voltage dependent functions should not be blocked, as tripping is required.
To differentiate between these two conditions an overcurrent level detector is used (VTS I> Inhibit). This prevents a
VTS block from being issued in case of a genuine fault. This overcurrent level detector is only enabled for 240 ms
448 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 17 - Supervision
following line energization (based on an All Poles Dead signal drop off). It must still be set in excess of any non-
fault based currents on line energisation (load, line charging current, transformer inrush current if applicable), but
below the level of current produced by a close-up three-phase fault.
If the line is closed where a three-phase VT failure is present, the overcurrent detector will not operate and a VTS
block will be applied. Closing onto a three-phase fault will result in operation of the overcurrent detector and
prevent a VTS block being applied.
Thresholds
The negative sequence thresholds used by the element are:
● V2 = 10 V (fixed)
● I2 = 0.05 to 0.5 In settable (default 0.05 In).
Fuse Fail
The device includes a setting (VT Connected ) in the CT AND VT RATIOS column, which determines whether there
are voltage transformers connected to it. If set to Yes, this setting has no effect.
If set to No it causes the VTS logic to set the VTS Slow Block and VTS Fast Block DDBs, but not raise any alarms. It
also disables the VTS function. This prevents the pole dead logic working incorrectly if there is no voltage or
current. It also blocks the distance, under voltage and other voltage-dependant functions. However, it does not
affect the CB open part of the logic.
A VTS condition can be raised by a mini circuit breaker (MCB) status input, by internal logic using IED
measurement, or both. The setting VTS Mode is used to select the method of indicating VT failure.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 449
Chapter 17 - Supervision P446SV
IA
240ms
VTS I> Inhibit
IB &
1
VTS I> Inhibit
IC
VA
Hardcoded threshold
Delta IA
Hardcoded threshold
&
V2
MCB/VTS
VTS Status
Indication
Blocking
1 S 1 VT Fail Alarm
Any Pole Dead & Q
240ms R
& 20ms
VTS Acc Ind
5
Cycle
1½
½ Cycle
Cycle
VT Fast Block 1 Block Distance
&
All Poles Dead ½
Cycle
V01261
450 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 17 - Supervision
Note:
All non-distance voltage-dependent elements are blocked by the VTS Fast Block DDB.
If a miniature circuit breaker (MCB) is used to protect the voltage transformer output circuits, MCB auxiliary
contacts can be used to indicate a three-phase output disconnection. It is possible for the VTS logic to operate
correctly without this input, but this facility has been provided to maintain compatibility with some practises.
Energising an opto-isolated input assigned to the MCB/VTS provides the necessary block.
The VTS function is inhibited if:
● An All Poles Dead DDB signal is present
● Any phase overcurrent condition exists
● A Negative Phase Sequence current exists
● If the phase current changes over the period of 1 cycle
P446SV-TM-EN-1 451
Chapter 17 - Supervision P446SV
452 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 17 - Supervision
& Pickup S
CTS IN> Set
Q CT1 Fail Alarm
VN & R
CTS Status 1
In indication mode , timer is set to 20 ms
Indication
Restrain
& Pickup S
CTS IN> Set
Q CT2 Fail Alarm
VN & R
Inhibit CTS
1
Disable CTS
CTS Status 1
In indication mode , timer is set to 20 ms
Indication
Where the magnitude of residual voltage during an earth fault is unpredictable, the element can be disabled to
prevent protection elements being blocked during fault conditions.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 453
Chapter 17 - Supervision P446SV
Note:
A 52a CB auxiliary contact follows the CB position. A 52b auxiliary contact is the opposite.
+ve
Blocking diode
52B
When the CB is closed, supervision current passes through the opto-input, blocking diode and trip coil. When the
CB is open, supervision current flows through the opto-input and into the trip coil via the 52b auxiliary contact.
This means that Trip Coil supervision is provided when the CB is either closed or open, however Trip Path
supervision is only provided when the CB is closed. No supervision of the trip path is provided whilst the CB is open
(pre-closing supervision). Any fault in the trip path will only be detected on CB closing, after a 400 ms delay.
454 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 17 - Supervision
Trip Circuit Voltage Opto Voltage Setting with R1 Fitted Resistor R1 (ohms)
110/125 48/54 2.7k
220/250 110/125 5.2k
Warning:
This Scheme is not compatible with Trip Circuit voltages of less than 48 V.
0 0
Opto Input dropoff Straight *Output Relay
400 0
50
& pickup Latching LED
0
User Alarm
The opto-input can be used to drive a Normally Closed Output Relay, which in turn can be used to drive alarm
equipment. The signal can also be inverted to drive a latching programmable LED and a user alarm DDB signal.
The DDO timer operates as soon as the opto-input is energised, but will take 400 ms to drop off/reset in the event
of a trip circuit failure. The 400 ms delay prevents a false alarm due to voltage dips caused by faults in other
circuits or during normal tripping operation when the opto-input is shorted by a self-reset trip contact. When the
timer is operated the NC (normally closed) output relay opens and the LED and user alarms are reset.
The 50 ms delay on pick-up timer prevents false LED and user alarm indications during the power up time,
following a voltage supply interruption.
+ve
52B
R1 Opto-input 1
Circuit Breaker
-ve
R2 Opto-input 2
V01215
P446SV-TM-EN-1 455
Chapter 17 - Supervision P446SV
When the breaker is closed, supervision current passes through opto input 1 and the trip coil. When the breaker is
open current flows through opto input 2 and the trip coil. No supervision of the trip path is provided whilst the
breaker is open. Any fault in the trip path will only be detected on CB closing, after a 400 ms delay.
Warning:
This Scheme is not compatible with Trip Circuit voltages of less than 48 V.
0 0
1 dropoff straight *Output Relay
400 0
50
& pickup Latching LED
0
User Alarm
In TCS scheme 2, both opto-inputs must be low before a trip circuit fail alarm is given.
+ve
R3
Output Relay Trip coil
Trip path 52A
R2
52B
When the CB is closed, supervision current passes through the opto-input, resistor R2 and the trip coil. When the
CB is open, current flows through the opto-input, resistors R1 and R2 (in parallel), resistor R3 and the trip coil. The
456 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 17 - Supervision
supervision current is maintained through the trip path with the breaker in either state, therefore providing pre-
closing supervision.
Warning:
This Scheme is not compatible with Trip Circuit voltages of less than 48 V.
0 0
Opto Input dropoff Straight *Output Relay
400 0
50
& pickup Latching LED
0
User Alarm
P446SV-TM-EN-1 457
Chapter 17 - Supervision P446SV
458 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 18
460 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter introduces the PSL (Programmable Scheme Logic) Editor, and describes the configuration of the digital
inputs and outputs. It provides an outline of scheme logic concepts and the PSL Editor. This is followed by details
about allocation of the digital inputs and outputs, which require the use of the PSL Editor. A separate "Settings
Application Software" document is available that gives a comprehensive description of the PSL, but enough
information is provided in this chapter to allow you to allocate the principal digital inputs and outputs.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 461
Configuring Digital Inputs and Outputs 462
Scheme Logic 463
Configuring the Opto-Inputs 465
Assigning the Output Relays 466
Fixed Function LEDs 467
Configuring Programmable LEDs 468
Function Keys 470
Control Inputs 471
P446SV-TM-EN-1 461
Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration P446SV
462 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration
3 SCHEME LOGIC
The product is supplied with pre-loaded Fixed Scheme Logic (FSL) and Programmable Scheme Logic (PSL).
The Scheme Logic is a functional module within the IED, through which all mapping of inputs to outputs is handled.
The scheme logic can be split into two parts; the Fixed Scheme Logic (FSL) and the Programmable Scheme Logic
(PSL). It is built around a concept called the digital data bus (DDB). The DDB encompasses all of the digital signals
(DDBs) which are used in the FSL and PSL. The DDBs included digital inputs, outputs, and internal signals.
The FSL is logic that has been hard-coded in the product. It is fundamental to correct interaction between various
protection and/or control elements. It is fixed and cannot be changed.
The PSL gives you a facility to develop custom schemes to suit your application if the factory-programmed default
PSL schemes do not meet your needs. Default PSL schemes are programmed before the product leaves the
factory. These default PSL schemes have been designed to suit typical applications and if these schemes suit your
requirements, you do not need to take any action. However, if you want to change the input-output mappings, or
to implement custom scheme logic, you can change these, or create new PSL schemes using the PSL editor.
The PSL consists of components such as logic gates and timers, which combine and condition DDB signals.
The logic gates can be programmed to perform a range of different logic functions. The number of inputs to a logic
gate are not limited. The timers can be used either to create a programmable delay or to condition the logic
outputs. Output contacts and programmable LEDs have dedicated conditioners.
The PSL logic is event driven. Only the part of the PSL logic that is affected by the particular input change that has
occurred is processed. This minimises the amount of processing time used by the PSL ensuring industry leading
performance.
The following diagram shows how the scheme logic interacts with the rest of the IED.
Goose inputs
V02011
P446SV-TM-EN-1 463
Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration P446SV
Example:
Date/time: This cell displays the date and time when the PSL scheme was downloaded to the IED.
Example:
18 Nov 2002
08:59:32.047
Grp(n) PSL ID: This cell displays a unique ID number for the downloaded PSL scheme.
Example:
Grp(n) PSL ID
ID - 2062813232
464 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration
P446SV-TM-EN-1 465
Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration P446SV
Note:
Contact Conditioners are only available if they have not all been used. In some default PSL schemes, all Contact Conditioners
might have been used. If that is the case, and you want to use them for something else, you will need to re-assign them.
On the toolbar there is another button associated with the relay outputs. The button looks like this:
This is the "Contact Signal" button. It allows you to put replica instances of a conditioned output relay into the PSL,
preventing you having to make cross-page connections which might detract from the clarity of the scheme.
466 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration
You enable the automatic self-resetting with the Sys Fn Links cell in the SYSTEM DATA column. A '0' disables self
resetting and a '1' enables self resetting.
The reset occurs when the circuit is reclosed and the Any Pole Dead signal has been reset for three seconds
providing the Any Start signal is inactive. The reset is prevented if the Any Start signal is active after the breaker
closes.
The Trip LED logic is as follows:
Any Trip S
Q Trip LED Trigger
Reset R
1
Reset Relays/LED
Sys Fn Links
Trip LED S/Reset
3s
&
Any Start
V01211
P446SV-TM-EN-1 467
Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration P446SV
DDB signals are mapped in the PSL and used to illuminate the LEDs. For single-coloured programmable LEDs there
is one DDB signal per LED. For tri-coloured LEDs there are two DDB signals associated with the LED. Asserting LED
# Grn will illuminate the LED green. Asserting LED # Red will illuminate the LED red. Asserting both DDB signals will
illuminate the LED amber.
The illumination of an LED is controlled by means of a conditioner. Using the conditioner, you can decide whether
the LEDs reflect the real-time state of the DDB signals, or whether illumination is latched pending user intervention.
To map an LED in the PSL you should use the LED Conditioner button in the toolbar to import it. You then condition
it according to your needs. The output(s) of the conditioner respect the attribute you have assigned.
The toolbar button for a tri-colour LED looks like this:
Note:
LED Conditioners are only available if they have not all been used up, and in some default PSL schemes they might be. If that
is the case and you want to use them for something else, you will need to re-assign them.
On the toolbar there is another button associated with the LEDs. For a tri-coloured LED the button looks like this:
It is the "LED Signal" button. It allows you to put replica instances of a conditioned LED into the PSL, preventing you
having to make cross-page connections which might detract from the clarity of the scheme.
468 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration
Note:
All LED DDB signals are always shown in the PSL Editor. However, the actual number of LEDs depends on the device
hardware. For example, if a small 20TE device has only 4 programmable LEDs, LEDs 5-8 will not take effect even if they are
mapped in the PSL.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 469
Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration P446SV
8 FUNCTION KEYS
For most models, a number of programmable function keys are available. This allows you to assign function keys
to control functionality via the programmable scheme logic (PSL). Each function key is associated with a
programmable tri-colour LED, which you can program to give the desired indication on activation of the function
key.
These function keys can be used to trigger any function that they are connected to as part of the PSL. The function
key commands are found in the FUNCTION KEYS column.
Each function key is associated with a DDB signal as shown in the DDB table. You can map these DDB signals to
any function available in the PSL.
The Fn Key Status cell displays the status (energised or de-energised) of the function keys by means of a binary
string, where each bit represents a function key starting with bit 0 for function key 1.
Each function key has three settings associated with it, as shown:
● Fn Key (n), which enables or disables the function key
● Fn Key (n) Mode, which allows you to configure the key as toggled or normal
● Fn Key (n) label, which allows you to define the function key text that is displayed
The Fn Key (n) cell is used to enable (unlock) or disable (unlock) the function key signals in PSL. The Lock setting has
been provided to prevent further activation on subsequent key presses. This allows function keys that are set to
Toggled mode and their DDB signal active ‘high’, to be locked in their active state therefore preventing any
further key presses from deactivating the associated function. Locking a function key that is set to the “Normal”
mode causes the associated DDB signals to be permanently off. This safety feature prevents any inadvertent
function key presses from activating or deactivating critical functions.
When the Fn Key (n) Mode cell is set to Toggle, the function key DDB signal output will remain in the set state
until a reset command is given. In the Normal mode, the function key DDB signal will remain energised for as long
as the function key is pressed and will then reset automatically. In this mode, a minimum pulse duration can be
programmed by adding a minimum pulse timer to the function key DDB output signal.
The Fn Key Label cell makes it possible to change the text associated with each individual function key. This text
will be displayed when a function key is accessed in the function key menu, or it can be displayed in the PSL.
The status of all function keys are recorded in non-volatile memory. In case of auxiliary supply interruption their
status will be maintained.
Note:
All function key DDB signals are always shown in the PSL Editor. However, the actual number of function keys depends on the
device hardware. For example, if a small 20TE device has no function keys, the function key DDBs mapped in the PSL will not
take effect.
470 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration
9 CONTROL INPUTS
The control inputs are software switches, which can be set or reset locally or remotely. These inputs can be used to
trigger any PSL function to which they are connected. There are three setting columns associated with the control
inputs: CONTROL INPUTS, CTRL I/P CONFIG and CTRL I/P LABELS. These are listed in the Settings and Records
appendix at the end of this manual.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 471
Chapter 18 - Digital I/O and PSL Configuration P446SV
472 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 19
FIBRE TELEPROTECTION
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV
474 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter provides information about the fibre-optic communication mechanism,which is used to provide unit
schemes and general-purpose teleprotection signalling for protection of transmission lines and distribution
feeders. The feature is called Fibre Teleprotection.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 475
Protection Signalling Introduction 476
Fibre Teleprotection Implementation 478
IM64 Logic 485
Application Notes 487
P446SV-TM-EN-1 475
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV
Direct Tripping
In direct tripping applications (also known as intertripping), signals are sent directly to the master trip relay. Receipt
of the command causes circuit breaker operation. The method of communication must be reliable and secure
because any signal detected at the receiving end causes a trip of the circuit at that end. The communications
system must be designed so that interference on the communication circuit does not cause spurious trips. If a
spurious trip occurs, the primary system might be unnecessarily isolated.
Permissive Tripping
Permissive trip commands are always monitored by a protection relay. The circuit breaker is tripped when receipt
of the command coincides with a ‘start’ condition being detected by the protection relay at the receiving end
responding to a system fault. Requirements for the communications channel are less onerous than for direct
476 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection
tripping schemes, since receipt of an incorrect signal must coincide with a ‘start’ of the receiving end protection for
a trip operation to take place. The intention of these schemes is to speed up tripping for faults occurring within the
protected zone.
Blocking Scheme
Blocking commands are initiated by a protection element that detects faults external to the protected zone.
Detection of an external fault at the local end of a protected circuit results in a blocking signal being transmitted to
the remote end. At the remote end, receipt of the blocking signal prevents the remote end protection operating if it
had detected the external fault. Loss of the communications channel is less serious for this scheme than in others
as loss of the channel does not result in a failure to trip when required. However, the risk of a spurious trip is higher.
Historically, pilot wires and channels (discontinuous pilot wires with isolation transformers or repeaters along the
route between signalling points) have been the most widely used due to their availability, followed by Power Line
Carrier Communications (PLCC) techniques and radio. In recent years, fibre-optic systems have become the usual
choice for new installations, primarily due to their complete immunity from electrical interference. The use of fibre-
optic cables also greatly increases the number of communication channels available for each physical fibre
connection and thus enables more comprehensive monitoring of the power system to be achieved by the
provision of a large number of communication channels.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 477
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV
478 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection
Rx IED B Tx
Ch1 Ch2
Tx Rx
Remote 1
Tx Rx Tx Rx
Ch2 Ch1
Local Remote 2
IED A IED C
Ch1 Ch2
Rx Tx Rx Tx
V02500
Note:
A universal address (0-0) is used as default. If this is used all products use the same address ‘0-0’. This is primarily intended to
help test the product before it goes into service. We strongly recommend not to use 0-0 in service since any communications
switching or loopback condition will not be detected and may cause false tripping.
Note:
For a three-terminal scheme, the A, B, and C parts of the address group should match the figure shown earlier for a
triangulated scheme where device A has address A, device B has address B, and device C has address C.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 479
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV
480 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection
local Ch1 Tx connects to a remote Ch2 Rx, and the corresponding Ch1 Rx and Ch2 Tx are connected together as
shown in the earlier figure (Fibre Teleprotection Connections for a Three Terminal Scheme).
This Three Terminal scheme uses a triangulation approach and is designed to function if a communications link
between two terminals is not present or is degraded. 8 duplex teleprotection commands are available between
any pair of terminals even if one communication channel fails.
Logical Channel 1 is associated with Physical Channel 1, and Logical Channel 2 is associated with Physical Channel
2.
Consider a Three terminal scheme where the terminals are referenced as Local, Remote1, and Remote2. Remote 1
correlates to Ch1, and Remote 2 correlates to Ch2. The Local terminal will send the commands that it wants
Remote 1 to act on to both Remote 1 and Remote 2. Upon receipt, Remote 1 acts upon the commands that the
Local terminal wants it to use. Remote 1 also packages the commands that it wants Remote 2 to use, together
with a copy of the commands that Local wants Remote 2 to use, and also the commands it wants Local to use.
Remote 1 sends the message to Remote2. Remote 2 acts similarly. The same process occurs in the opposite
direction around the ring, so in the event of a single channel failure, and if all terminals have the same mappings
for the 8 IM64 bits integrity will be maintained for all 8 duplex commands between connected terminals.
In a triangulated scheme, at each terminal, Logical Channel 1 commands are assigned to Physical Channel 1, and
Logical Channel 2 commands are assigned to Physical Channel 2. At each terminal, the eight IM64 commands
transmitted on Physical Channel 1 are intended for the device connected as its Remote 1, and the eight IM64
commands transmitted on Channel 2 are intended for the device connected as its Remote 2. So, eight full-duplex
commands are available between any two terminals. Each device transmits both channels of eight IM64
commands to the connected devices. At the Remote 1 device, the eight Channel 1 IM64 commands are used
directly by the receiving device which passes through the eight Channel 2 IM64 commands to the remote 2 device.
All three devices in the scheme perform similarly, ensuring that, so long as one device is able to communicate with
the other two, scheme integrity is maintained.
This Chain topology (normally invoked when a communication link fails) can be used to save cost in a three-
terminal scheme. This is because two legs are cheaper to install than full triangulation implementation. Also if a
suitable communication link is not available between two of the line ends, it may be the only option. If a Chain
topology is used, or one link in a fully triangulated scheme is lost, the operating delay of the teleprotection
commands increases by approximately 7 ms, plus the communications channel signalling delay, due to the
extended path length and additional processing.
Connections are made using appropriate fibre-optic cables terminated with BFOC/2.5 connectors. The transmitter
of one device (for example Tx1) is connected to the receiver of another (Rx1 or Rx2 according to the scheme set-
up)
Products can be supplied with the following fibre-optic channel arrangements:
Ch 1 Ch2
850 nm 850 nm
P446SV-TM-EN-1 481
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV
Ch 1 Ch2
1300 nm multi-mode Not fitted
1300 nm multi-mode 1300 nm multi-mode
1300 nm single-mode Not fitted
1300 nm single-mode 1300 nm single-mode
1550 nm single-mode Not fitted
1550 nm single-mode 1550 nm single-mode
850 nm 1300 nm multi-mode
850 nm 1300 nm single-mode
850 nm 1550 nm single-mode
1300 nm multi-mode 850 nm
1300 nm single-mode 850 nm
1550 nm single-mode 850 nm
P59x interface units are housed in 10TE wide, 4U high cases. They provide optical-electrical conversion. The optical
characteristics match those of the 850nm interface on the protection device. When used, you need one unit for
each transmitter/receiver pair. That means one unit at each end of each communications channel as
demonstrated in the figure below.
482 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection
Multiplexer or Multiplexer or
Multiplexer
xDSL modem xDSL modem
Multiplexer or Multiplexer or
Multiplexer
xDSL modem xDSL modem
V02501
Note:
P59x interface units should be mounted as close as possible to the telecommunications equipment to minimise interference
on the electrical connections.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 483
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV
Note:
To use this configuration, you need to set Comms Mode to ‘IEEE C37.94’. You then need to remove the power supply from the
product and then re-apply the power. The setting is now effective. If ‘IEEE C37.94’ is used, it applies to both communication
channels.
The IEEE C37.94 standard defines an N*64 kbits/s selection, where N is a number between 1 and 12 and selects
the channel used in the multiplexer. The value of N is set on a per channel basis by setting Ch1 N*64kbits/s (and
Ch2 N*64kbits/s where applicable) to N (1 to 12). For convenience an auto-detect setting is provided. Setting to
Auto means that the device will automatically determine which multiplexer channel to use.
When P59x units are used in the communications channel of the protection scheme, the following must be set:
● Comms Mode
● Baud Rate Chn (n = 1 or 2)
● Clock Source Chn (n = 1 or 2)
You should set the Comms Mode setting to Standard, and you should match the Baud Rate to the channel data
rate.
For V.35, you should set the Clock Source to External for a multiplexer network which is supplying a master
clock signal, or to Internal for a multiplexer network recovering signal timing from the equipment (clock
recovery). For G.703 and X.21, you always set the clock source to External.
484 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection
4 IM64 LOGIC
Channel Timeout
t
No Received Messages Ch 1 Ch1 Timeout
0 t
1
Poor Channel Quality Ch 1 0 1 Signalling Fail
Ch1 Degraded
Channel Timeout
1
Scheme Setup &
3 terminal
&
V02502
Channel Timeout
3 terminal
1 Ch1 Timeout
3 terminal
Channel Timeout
3 terminal Signalling Fail
Channel Timeout
3 terminal
& Ch2 Timeout
Channel 2 IM64 Bits
received from channel 1
V02503
P446SV-TM-EN-1 485
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV
Message Evaluation
message (IEEE C37 .94) Ch1 Signal Lost
Message Info
Channel 1
Error in Transit
Ch1 Path Yellow
Message Info
Comms Mode
IEEE C37.94 Channel Mismatch Ch1 Mismatch RxN
Error in Receive
Message Evaluation
Ch2 Signal Lost
Message Info
Channel 1
Error in Transit
Ch2 Path Yellow
Message Info
Channel 2 Communication Channel Mismatch Ch2 Mismatch RxN
message (IEEE C37 .94)
Comms Mode
Standard S
Q
IEEE C37.94 RD
& Comms Changed
S
Q
RD
Relay Power Up
Fixed Pulse
V02504
Figure 260: IM64 communications mode and IEEE C37.94 alarm signals
486 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection
5 APPLICATION NOTES
Effective communications are essential for the performance of teleprotection schemes. Disturbances on the
communications links need to be detected and reported so that appropriate actions can be taken to ensure that
the power system does not go unprotected.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 487
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV
Opto 1
Control Input 1
Non-
Signalling Fail & Latching
LED 8
V02505
In this example scheme, several signals are used to permanently pass an IM64 signal to the remote terminal.
These signals take account of the local ability to receive IM64 messages, local test/loopback modes and any other
external methods of switching the signalling scheme out of service. If any of these driving signals are energised,
the IM64 message is reset (a “0” sent on IM64 bit 8). This causes both ends to raise an alarm (LED 8 in the example)
or switch the aided scheme out of service due to loss of channel.
This is intended only as an example. You may need to customise it for your application requirements.
Opto 1
Control Input 1
Non-
Signalling Fail & Latching
LED 8
V02506
In this example if both channels at any one terminal fail to receive information, this is communicated to the other
terminals. An alarm is raised and the aided scheme is switched out of service. The example given above, also takes
into account the test modes and local switching, so the scheme is signalled out of service at all terminals if one
terminal is locally disabled.
488 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection
The logic presented above is intended only as an example. You may need to customise it for your application
requirements.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 489
Chapter 19 - Fibre Teleprotection P446SV
490 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 20
ELECTRICAL TELEPROTECTION
Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection P446SV
492 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 493
Introduction 494
Teleprotection Scheme Principles 495
Implementation 496
Configuration 497
Connecting to Electrical InterMiCOM 499
Application Notes 500
P446SV-TM-EN-1 493
Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection P446SV
2 INTRODUCTION
Electrical Teleprotection is an optional feature that uses communications links to create protection schemes. It can
be used to replace hard wiring between dedicated relay output contacts and digital input circuits. Two products
equipped with electrical teleprotection can connect and exchange commands using a communication link. It is
typically used to implement teleprotection schemes.
Using full duplex communications, eight binary command signals can be sent in each direction between
connected products. The communication connection complies with the EIA(RS)232 standard. Ports may be
connected directly, or using modems. Alternatively EIA(RS)232 converters can be used for connecting to other
media such as optical fibres.
Communications statistics and diagnostics enable you to monitor the integrity of the communications link, and a
loopback feature is available to help with testing.
494 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection
P446SV-TM-EN-1 495
Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection P446SV
4 IMPLEMENTATION
Electrical InterMiCOM is configured using a combination of settings in the INTERMICOM COMMS column, settings in
the INTERMICOM CONF column, and the programmable scheme logic (PSL).
The eight command signals are mapped to DDB signals within the product using the PSL.
Signals being sent to a remote terminal are referenced in the PSL as IM Output 1 - IM Output 8. Signals received
from the remote terminal are referenced as IM Input 1 - IM Input 8.
Note:
As well as the optional Modem InterMiCOM, some products are available with a feature called InterMiCOM64 (IM64). The
functionality and assignment of commands in InterMiCOM and InterMiCOM64 are similar, but they act independently and are
configured independently.
496 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection
5 CONFIGURATION
Electrical Teleprotection is compliant with IEC 60834-1:1999. For your application, you can customise individual
command signals to the differing requirements of security, speed, and dependability as defined in this standard.
You customise the command signals using the IM# Cmd Type cell in the INTERMICOM CONF column.
Any command signal can be configured for:
● Direct intertripping by selecting ‘Direct’. (this is the most secure signalling but incurs a time delay to deliver
the security).
● Blocking applications by selecting ‘Blocking’. (this is the fastest signalling)
● Permissive intertripping applications by selecting ‘Permissive. (this is dependable signalling that balances
speed and security)
Note:
When used in the context of a setting, ‘#’ specifies which command signal (1-8) bit is being configured.
To ensure that command signals are processed only by their intended recipient, the command signals are
packaged into a message (sometimes referred to as a telegram) which contains an address field. A sending device
sets a pattern in this field. A receiving device must be set to match this pattern in the address field before the
commands will be acted upon. 10 patterns have been carefully chosen for maximum security. You need to choose
which ones to use, and set them using the Source Address and Receive Address cells in the INTERMICOM COMMS
column.
The value set in the Source Address of the transmitting device should match that set in the Receive Address of the
receiving device. For example set Source Address to 1 at a local terminal and set Receive Address to 1 at the
remote terminal.
The Source Address and Receive Address settings in the device should be set to different values to avoid false
operation under inadvertent loopback conditions.
Where more than one pair of devices is likely to share a communication link, you should set each pair to use a
different pair of address values.
Electrical InterMiCOM has been designed to be resilient to noise on communications links, but during severe noise
conditions, the communication may fail. If this is the case, an alarm is raised and you can choose how the input
signals are managed using the IM# FallBackMode cell in the INTERMICOM CONF column:
• If you choose Latched, the last valid command to be received can be maintained until a new valid message is
received.
• If you choose Default, the signal will revert to a default value after the period defined in the IM#
FrameSyncTim setting has expired. You choose the default value using the IM# DefaultValue setting.
Subsequent receipt of a full valid message will reset the alarm, and the new command signals will be used.
As well as the settings described above, you will need to assign input and output signals in the Programmable
Scheme Logic (PSL). Use the ‘Integral Tripping’ buttons to create the logic you want to apply. A typical example is
shown below.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 497
Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection P446SV
E002521
Note:
When an Electrical InterMiCOM signal is sent from a local terminal, only the remote terminal will react to the command. The
local terminal will only react to commands initiated at the remote terminal.
498 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection
IED IED
DCD 1 1 DCD
RxD 2 2 RxD
TxD 3 3 TxD
DTR 4 4 DTR
GND 5 5 GND
6 6
RTS 7 7 RTS
8 8
9 9
E02522
For direct connection, the maximum baud rate can generally be used.
E02523
This type of connection should be used when connecting to devices that have the ability to control the DCD line.
The baud rate should be chosen to be suitable for the communications network. If the Modem does not support
the DCD function, the DCD terminal on the IED should be connected to the DTR terminal.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 499
Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection P446SV
7 APPLICATION NOTES
Electrical InterMiCOM settings are contained within two columns; INTERMICOM COMMS and INTERMICOM CONF.
The INTERMICOM COMMS column contains all the settings needed to configure the communications, as well as the
channel statistics and diagnostic facilities. The INTERMICOM CONF column sets the mode of each command signal
and defines how they operate in case of signalling failure.
Short metallic direct connections and connections using fire-optic converters will generally be set to have the
highest signalling speed of 19200b/s. Due to this high signalling rate, the difference in operating time between the
direct, permissive, and blocking type signals is small. This means you can select the most secure signalling
command type (‘Direct’ intertrip) for all commands. You do this with the IM# Cmd Type settings. For these
applications you should set the IM# Fallback Mode to Default. You should also set a minimal intentional delay
by setting IM# FrameSyncTim to 10 msecs. This ensures that whenever two consecutive corrupt messages are
received, the command will immediately revert to the default value until a new valid message is received.
For applications that use Modem and/or multiplexed connections, the trade-off between speed, security, and
dependability is more critical. Choosing the fastest baud rate (data rate) to achieve maximum speed may appear
attractive, but this is likely to increase the cost of the telecommunications equipment. Also, telecommunication
services operating at high data rates are more prone to interference and suffer from longer re-synchronisation
times following periods of disruption. Taking into account these factors we recommend a maximum baud rate
setting of 9600 bps. As baud rates decrease, communications become more robust with fewer interruptions, but
overall signalling times increase.
At slower baud rates, the choice of signalling mode becomes significant. You should also consider what happens
during periods of noise when message structure and content can be lost.
● In ‘Blocking’ mode, the likelihood of receiving a command in a noisy environment is high. In this case, we
recommend you set IM# Fallback Mode to Default, with a reasonably long IM# FrameSyncTim setting.
Set IM# DefaultValue to ‘1’. This provides a substitute for a received blocking signal, applying a failsafe for
blocking schemes.
● In ‘Direct’ mode, the likelihood of receiving commands in a noisy environment is small. In this case, we
recommend you set IM# Fallback Mode to Default with a short IM# FrameSyncTim setting. Set IM#
DefaultValue to ‘0’. This means that if a corrupt message is received, InterMiCOM will use the default value.
This provides a substitute for the intertrip signal not being received, applying a failsafe for direct
intertripping schemes.
● In ‘Permissive’ mode, the likelihood of receiving a valid command under noisy communications conditions is
somwhere between that of the ‘Blocking’ mode and the ‘Direct’ intertrip mode. In this case, we
recommended you set IM# Fallback Mode to Latched.
The table below presents recommended IM# FrameSyncTim settings for the different signalling modes and baud
rates:
Minimum Recommended "IM# FrameSyncTim" Setting
Minimum Setting Maximum Setting
Baud Rate Direct Intertrip Mode Blocking Mode
(ms) (ms)
600 100 250 100 1500
1200 50 130 50 1500
2400 30 70 30 1500
4800 20 40 20 1500
9600 10 20 10 1500
19200 10 10 10 1500
500 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection
Note:
As we have recommended Latched operation, the table does not contain recommendations for ‘Permissive’ mode. However, if
you do select ‘Default’ mode, you should set IM# FrameSyncTim greater than those listed above. If you set IM#
FrameSyncTim lower than the minimum setting listed above, the device could interpret a valid change in a message as a
corrupted message.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 501
Chapter 20 - Electrical Teleprotection P446SV
502 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 21
COMMUNICATIONS
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
504 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This product supports Substation Automation System (SAS), and Supervisory Control and Data Acquisition (SCADA)
communication. The support embraces the evolution of communications technologies that have taken place since
microprocessor technologies were introduced into protection, control, and monitoring devices which are now
ubiquitously known as Intelligent Electronic Devices for the substation (IEDs).
As standard, all products support rugged serial communications for SCADA and SAS applications. By option, any
product can support Ethernet communications for more advanced SCADA and SAS applications.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 505
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
2 COMMUNICATION INTERFACES
The products have a number of standard and optional communication interfaces. The standard and optional
hardware and protocols are summarised below:
Port Availability Physical layer Use Data Protocols
Front Standard RS232 Local settings Courier
Rear Port 1 RS232 / RS485 / K- SCADA Courier, MODBUS, IEC60870-5-103, DNP3.0
Standard
(RP1 copper) Bus Remote settings (order option)
Rear Port 1 SCADA Courier, MODBUS, IEC60870-5-103, DNP3.0
Optional Fibre
(RP1 fibre) Remote settings (order option)
Rear Port 2 RS232 / RS485 / K- SCADA SK4: Courier only
Optional
(RP2) Bus Remote settings SK5: InterMicom only
IEC 61850 or DNP3 IEC 61850, Courier (tunnelled) or DNP3.0
Ethernet Optional Ethernet
Remote settings (order option)
Note:
Optional communications boards are always fitted into slot A.
Note:
It is only possible to fit one optional communications board, therefore RP2 and Ethernet communications are mutually
exclusive.
506 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
3 SERIAL COMMUNICATION
The physical layer standards that are used for serial communications for SCADA purposes are:
● EIA(RS)485 (often abbreviated to RS485)
● K-Bus (a proprietary customization of RS485)
EIA(RS)232 is used for local communication with the IED (for transferring settings and downloading firmware
updates).
RS485 is similar to RS232 but for longer distances and it allows daisy-chaining and multi-dropping of IEDs.
K-Bus is a proprietary protocol quite similar to RS485, but it cannot be mixed on the same link as RS485. Unlike
RS485, K-Bus signals applied across two terminals are not polarised.
It is important to note that these are not data protocols. They only describe the physical characteristics required
for two devices to communicate with each other.
For a description of the K-Bus standard see K-Bus (on page508) and General Electric's K-Bus interface guide
reference R6509.
A full description of the RS485 is available in the published standard.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 507
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
Note:
Some devices may be able to provide the bus bias, in which case external components would not be required.
6 – 9 V DC
180 Ω bias
Master 120 Ω
180 Ω bias
0V 120 Ω
V01000
Warning:
It is extremely important that the 120 Ω termination resistors are fitted. Otherwise
the bias voltage may be excessive and may damage the devices connected to the
bus.
3.3 K-BUS
K-Bus is a robust signalling method based on RS485 voltage levels. K-Bus incorporates message framing, based on
a 64 kbps synchronous HDLC protocol with FM0 modulation to increase speed and security.
The rear interface is used to provide a permanent connection for K-Bus, which allows multi-drop connection.
A K-Bus spur consists of up to 32 IEDs connected together in a multi-drop arrangement using twisted pair wiring.
The K-Bus twisted pair connection is non-polarised.
It is not possible to use a standard EIA(RS)232 to EIA(RS)485 converter to convert IEC 60870-5 FT1.2 frames to K-
Bus. A protocol converter, namely the KITZ101, KITZ102 or KITZ201, must be used for this purpose. Please consult
General Electric for information regarding the specification and supply of KITZ devices. The following figure
demonstrates a typical K-Bus connection.
508 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
RS232 K-Bus
V01001
Note:
An RS232-USB converter is only needed if the local computer does not provide an RS232 port.
Further information about K-Bus is available in the publication R6509: K-Bus Interface Guide, which is available on
request.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 509
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
510 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
PRP and HSR are open standards, so their implementation is compatible with any standard PRP or HSR device
respectively. PRP provides "bumpless" redundancy. RSTP is also an open standard, so its implementation is
compatible with any standard RSTP devices. RSTP provides redundancy, however, it is not "bumpless".
SHP and DHP are proprietary protocols intended for use with specific General Electric products:
● SHP is compatible with the C264-SWR212 as well as H35x multimode switches.
● DHP is compatible with the C264-SWD212 as well as H36x multimode switches.
Note:
The protocol you require must be selected at the time of ordering.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 511
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
DAN DAN
SAN DAN
LAN B
LAN A
REDUNDANCY
BOX
VDAN
VDAN
E01028
In a DAN, both ports share the same MAC address so it does not affect the way devices talk to each other in an
Ethernet network (Address Resolution Protocol at layer 2). Every data frame is seen by both ports.
When a DAN sends a frame of data, the frame is duplicated on both ports and therefore on both LAN segments.
This provides a redundant path for the data frame if one of the segments fails. Under normal conditions, both LAN
segments are working and each port receives identical frames.
512 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
Source
Singly Attached
Nodes
Only about half of the network bandwidth is available in HSR for multicast or broadcast frames because both
duplicate frames A & B circulate the full ring.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 513
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
Source
C frame
A frame B frame
Singly Attached
Nodes
D frame
Destination V01031
For unicast frames, the whole bandwidth is available as both frames A & B stop at the destination node.
514 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
T1000 switch
PC SCADA
DS Agile gateways
The RSTP implementation in this product is compatible with any devices that use RSTP.
RSTP can recover network faults quickly, but the fault recovery time depends on the number of devices on the
network and the network topology. A typical figure for the fault recovery time is 300ms. Therefore, RSTP cannot
achieve the “bumpless” redundancy that some other protocols can.
Refer to IEEE 802.1D 2004 standard for detailed information about the opration of the protocol.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 515
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
MiCOM MiCOM
H35 H35
Px4x Px4x
E01011
Figure 273: IED, bay computer and Ethernet switch with self healing ring facilities
Primary Fibre
1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
A B C D E
Tx (Es) Rx (Rs)
Hx5x IED C264 IED Hx5x
Secondary Fibre
V01013
Figure 274: Redundant Ethernet ring architecture with IED, bay computer and Ethernet switches
516 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
Primary Fibre
1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
A B C D E
Tx (Es) Rx (Rs)
Hx5x IED C264 IED Hx5x
Secondary Fibre
V01014
Figure 275: Redundant Ethernet ring architecture with IED, bay computer and Ethernet switches after failure
P446SV-TM-EN-1 517
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
Network 1 Network 2
The H36x is a repeater with a standard 802.3 Ethernet switch, plus the DHM.
518 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
MiCOM H382
SCADA or PACiS OI
DS Agile gateways
Ethernet
Up to
6 links C264 *
RS485
TX copper link
FX optical fibre Ethernet
E01017 RS485, RS422
* For PRP this is SRP, for DHP this is SWD
** For PRP this is PRP REB, for DHP this is DHP REB
Note:
IP1 and IP2 are different but use the same subnet mask.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 519
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
PRP/HSR
If using PRP or HSR, you configure the REB IP address using the PRP/HSR Configurator software.
RSTP
If using RSTP, you configure the REB IP address using the PRP/HSR Configurator software.
SHP or DHP
If using SHP or DHP the first two octets are set by the Switch Manager software or an SNMP MIB browser. The third
octet is fixed at 254 (FE hex, 11111110 binary), and the fourth octet is set by the on-board dip switch.
Note:
An H35 (SHP) or H36 (DHP) network device is needed in the network to configure the REB IP address if you are using SNMP.
Warning:
Configure the hardware settings before the device is installed.
520 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
3. Before removing the front cover, take precautions to prevent electrostatic discharge damage according to
the ANSI/ESD-20.20 -2007 standard.
4. Wear a 1 MΩ earth strap and connect it to the earth (ground) point on the back of the IED.
E01019
5. Lift the upper and lower flaps. Remove the six screws securing the front panel and pull the front panel
outwards.
E01020
P446SV-TM-EN-1 521
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
6. Press the levers either side of the connector to disconnect the ribbon cable from the front panel.
E01021
7. Remove the redundant Ethernet board. Set the last octet of IP address using the DIP switches. The available
range is 1 to 127.
1 Example address 1 + 4 + 16 + 64 = 85
2 decimal 85
4
8
16
32
64
Unused
ON
V01022 SW2 Top view
8. Once you have set the IP address, reassemble the IED, following theses instructions in the reverse order.
Warning:
Take care not to damage the pins of the ribbon cable connector on the front panel when reinserting
the ribbon cable.
522 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
between PRP and HSR or configure their parameters, configure the redundancy IP address, or configure the SNTP
IP address.
RJ45
Ethernet switch
Media
Converter
TXA RXA TXB RXB
TX RX
IED IED
(a) (b)
V01806
Figure 279: Connection using (a) an Ethernet switch and (b) a media converter
P446SV-TM-EN-1 523
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
Select the device you wish to configure. The MAC address of the selected device is highlighted.
524 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
General tab
The Filtering Database contains two types of entry; static and dynamic. The Static Entries are the source addresses
entered by an administrator. The Dynamic Entries are the source addresses learnt by the switch process. The
Dynamic Entries are removed from the Filtering Database after the Ageing Time. The Database holds a maximum
of 1024 entries.
1. To access the forwarding database functions, if required, click the Filtering Database button in the main
window.
2. To view the Forwarding Database Size, Number of Static Entries and Number of Dynamic Entries, click Read
Database Info.
3. To set the Aging Time, enter the number of seconds in the text box and click the Set button.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 525
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
PRP/HSR functionality. To add an entry in the forwarding database, click the Filtering Entries tab. Configure as
follows:
1. Select the Port Number and MAC Address
2. Set the Entry type (Dynamic or Static)
3. Set the cast type (Unicast or Multicast)
4. Set theMGMT and Rate Limit
5. Click the Create button. The new entry appears in the forwarding database.
To delete an entry from the forwarding database, select the entry and click the Delete Entry button.
526 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
RJ45
Ethernet switch
Media
Converter
TX1 RX1 TX2 RX2
TX RX
IED IED
(a) (b)
V01803
Figure 280: Connection using (a) an Ethernet switch and (b) a media converter
P446SV-TM-EN-1 527
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
Note:
Due to the time needed to establish the RSTP protocol, wait 25 seconds between connecting the PC to the IED and clicking the
Identify Device button.
The redundant Ethernet board connected to the PC is identified and its details are listed.
● Device address
● MAC address
● Version number of the firmware
● SNTP IP address
● Date & time of the real-time clock, from the board.
Maximum value
S.No Parameter Default value (second) Minimum value (second)
(second)
1 Bridge Max Age 20 6 40
2 Bridge Hello Time 2 1 10
528 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
Maximum value
S.No Parameter Default value (second) Minimum value (second)
(second)
3 Bridge Forward Delay 15 4 30
4 Bridge Priority 32768 0 61440
Note:
When assigning the bridge priority, make sure the root of the network is the Ethernet switch, not the IEDs. This reduces the
number of hops to reach all devices in the network. Also make sure the priority values for all IEDs are higher than that of the
switch.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 529
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
Switch hardware
Alstom switches are stand-alone devices (H3xx, H6x families) or embedded in a computer device rack, for example
MiCOM C264 (SWDxxx, SWRxxx, SWUxxx Ethernet boards) or PC board (MiCOM H14x, MiCOM H15x, MiCOM H16x).
Switch range
There are 3 types of Alstom switches:
● Standard switches: SWU (in C264), H14x (PCI), H34x, H6x
● Redundant Ring switches: SWR (in C264), H15x (PCI), H35x,
● Redundant Dual Homing switches: SWD (in C264), H16x (PCI), H36x
Switch Manager allows you to allocate an IP addresses for Alstom switches. Switches can then be synchronized
using the Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) or they can be administrated using the Simple Network
Management Protocol (SNMP).
All switches have a single 6-byte MAC address.
Redundancy Management
Standard Ethernet does not support a loop at the OSI link layer (layer 2 of the 7 layer model). A mesh topology
cannot be created using a standard Hub and switch. Redundancy needs separate networks using hardware in
routers or software in dedicated switches using STP (Spanning Tree Protocol). However, this redundancy
mechanism is too slow for one link failure in electrical automation networks.
Alstom has developed its own Redundancy ring and star mechanisms using two specific Ethernet ports of the
redundant switches. This redundancy works between Alstom switches of the same type. The two redundant
Ethernet connections between Alstom switches create one private redundant Ethernet LAN.
The Ethernet ports dedicated to the redundancy are optical Ethernet ports. The Alstom redundancy mechanism
uses a single specific address for each Ethernet switch of the private LAN. This address is set using DIP switches or
jumpers.
Switch Manager monitors the redundant address of the switches and the link topology between switches.
5.10.1 INSTALLATION
Network IP address
IP addressing is needed for time synchronization of Alstom switches and for SNMP management.
Switch Manager is used to define IP addresses of Alstom switches. These addresses must be in the range of the
system IP, depending on the IP mask of the engineering PC for substation maintenance.
Alstom switches have a default multicast so the 3rd word of the IP address is always 254.
Installation procedure
Run Setup.exe and follow the on-screen instructions.
530 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
5.10.2 SETUP
1. Make sure the PC has one Ethernet port connected to the Alstom switch.
2. Configure the PC's Ethernet port on the same subnet as the Alstom switch.
3. Select User or Admin mode. In User mode enter the user name as User, leave the password blank and click
OK. In Admin mode you can not upload the firmware on the Ethernet repeaters.
4. In Admin mode enter the user name as Admin, enter the password and click OK. All functions are available
including Expert Maintenance facilities.
5. Click the Language button in the bottom right of the screen and select your language.
6. If several Ethernet interfaces are used, in the Network board drop-down box, select the PC Network board
connected to the Alstom switch. The IP and MAC addresses are displayed below the drop-down box.
7. Periodically click the Ring Topology button (top left) to display or refresh the list of Alstom switches that are
connected.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 531
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
5.10.9 VLAN
The Virtual Local Area Network (VLAN) is a technique used to split an interconnected physical network into several
networks. This technique can be used at all ISO/OSI levels. The VLAN switch is mainly at OSI level 1 (physical VLAN)
which allows communication only between some Ethernet physical ports.
Ports on the switch can be grouped into Physical VLANs to limit traffic flooding. This is because it is limited to ports
belonging to that VLAN and not to other ports.
Port-based VLANs are VLANs where the packet forwarding decision is based on the destination MAC address and
its associated port. You must define outgoing ports allowed for each port when using port-based VLANs. The VLAN
only governs the outgoing traffic so is unidirectional. Therefore, if you wish to allow two subscriber ports to talk to
each other, you must define the egress port for both ports. An egress port is an outgoing port, through which a
data packet leaves.
To assign a physical VLAN to a set of ports:
1. Select the address of the device in the main window.
2. Click the VLAN button, a new screen appears.
3. Use the checkboxes to select which ports will be in the same VLAN. By default all the ports share the same
VLAN.
532 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
P446SV-TM-EN-1 533
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
534 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
Address Name
2 mgmt
1 Mib-2
1 sys
1 sysDescr
3 sysUpTime
4 sysName
Remote Monitoring
16 RMON
1 statistics
1 etherstat
1 etherStatsEntry
9 etherStatsUndersizePkts
10 etherStatsOversizePkts
12 etherStatsJabbers
13 etherStatsCollisions
14 etherStatsPkts64Octets
15 etherStatsPkts65to127Octets
16 etherStatsPkts128to255Octets
17 etherStatsPkts256to511Octets
18 etherStatsPkts512to1023Octets
P446SV-TM-EN-1 535
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
Address Name
7 lreMacAddressB
8 lreAdapterAdminStateA
9 lreAdapterAdminStateB
10 lreLinkStatusA
11 lreLinkStatusB
12 lreDuplicateDiscard
13 lreTransparentReception
14 lreHsrLREMode
15 lreSwitchingEndNode
16 lreRedBoxIdentity
17 lreSanA
18 lreSanB
19 lreEvaluateSupervision
20 lreNodesTableClear
21 lreProxyNodeTableClear
1 lreStatistics
1 lreStatisticsInterfaceGroup
0 lreStatisticsInterfaces
1 lreInterfaceStatsTable
1 lreInterfaceStatsIndex
2 lreCntTotalSentA
3 lreCntTotalSentB
4 lreCntErrWrongLANA
5 lreCntErrWrongLANB
6 lreCntReceivedA
7 lreCntReceivedB
8 lreCntErrorsA
9 lreCntErrorsB
10 lreCntNodes
11 IreOwnRxCntA
12 IreOwnRxCntB
3 lreProxyNodeTable
1 lreProxyNodeEntry
1 reProxyNodeIndex
2 reProxyNodeMacAddress
3 Org
6 Dod
1 Internet
2 mgmt
1 mib-2
1 System
1 sysDescr
3 sysUpTime
536 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
Address Name
5 sysName
7 sysServices
2 interfaces
2 ifTable
1 ifEntry
1 ifIndex
2 ifDescr
3 ifType
4 ifMtu
5 ifSpeed
6 ifPhysAddress
7 ifAdminStatus
8 ifOpenStatus
9 ifLastChange
10 ifInOctets
11 ifInUcastPkts
12 ifInNUcastPkts
13 ifInDiscards
14 ifInErrors
15 ifInUnknownProtos
16 ifOutOctets
17 ifOutUcastPkts
18 ifOutNUcastPkts
19 ifOutDiscards
20 ifOutErrors
21 ifOutQLen
22 ifSpecific
16 rmon
1 statistics
1 etherStatsTable
1 etherStatsEntry
1 etherStatsIndex
2 etherStatsDataSource
3 etherStatsDropEvents
4 etherStatsOctets
5 etherStatsPkts
6 etherStatsBroadcastPkts
7 etherStatsMulticastPkts
8 etherStatsCRCAlignErrors
9 etherStatsUndersizePkts
10 etherStatsOversizePkts
11 etherStatsFragments
12 etherStatsJabbers
P446SV-TM-EN-1 537
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
Address Name
13 etherStatsCollisions
14 etherStatsPkts64Octets
15 etherStatsPkts65to127Octets
16 etherStatsPkts128to255Octets
17 etherStatsPkts256to511Octets
18 etherStatsPkts512to1023Octets
19 etherStatsPkts1024to1518Octets
20 etherStatsOwner
21 etherStatsStatus
Note:
There are two IP addresses visible when communicating with the Redundant Ethernet Card via the fibre optic ports: Use the
one for the IED itself to the Main Processor SNMP interface, and use the one for the on-board Ethernet switch to access the
Redundant Ethernet Board SNMP interface. See the configuration chapter for more information.
538 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
Authentication is used to check the identity of users, privacy allows for encryption of SNMP messages. Both are
optional, however you must enable authentication in order to enable privacy. To configure these security options:
1. If SNMPv3 has been enabled, set the Security Level setting. There are three levels; without authentication
and without privacy (noAuthNoPriv), with authentication but without privacy (authNoPriv), and with
authentication and with privacy (authPriv).
2. If Authentication is enabled, use the Auth Protocol setting to select the authentication type. There are two
options: HMAC-MD5-96 or HMAC-SHA-96.
3. Using the Auth Password setting, enter the 8-character password to be used by the IED for authentication.
4. If privacy is enabled, use the Encrypt Protocol setting to set the 8-character password that will be used by
the IED for encryption.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 539
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
7 DATA PROTOCOLS
The products supports a wide range of protocols to make them applicable to many industries and applications.
The exact data protocols supported by a particular product depend on its chosen application, but the following
table gives a list of the data protocols that are typically available.
The relationship of these protocols to the lower level physical layer protocols are as follows:
IEC 60870-5-103
MODBUS IEC 61850
Data Protocols
DNP3.0 DNP3.0
Courier Courier Courier Courier
Data Link Layer EIA(RS)485 Ethernet EIA(RS)232 K-Bus
Physical Layer Copper or Optical Fibre
7.1 COURIER
This section should provide sufficient detail to enable understanding of the Courier protocol at a level required by
most users. For situations where the level of information contained in this manual is insufficient, further
publications (R6511 and R6512) containing in-depth details about the protocol and its use, are available on
request.
Courier is an General Electric proprietary communication protocol. Courier uses a standard set of commands to
access a database of settings and data in the IED. This allows a master to communicate with a number of slave
devices. The application-specific elements are contained in the database rather than in the commands used to
interrogate it, meaning that the master station does not need to be preconfigured. Courier also provides a
sequence of event (SOE) and disturbance record extraction mechanism.
For either of the rear ports, both the IED address and baud rate can be selected using the front panel menu or by
the settings application software.
540 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
With the exception of the Disturbance Recorder settings, changes made to the control and support settings are
implemented immediately and stored in non-volatile memory. Changes made to the Protection settings and the
Disturbance Recorder settings are stored in ‘scratchpad’ memory and are not immediately implemented. These
need to be committed by writing to the Save Changes cell in the CONFIGURATION column.
Method 1
This uses a combination of three commands to perform a settings change:
First, enter Setting mode: This checks that the cell is settable and returns the limits.
1. Preload Setting: This places a new value into the cell. This value is echoed to ensure that setting corruption
has not taken place. The validity of the setting is not checked by this action.
2. Execute Setting: This confirms the setting change. If the change is valid, a positive response is returned. If
the setting change fails, an error response is returned.
3. Abort Setting: This command can be used to abandon the setting change.
This is the most secure method. It is ideally suited to on-line editors because the setting limits are extracted before
the setting change is made. However, this method can be slow if many settings are being changed because three
commands are required for each change.
Method 2
The Set Value command can be used to change a setting directly. The response to this command is either a
positive confirm or an error code to indicate the nature of a failure. This command can be used to implement a
setting more rapidly than the previous method, however the limits are not extracted. This method is therefore most
suitable for off-line setting editors such as MiCOM S1 Agile, or for issuing preconfigured control commands.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 541
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
Event Types
The IED generates events under certain circumstances such as:
● Change of state of output contact
● Change of state of opto-input
● Protection element operation
● Alarm condition
● Setting change
● Password entered/timed-out
542 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
The Menu Database contains tables of possible events, and shows how the contents of the above fields are
interpreted. Fault and Maintenance records return a Courier Type 3 event, which contains the above fields plus two
additional fields:
● Event extraction column
● Event number
These events contain additional information, which is extracted from the IED using column B4. Row 01 contains a
Select Record setting that allows the fault or maintenance record to be selected. This setting should be set to the
event number value returned in the record. The extended data can be extracted from the IED by uploading the text
and data from the column.
The PSL settings can be uploaded and downloaded to and from the IED using this mechanism. The settings
application software must be used to edit the settings. It also performs checks on the validity of the settings before
they are transferred to the IED.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 543
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Protocol
Courier
4. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Address). This cell controls the address of the RP1 port on thje device. Up to
32 IEDs can be connected to one spur. It is therefore necessary for each IED to have a unique address so
that messages from the master control station are accepted by one IED only. Courier uses an integer
number between 1 and 254 for the Relay Address. It is set to 255 by default, which has to be changed. It is
important that no two IEDs share the same address.
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Address
100
5. Move down to the next cell (RP1 InactivTimer). This cell controls the inactivity timer. The inactivity timer
controls how long the IED waits without receiving any messages on the rear port before revoking any
password access that was enabled and discarding any changes. For the rear port this can be set between 1
and 30 minutes.
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Inactivtimer
10.00 mins.
6. If the optional fibre optic connectors are fitted, the RP1 PhysicalLink cell is visible. This cell controls the
physical media used for the communication (Copper or Fibre optic).
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 PhysicalLink
Copper
7. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Card Status). This cell is not settable. It displays the status of the chosen
physical layer protocol for RP1.
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Card Status
K-Bus OK
544 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
8. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Port Config). This cell controls the type of serial connection. Select between
K-Bus or RS485.
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Port Config
K-Bus
9. If using EIA(RS)485, the next cell (RP1 Comms Mode) selects the communication mode. The choice is either
IEC 60870 FT1.2 for normal operation with 11-bit modems, or 10-bit no parity. If using K-Bus this cell will not
appear.
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Comms Mode
IEC 60870 FT1.2
10. If using EIA(RS)485, the next cell down controls the baud rate. Three baud rates are supported; 9600, 19200
and 38400. If using K-Bus this cell will not appear as the baud rate is fixed at 64 kbps.
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Baud rate
19200
If the optional fibre optic port is fitted, a menu item appears in which the active port can be selected. However the
selection is only effective following the next power up.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 545
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
The IED address and baud rate can be selected using the front panel menu or by the settings application software.
7.2.2 INITIALISATION
Whenever the device has been powered up, or if the communication parameters have been changed a reset
command is required to initialize the communications. The device will respond to either of the two reset
commands; Reset CU or Reset FCB (Communication Unit or Frame Count Bit). The difference between the two
commands is that the Reset CU command will clear any unsent messages in the transmit buffer, whereas the
Reset FCB command does not delete any messages.
The device will respond to the reset command with an identification message ASDU 5. The Cause of Transmission
(COT) of this response will be either Reset CU or Reset FCB depending on the nature of the reset command. The
content of ASDU 5 is described in the IEC 60870-5-103 section of the Menu Database, available from General
Electric separately if required.
In addition to the above identification message, it will also produce a power up event.
The IEC 60870-5-103 profile in the Menu Database contains a complete listing of all events produced by the
device.
7.2.7 COMMANDS
A list of the supported commands is contained in the Menu Database. The device will respond to other commands
with an ASDU 1, with a cause of transmission (COT) indicating ‘negative acknowledgement’.
546 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
Note:
IEC 60870-5-103 only supports up to 8 records.
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Protocol
IEC 60870-5-103
4. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Address). This cell controls the IEC 60870-5-103 address of the IED. Up to 32
IEDs can be connected to one spur. It is therefore necessary for each IED to have a unique address so that
messages from the master control station are accepted by one IED only. IEC 60870-5-103 uses an integer
number between 0 and 254 for the address. It is important that no two IEDs have the same IEC 60870 5 103
address. The IEC 60870-5-103 address is then used by the master station to communicate with the IED.
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 address
162
5. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Baud Rate). This cell controls the baud rate to be used. Two baud rates are
supported by the IED, 9600 bits/s and 19200 bits/s. Make sure that the baud rate selected on the
IED is the same as that set on the master station.
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Baud rate
9600 bits/s
P446SV-TM-EN-1 547
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
6. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Meas Period). The next cell down controls the period between
IEC 60870-5-103 measurements. The IEC 60870-5-103 protocol allows the IED to supply measurements at
regular intervals. The interval between measurements is controlled by this cell, and can be set between 1
and 60 seconds.
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Meas Period
30.00 s
7. If the optional fibre optic connectors are fitted, the RP1 PhysicalLink cell is visible. This cell controls the
physical media used for the communication (Copper or Fibre optic).
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 PhysicalLink
Copper
8. The next cell down (RP1 CS103Blcking) can be used for monitor or command blocking.
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 CS103Blcking
Disabled
9. There are three settings associated with this cell; these are:
Setting: Description:
Disabled No blocking selected.
When the monitor blocking DDB Signal is active high, either by energising an opto input or control input,
Monitor Blocking reading of the status information and disturbance records is not permitted. When in this mode the device
returns a "Termination of general interrogation" message to the master station.
When the command blocking DDB signal is active high, either by energising an opto input or control input,
Command Blocking all remote commands will be ignored (i.e. CB Trip/Close, change setting group etc.). When in this mode the
device returns a "negative acknowledgement of command" message to the master station.
548 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
The IED address and baud rate can be selected using the front panel menu or by the settings application software.
When using a serial interface, the data format is: 1 start bit, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit and optional configurable parity
bit.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 549
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
Control Input
(Latched)
Aliased Control
Input
(Latched)
Control Input
(Pulsed )
Aliased Control
Input
(Pulsed )
The pulse width is equal to the duration of one protection iteration
V01002
Many of the IED’s functions are configurable so some of the Object 10 commands described in the following
sections may not be available. A read from Object 10 reports the point as off-line and an operate command to
Object 12 generates an error response.
Examples of Object 10 points that maybe reported as off-line are:
● Activate setting groups: Ensure setting groups are enabled
● CB trip/close: Ensure remote CB control is enabled
● Reset NPS thermal: Ensure NPS thermal protection is enabled
● Reset thermal O/L: Ensure thermal overload protection is enabled
● Reset RTD flags: Ensure RTD Inputs is enabled
● Control inputs: Ensure control inputs are enabled
550 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
Analogue values can be reported to the master station as primary, secondary or normalized values (which takes
into account the IED’s CT and VT ratios), and this is settable in the COMMUNICATIONS column in the IED.
Corresponding deadband settings can be displayed in terms of a primary, secondary or normalized value.
Deadband point values can be reported and written using Object 34 variations.
The deadband is the setting used to determine whether a change event should be generated for each point. The
change events can be read using Object 32 or Object 60. These events are generated for any point which has a
value changed by more than the deadband setting since the last time the data value was reported.
Any analogue measurement that is unavailable when it is read is reported as offline. For example, the frequency
would be offline if the current and voltage frequency is outside the tracking range of the IED. All Object 30 points
are reported as secondary values in DNP 3.0 (with respect to CT and VT ratios).
DNP 3.0
Device Profile Document
Vendor Name: ALSTOM GRID
Device Name: MiCOM P40Agile Protection Relays – compact and modular range
P446SV-TM-EN-1 551
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
DNP 3.0
Device Profile Document
Models Covered: All models
Highest DNP Level Supported*: For Requests: Level 2
*This is the highest DNP level FULLY supported. Parts of level 3 are For Responses: Level 2
also supported
Device Function: Slave
Notable objects, functions, and/or qualifiers supported in addition to the highest DNP levels supported (the complete list is described in the
DNP 3.0 Implementation Table):
For static (non-change event) object requests, request qualifier codes 00 and 01 (start-stop), 07 and 08 (limited quantity), and 17 and 28 (index)
are supported in addition to the request qualifier code 06 (no range (all points))
Static object requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08 will be responded with qualifiers 00 or 01
Static object requests sent with qualifiers 17 or 28 will be responded with qualifiers 17 or 28
For change-event object requests, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded
16-bit and 32-bit analogue change events with time may be requested
The read function code for Object 50 (time and date) variation 1 is supported
Analogue Input Deadbands, Object 34, variations 1 through 3, are supported
Floating Point Analogue Output Status and Output Block Objects 40 and 41 are supported
Sequential file transfer, Object 70, variations 2 through 7, are supported
Device Attribute Object 0 is supported
Maximum Data Link Frame Size (octets): Transmitted: 292
Received: 292
Maximum Application Fragment Size (octets) Transmitted: Configurable (100 to 2048). Default 2048
Received: 249
Maximum Data Link Retries: Fixed at 2
Maximum Application Layer Retries: None
Requires Data Link Layer Confirmation: Configurable to Never or Always
Requires Application Layer Confirmation: When reporting event data (Slave devices only)
When sending multi-fragment responses (Slave devices only)
Timeouts while waiting for:
Data Link Confirm: Configurable
Complete Application Fragment: None
Application Confirm: Configurable
Complete Application Response: None
Others:
Data Link Confirm Timeout: Configurable from 0 (Disabled) to 120s, default 10s.
Application Confirm Timeout: Configurable from 1 to 120s, default 2s.
Select/Operate Arm Timeout: Configurable from 1 to 10s, default 10s.
Need Time Interval (Set IIN1-4): Configurable from 1 to 30, default 10min.
Application File Timeout 60 s
Analog Change Event Scan Period: Fixed at 0.5s
Counter Change Event Scan Period Fixed at 0.5s
Frozen Counter Change Event Scan Period Fixed at 1s
Maximum Delay Measurement Error: 2.5 ms
Time Base Drift Over a 10-minute Interval: 7 ms
Sends/Executes Control Operations:
Write Binary Outputs: Never
Select/Operate: Always
552 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
DNP 3.0
Device Profile Document
Direct Operate: Always
Direct Operate - No Ack: Always
Count > 1 Never
Pulse On Always
Pulse Off Sometimes
Latch On Always
Latch Off Always
Queue Never
Clear Queue Never
Note: Paired Control points will accept Pulse On/Trip and Pulse On/Close, but only single point will accept the Pulse Off control command.
Reports Binary Input Change Events when no specific variation Configurable to send one or the other
requested:
Reports time-tagged Binary Input Change Events when no specific Binary input change with time
variation requested:
Sends Unsolicited Responses: Never
Sends Static Data in Unsolicited Responses: Never
No other options are permitted
Default Counter Object/Variation: Configurable, Point-by-point list attached
Default object: 20
Default variation: 1
Counters Roll Over at: 32 bits
Sends multi-fragment responses: Yes
Sequential File Transfer Support:
Append File Mode No
Custom Status Code Strings No
Permissions Field Yes
File Events Assigned to Class No
File Events Send Immediately Yes
Multiple Blocks in a Fragment No
Max Number of Files Open 1
P446SV-TM-EN-1 553
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
Request Response
Object
(Library will parse) (Library will respond with)
Object Variation Function Codes (dec) Qualifier Codes Function Codes Qualifier Codes (hex)
Description (dec)
Number Number (hex)
2 0 Binary Input Change - Any 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
Variation 07, 08 (limited qty)
2 1 Binary Input Change without Time 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited qty)
2 2 Binary Input Change with Time 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited qty)
10 0 Binary Output Status - Any 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
Variation 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
10 2 Binary Output Status 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default - see 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
note 1) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 28 (index)
12 1 Control Relay Output Block 3 (select) 17, 28 (index) 129 response echo of request
4 (operate)
5 (direct op)
6 (dir. op, noack)
20 0 Binary Counter - Any Variation 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
22 (assign class) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
7 (freeze) 00, 01 (start-stop)
8 (freeze noack) 06 (no range, or all)
9 (freeze clear) 07, 08 (limited qty)
10 (frz. cl. Noack)
20 1 32-Bit Binary Counter with Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
20 2 16-Bit Binary Counter with Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
20 5 32-Bit Binary Counter without Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default - see 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
note 1) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
20 6 16-Bit Binary Counter without Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
21 0 Frozen Counter - Any Variation 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
21 1 32-Bit Frozen Counter with Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
21 2 16-Bit Frozen Counter with Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
21 5 32-Bit Frozen Counter with Time of 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
Freeze 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 1)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
21 6 16-Bit Frozen Counter with Time of 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
Freeze 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 17, 28 (index - see note 1)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
21 9 32-Bit Frozen Counter without Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default - see 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
note 1) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
554 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
Request Response
Object
(Library will parse) (Library will respond with)
Object Variation Function Codes (dec) Qualifier Codes Function Codes Qualifier Codes (hex)
Description (dec)
Number Number (hex)
21 10 16-Bit Frozen Counter without Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
`22 0 Counter Change Event - Any 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
Variation 07, 08 (limited qty)
22 1 32-Bit Counter Change Event 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
(default - see without Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
note 1)
22 2 16-Bit Counter Change Event 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
without Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
22 5 32-Bit Counter Change Event with 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
22 6 16-Bit Counter Change Event with 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
23 0 Frozen Counter Event (Variation 0 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
is used to request default 07, 08 (limited qty)
variation)
23 1 32-Bit Frozen Counter Event 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
(default - see 07, 08 (limited qty)
note 1)
23 2 16-Bit Frozen Counter Event 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited qty)
23 5 32-Bit Frozen Counter Event with 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
23 6 16-Bit Frozen Counter Event with 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
30 0 Analog Input - Any Variation 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
22 (assign class) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
30 1 32-Bit Analog Input 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
30 2 16-Bit Analog Input 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
30 3 32-Bit Analog Input without Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default - see 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
note 1) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
30 4 16-Bit Analog Input without Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
30 5 Short floating point 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
32 0 Analog Change Event - Any 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
Variation 07, 08 (limited qty)
32 1 32-Bit Analog Change Event 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
(default - see without Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
note 1)
32 2 16-Bit Analog Change Event 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
without Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
32 3 32-Bit Analog Change Event with 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
32 4 16-Bit Analog Change Event with 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
32 5 Short floating point Analog 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
Change Event without Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
32 7 Short floating point Analog 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 response 17, 28 (index)
Change Event with Time 07, 08 (limited qty)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 555
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
Request Response
Object
(Library will parse) (Library will respond with)
Object Variation Function Codes (dec) Qualifier Codes Function Codes Qualifier Codes (hex)
Description (dec)
Number Number (hex)
34 0 Analog Input Deadband (Variation 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
0 is used to request default 06 (no range, or all)
variation) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
34 1 16 Bit Analog Input Deadband 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
2 (write) 00, 01 (start-stop)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
34 2 32 Bit Analog Input Deadband 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default - see 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
note 1) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
2 (write) 00, 01 (start-stop)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
34 3 Short Floating Point Analog Input 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
Deadband 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
2 (write) 00, 01 (start-stop)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
40 0 Analog Output Status (Variation 0 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
is used to request default 06 (no range, or all)
variation) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
40 1 32-Bit Analog Output Status 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default - see 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
note 1) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
40 2 16-Bit Analog Output Status 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
40 3 Short Floating Point Analog 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 response 00, 01 (start-stop)
Output Status 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index - see note 2)
07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 27, 28 (index)
41 1 32-Bit Analog Output Block 3 (select) 17, 28 (index) 129 response echo of request
4 (operate) 27 (index)
5 (direct op)
6 (dir. op, noack)
41 2 16-Bit Analog Output Block 3 (select) 17, 28 (index) 129 response echo of request
4 (operate) 27 (index)
5 (direct op)
6 (dir. op, noack)
41 3 Short Floating Point Analog 3 (select) 17, 27, 28 (index) 129 response echo of request
Output Block 4 (operate)
5 (direct op)
6 (dir. op, noack)
1 1 (read) 07 (limited qty = 1) 129 response 07 (limited qty = 1)
50 (default - see Time and Date
note 1)
2 (write) 07 (limited qty = 1)
60 0 Not defined
60 1 Class 0 Data 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
60 2 Class 1 Data 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
22 (assign class) 06 (no range, or all)
60 3 Class 2 Data 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
22 (assign class) 06 (no range, or all)
60 4 Class 3 Data 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
556 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
Request Response
Object
(Library will parse) (Library will respond with)
Object Variation Function Codes (dec) Qualifier Codes Function Codes Qualifier Codes (hex)
Description (dec)
Number Number (hex)
22 (assign class) 06 (no range, or all)
70 0 File Event - Any Variation 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
22 (assign class) 06 (no range, or all)
70 2 File Authentication 29 (authenticate) 5b (free-format) 129 response 5B (free-format)
70 3 File Command 25 (open) 5b (free-format)
27 (delete)
70 4 File Command Status 26 (close) 5b (free-format) 129 response 5B (free-format)
30 (abort)
70 5 File Transfer 1 (read) 5b (free-format) 129 response 5B (free-format)
70 6 File Transfer Status 129 response 5B (free-format)
70 7 File Descriptor 28 (get file info) 5b (free-format) 129 response 5B (free-format)
Note:
A Default variation refers to the variation responded to when variation 0 is requested and/or in class 0, 1, 2, or 3 scans.
Note:
For static (non-change-event) objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are only responded to when a request is sent with qualifiers 17 or
28, respectively. Otherwise, static object requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, will be responded to with qualifiers
00 or 01. For change-event objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded to.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 557
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
558 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
Note:
Code numbers 10 through to 126 are reserved for future use.
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Protocol
DNP3.0
4. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Address). This cell controls the DNP3.0 address of the IED. Up to 32 IEDs can
be connected to one spur, therefore it is necessary for each IED to have a unique address so that messages
from the master control station are accepted by only one IED. DNP3.0 uses a decimal number between 1
and 65519 for the Relay Address. It is important that no two IEDs have the same address.
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Address
1
5. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Baud Rate). This cell controls the baud rate to be used. Six baud rates are
supported by the IED 1200 bps, 2400 bps, 4800 bps, 9600 bps, 19200 bps and 38400 bps. Make sure that
the baud rate selected on the IED is the same as that set on the master station.
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Baud rate
9600 bits/s
P446SV-TM-EN-1 559
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
6. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Parity). This cell controls the parity format used in the data frames. The
parity can be set to be one of None, Odd or Even. Make sure that the parity format selected on the IED is
the same as that set on the master station.
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Parity
None
7. If the optional fibre optic connectors are fitted, the RP1 PhysicalLink cell is visible. This cell controls the
physical media used for the communication (Copper or Fibre optic).
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 PhysicalLink
Copper
8. Move down to the next cell (RP1 Time Sync). This cell affects the time synchronisation request from the
master by the IED. It can be set to enabled or disabled. If enabled it allows the DNP3.0 master to
synchronise the time on the IED.
COMMUNICATIONS
RP1 Time Sync
Enabled
560 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
The standard adheres to the requirements laid out by the ISO OSI model and therefore provides complete vendor
interoperability and flexibility on the transmission types and protocols used. This includes mapping of data onto
Ethernet, which is becoming more and more widely used in substations, in favour of RS485. Using Ethernet in the
substation offers many advantages, most significantly including:
● Ethernet allows high-speed data rates (currently 100 Mbps, rather than tens of kbps or less used by most
serial protocols)
● Ethernet provides the possibility to have multiple clients
● Ethernet is an open standard in every-day use
● There is a wide range of Ethernet-compatible products that may be used to supplement the LAN installation
(hubs, bridges, switches)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 561
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
Data Attributes
stVal q t PhA PhB PhC
Data Objects
Pos A
Logical Nodes : 1 to n
LN1: XCBR LN2: MMXU
V01008
562 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
The IEC 61850 compatible interface standard provides capability for the following:
● Read access to measurements
● Refresh of all measurements at the rate of once per second.
● Generation of non-buffered reports on change of status or measurement
● SNTP time synchronization over an Ethernet link. (This is used to synchronize the IED's internal real time
clock.
● GOOSE peer-to-peer communication
● Disturbance record extraction by file transfer. The record is extracted as an ASCII format COMTRADE file
Note:
Setting changes are not supported in the current IEC 61850 implementation. Currently these setting changes are carried out
using the settings application software.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 563
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
● INT8
● UINT16
● UINT32
● UINT8
Note:
Some configuration data is available in the IEC61850 CONFIG. column, allowing read-only access to basic configuration data.
564 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
Any new configuration sent to the IED is automatically stored in the inactive configuration bank, therefore not
immediately affecting the current configuration.
Following an upgrade, the IEC 61850 Configurator tool can be used to transmit a command, which authorises
activation of the new configuration contained in the inactive configuration bank. This is done by switching the
active and inactive configuration banks. The capability of switching the configuration banks is also available using
the IEC61850 CONFIG. column of the HMI.
The SCL Name and Revision attributes of both configuration banks are available in the IEC61850 CONFIG. column
of the HMI.
Edition 2 implementation requires use of version 3.2 of the IEC 61850 configurator, which is installed with version
1.2 of MiCOM S1 Agile.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 565
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
V01056
An Edition 2 IED cannot normally operate within an Edition 1 IEC 61850 system. An Edition 2 IED can work for
GOOSE messaging in a mixed system, providing the client is compatible with Edition 2.
V01057
566 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
Of these, only ENS and ENC types are available from a MiCOM P40 IED when publishing GOOSE messages, so Data
Objects using these Common Data Classes should not be published in mixed Edition 1 and Edition 2 systems.
For compatibility between Edition 1 and Edition 2 IEDs, SCL files using SCL schema version 2.1 must be used. For a
purely Edition 2 system, use the schema version 3.1.
V01059
See the example below. If a failure occurs in the Bay 1 protection IED (MP2), we could disable this device and
activate a standby protection IED to replace its functionality.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 567
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
V01060
568 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
Note:
For IEC 60870-5-103, Read Only Mode function is different from the existing Command block feature.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 569
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
Using the PSL, these signals can be activated by opto-inputs, Control Inputs and function keys if required.
570 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
9 TIME SYNCHRONISATION
In modern protection schemes it is necessary to synchronise the IED's real time clock so that events from different
devices can be time stamped and placed in chronological order. This is achieved in various ways depending on the
chosen options and communication protocols.
● Using the IRIG-B input (if fitted)
● Using the SNTP time protocol (for Ethernet IEC 61850 versions + DNP3 OE)
● By using the time synchronisation functionality inherent in the data protocols
IRIG-B
V01040
The IRIG-B time code signal is a sequence of one second time frames. Each frame is split up into ten 100 mS slots
as follows:
● Time-slot 1: Seconds
● Time-slot 2: Minutes
● Time-slot 3: Hours
● Time-slot 4: Days
● Time-slot 5 and 6: Control functions
● Time-slots 7 to 10: Straight binary time of day
The first four time-slots define the time in BCD (Binary Coded Decimal). Time-slots 5 and 6 are used for control
functions, which control deletion commands and allow different data groupings within the synchronisation strings.
Time-slots 7-10 define the time in SBS (Straight Binary Second of day).
P446SV-TM-EN-1 571
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
communication functionality such as Ethernet. The IRIG-B connection is presented by a connector is a BNC
connector. IRIG-B signals are usually presented as an RF-modulated signal. There are two types of input to our
IRIG-B boards: demodulated or modulated. A board that accepts a demodulated input is used where the IRIG-B
signal has already been demodulated by another device before being fed to the IED. A board that accepts a
modulated input has an on-board demodulator.
To set the device to use IRIG-B, use the setting IRIG-B Sync cell in the DATE AND TIME column.
The IRIG-B status can be viewed in the IRIG-B Status cell in the DATE AND TIME column.
9.2 SNTP
SNTP is used to synchronise the clocks of computer systems over packet-switched, variable-latency data
networks, such as IP. SNTP can be used as the time synchronisation method for models using IEC 61850 over
Ethernet.
The device is synchronised by the main SNTP server. This is achieved by entering the IP address of the SNTP server
into the IED using the IEC 61850 Configurator software described in the settings application software manual. A
second server is also configured with a different IP address for backup purposes.
This function issues an alarm when there is a loss of time synchronisation on the SNTP server. This could be
because there is no response or no valid clock signal.
The HMI menu does not contain any configurable settings relating to SNTP, as the only way to configure it is using
the IEC 61850 Configurator. However it is possible to view some parameters in the COMMUNICATIONS column
under the sub-heading SNTP parameters. Here you can view the SNTP server addresses and the SNTP poll rate in
the cells SNTP Server 1, SNTP Server 2 and SNTP Poll rate respectively.
The SNTP time synchronisation status is displayed in the SNTP Status cell in the DATE AND TIME column.
572 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 21 - Communications
When using end-to-end mode, the IED can be connected in a ring or line topology using RSTP or Self Healing
Protocol without any additional Transparent Clocks. But because the IED is a slave-only device, additional
inaccuracy is introduced. The additional error will be less than 1ms for a network of eight devices.
V01061
P446SV-TM-EN-1 573
Chapter 21 - Communications P446SV
574 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 22
CYBER-SECURITY
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV
576 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security
1 OVERVIEW
In the past, substation networks were traditionally isolated and the protocols and data formats used to transfer
information between devices were often proprietary.
For these reasons, the substation environment was very secure against cyber-attacks. The terms used for this
inherent type of security are:
● Security by isolation (if the substation network is not connected to the outside world, it cannot be accessed
from the outside world).
● Security by obscurity (if the formats and protocols are proprietary, it is very difficult to interpret them).
The increasing sophistication of protection schemes, coupled with the advancement of technology and the desire
for vendor interoperability, has resulted in standardisation of networks and data interchange within substations.
Today, devices within substations use standardised protocols for communication. Furthermore, substations can be
interconnected with open networks, such as the internet or corporate-wide networks, which use standardised
protocols for communication. This introduces a major security risk making the grid vulnerable to cyber-attacks,
which could in turn lead to major electrical outages.
Clearly, there is now a need to secure communication and equipment within substation environments. This
chapter describes the security measures that have been put in place for our range of Intelligent Electronic Devices
(IEDs).
Note:
Cyber-security compatible devices do not enforce NERC compliance, they merely facilitate it. It is the responsibility of the user
to ensure that compliance is adhered to as and when necessary.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 577
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV
The threats to cyber-security may be unintentional (e.g. natural disasters, human error), or intentional (e.g. cyber-
attacks by hackers).
Good cyber-security can be achieved with a range of measures, such as closing down vulnerability loopholes,
implementing adequate security processes and procedures and providing technology to help achieve this.
Examples of vulnerabilities are:
● Indiscretions by personnel (users keep passwords on their computer)
● Bad practice (users do not change default passwords, or everyone uses the same password to access all
substation equipment)
● Bypassing of controls (users turn off security measures)
● Inadequate technology (substation is not firewalled)
To help tackle these issues, standards organisations have produced various standards. Compliance with these
standards significantly reduces the threats associated with lack of cyber-security.
578 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security
3 STANDARDS
There are several standards, which apply to substation cyber-security. The standards currently applicable to
General Electric IEDs are NERC and IEEE1686.
Standard Country Description
NERC CIP (North American Electric Reliability
USA Framework for the protection of the grid critical Cyber Assets
Corporation)
BDEW (German Association of Energy and Water Requirements for Secure Control and Telecommunication
Germany
Industries) Systems
ICS oriented then Relevant for EPU completing existing standard
ANSI ISA 99 USA
and identifying new topics such as patch management
International Standard for substation IED cyber-security
IEEE 1686 International
capabilities
IEC 62351 International Power system data and Comm. protocol
ISO/IEC 27002 International Framework for the protection of the grid critical Cyber Assets
NIST SP800-53 (National Institute of Standards and
USA Complete framework for SCADA SP800-82and ICS cyber-security
Technology)
CPNI Guidelines (Centre for the Protection of National Clear and valuable good practices for Process Control and SCADA
UK
Infrastructure) security
P446SV-TM-EN-1 579
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV
580 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security
P446SV-TM-EN-1 581
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV
● IED functions and features are assigned to different password levels. The assignment is fixed.
● The audit trail is recorded, listing events in the order in which they occur, held in a circular buffer.
● Records contain all defined fields from the standard and record all defined function event types where the
function is supported.
● No password defeat mechanism exists. Instead a secure recovery password scheme is implemented.
● Unused ports (physical and logical) may be disabled.
582 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security
4 CYBER-SECURITY IMPLEMENTATION
The General Electric IEDs have always been and will continue to be equipped with state-of-the-art security
measures. Due to the ever-evolving communication technology and new threats to security, this requirement is
not static. Hardware and software security measures are continuously being developed and implemented to
mitigate the associated threats and risks.
This section describes the current implementation of cyber-security. This is valid for the release of platform
software to which this manual pertains. This current cyber-security implementation is known as Cyber-security
Phase 1.
At the IED level, these cyber-security measures have been implemented:
● NERC-compliant default display
● Four-level access
● Enhanced password security
● Password recovery procedure
● Disabling of unused physical and logical ports
● Inactivity timer
● Security events management
External to the IEDs, the following cyber-security measures have been implemented:
● Antivirus
● Security patch management
If you try to change the default display from the NERC-compliant one, a further warning is displayed:
The default display navigation map shows how NERC-compliance is achieved with the product's default display
concept.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 583
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV
NERC compliant
banner
System Current
Access Level
Measurements
System Voltage
System Frequency
Measurements
System Power
Plant Reference
Measurements
V00403
Password levels
Level Meaning Read Operation Write Operation
SYSTEM DATA column:
Description
Plant Reference
Model Number
Serial Number
S/W Ref.
Access Level
Read Some Password Entry
0 Security Feature
Write Minimal LCD Contrast (UI only)
SECURITY CONFIG column:
User Banner
Attempts Remain
Blk Time Remain
Fallback PW level
Security Code (UI only)
All items writeable at level 0.
Level 1 Password setting
Read All All data and settings are readable.
1 Extract Disturbance Record
Write Few Poll Measurements
Select Event, Main and Fault (upload)
Extract Events (e.g. via MiCOM S1 Studio)
584 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security
BLANK PASSWORD
ENTERED CONFIRM
Blank passwords cannot be configured if the lower level password is not blank.
Blank passwords affect the fall back level after inactivity timeout or logout.
The ‘fallback level’ is the password level adopted by the IED after an inactivity timeout, or after the user logs out.
This will be either the level of the highest-level password that is blank, or level 0 if no passwords are blank.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 585
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV
Key:
HMI = Human Machine Interface
FPort = Front Port
RPrt = Rear Port
Lvl = Level
586 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security
NERC COMPLIANT
P/WORD WAS SAVED
If the password entered is not NERC-compliant, the user is required to actively confirm this, in which case the non-
compliance is logged.
If the entered password is not NERC compliant, the following text is displayed:
NERC COMPLIANCE
NOT MET CONFIRM?
On confirmation, the non-compliant password is stored and the following acknowledgement message is displayed
for 2 seconds.
NON-NERC P/WORD
SAVED OK
If the action is cancelled, the password is rejected and the following message is displayed for 2 seconds.
NON-NERC P/WORD
NOT SAVE
If the password is entered through a communications port using Courier or Modbus protocols, the device will store
the password, irrespective of whether it is NERC-compliant or not. It then uses appropriate response codes to
inform the client of the NERC-compliancy status. You can then choose to enter a new NERC-compliant password
or accept the non-NERC compliant password just entered.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 587
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV
If you try to enter the password while the interface is blocked, the following message is displayed for 2 seconds.
NOT ACCEPTED
ENTRY IS BLOCKED
A similar response occurs if you try to enter the password through a communications port.
The parameters can then be configured using the Attempts Limit, Attempts Timer and Blocking Timer settings in
the SECURITY CONFIG column.
As soon as the security code is displayed on the LCD, a validity timer is started. This validity timer is set to 72 hours
and is not configurable. This provides enough time for the contact centre to manually generate and send a
recovery password. The Service Level Agreement (SLA) for recovery password generation is one working day, so 72
hours is sufficient time, even allowing for closure of the contact centre over weekends and bank holidays.
To prevent accidental reading of the IED security code, the cell will initially display a warning message:
PRESS ENTER TO
READ SEC. CODE
The security code is displayed on confirmation. The validity timer is then started. The security code can only be
read from the front panel.
588 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security
PASSWORDS HAVE
BEEN SET TO
DEFAULT
The recovery password can be applied through any interface, local or remote. It will achieve the same result
irrespective of which interface it is applied through.
REAR PORT 1 TO BE
DISABLED.CONFIRM
Note:
It is not possible to disable a port from which the disabling port command originates.
Note:
We do not generally advise disabling the physical Ethernet port.
Note:
The port disabling setting cells are not provided in the settings file. It is only possible to do this using the HMI front panel.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 589
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV
Note:
If any of these protocols are enabled or disabled, the Ethernet card will reboot.
590 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security
where:
● int is the interface definition (UI, FP, RP1, RP2, TNL, TCP)
● prt is the port ID (FP, RP1, RP2, TNL, DNP3, IEC, ETHR)
● grp is the group number (1, 2, 3, 4)
P446SV-TM-EN-1 591
Chapter 22 - Cyber-Security P446SV
Each new event has an incremented unique number, therefore missing events appear as ‘gap’ in the sequence.
The unique identifier forms part of the event record that is read or uploaded from the IED.
Note:
It is no longer possible to clear Event, Fault, Maintenance, and Disturbance Records.
DO YOU WANT TO
LOG OUT?
You will only be asked this question if your password level is higher than the fallback level.
If you confirm, the following message is displayed for 2 seconds:
LOGGED OUT
Access Level #
LOGOUT CANCELLED
Access Level #
592 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 23
INSTALLATION
Chapter 23 - Installation P446SV
594 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 23 - Installation
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter provides information about installing the product.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 595
Handling the Goods 596
Mounting the Device 597
Cables and Connectors 600
Case Dimensions 604
P446SV-TM-EN-1 595
Chapter 23 - Installation P446SV
Caution:
Before lifting or moving the equipment you should be familiar with the Safety
Information chapter of this manual.
596 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 23 - Installation
V01412
Caution:
Do not use conventional self-tapping screws, because they have larger heads and could
damage the faceplate.
Alternatively, you can use tapped holes if the panel has a minimum thickness of 2.5 mm.
For applications where the product needs to be semi-projection or projection mounted, a range of collars are
available.
If several products are mounted in a single cut-out in the panel, mechanically group them horizontally or vertically
into rigid assemblies before mounting in the panel.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 597
Chapter 23 - Installation P446SV
Caution:
Do not fasten products with pop rivets because this makes them difficult to remove if
repair becomes necessary.
Caution:
Risk of damage to the front cover molding. Do not use conventional self-tapping
screws, including those supplied for mounting MiDOS products because they have
slightly larger heads.
Once the tier is complete, the frames are fastened into the racks using mounting angles at each end of the tier.
Products can be mechanically grouped into single tier (4U) or multi-tier arrangements using the rack frame. This
enables schemes using products from different product ranges to be pre-wired together before mounting.
Use blanking plates to fill any empty spaces. The spaces may be used for installing future products or because the
total size is less than 80TE on any tier. Blanking plates can also be used to mount ancillary components. The part
numbers are as follows:
598 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 23 - Installation
P446SV-TM-EN-1 599
Chapter 23 - Installation P446SV
Caution:
Before carrying out any work on the equipment you should be familiar with the Safety
Section and the ratings on the equipment’s rating label.
MiCOM products are supplied with sufficient M4 screws for making connections to the rear mounted terminal
blocks using ring terminals, with a recommended maximum of two ring terminals per terminal.
If required, M4 90° crimp ring terminals can be supplied in three different sizes depending on wire size. Each type is
available in bags of 100.
Part number Wire size Insulation color
ZB9124 901 0.25 - 1.65 mm2 (22 – 16 AWG) Red
ZB9124 900 1.04 - 2.63 mm2 (16 – 14 AWG) Blue
600 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 23 - Installation
Caution:
Protect the auxiliary power supply wiring with a maximum 16 A high rupture capacity
(HRC) type NIT or TIA fuse.
Use a wire size of at least 2.5 mm2 terminated with a ring terminal.
Due to the physical limitations of the ring terminal, the maximum wire size you can use is 6.0 mm2 using ring
terminals that are not pre-insulated. If using pre insulated ring terminals, the maximum wire size is reduced to 2.63
mm2 per ring terminal. If you need a greater cross-sectional area, use two wires in parallel, each terminated in a
separate ring terminal.
The wire should have a minimum voltage rating of 300 V RMS.
Note:
To prevent any possibility of electrolytic action between brass or copper ground conductors and the rear panel of the product,
precautions should be taken to isolate them from one another. This could be achieved in several ways, including placing a
nickel-plated or insulating washer between the conductor and the product case, or using tinned ring terminals.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 601
Chapter 23 - Installation P446SV
Caution:
Protect the opto-inputs and their wiring with a maximum 16 A high rupture capacity
(HRC) type NIT or TIA fuse.
Note:
For models equipped with redundant Ethernet connections the product must be partially dismantled to set the fourth octet of
the second IP address. This ideally, should be done before installation.
602 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 23 - Installation
P446SV-TM-EN-1 603
Chapter 23 - Installation P446SV
5 CASE DIMENSIONS
Not all products are available in all case sizes.
AB BA
168.00 177.0
159.00 (4U)
AB BA
200.00
Note: If mouting plate is required
use flush mounting cut out
dimentions
All dimensons in mm
157.5
max.
Side view
206.00 30.00
E01411
604 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 24
COMMISSIONING INSTRUCTIONS
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
606 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 607
General Guidelines 608
Commissioning Test Menu 609
Commissioning Equipment 613
Product Checks 615
Electrical Intermicom Communication Loopback 624
Intermicom 64 Communication 626
Setting Checks 628
IEC 61850 Edition 2 Testing 630
Distance Protection 635
Delta Directional Comparison 641
DEF Aided Schemes 644
Out of Step Protection 646
Protection Timing Checks 648
System Check and Check Synchronism 650
Check Trip and Autoreclose Cycle 651
End-to-End Communication Tests 652
End-to-End Scheme Tests 655
Onload Checks 657
Final Checks 659
Commmissioning the P59x 660
P446SV-TM-EN-1 607
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
2 GENERAL GUIDELINES
General Electric IEDs are self-checking devices and will raise an alarm in the unlikely event of a failure. This is why
the commissioning tests are less extensive than those for non-numeric electronic devices or electro-mechanical
relays.
To commission the devices, you (the commissioning engineer) do not need to test every function. You need only
verify that the hardware is functioning correctly and that the application-specific software settings have been
applied. You can check the settings by extracting them using the settings application software, or by means of the
front panel interface (HMI panel).
The menu language is user-selectable, so you can change it for commissioning purposes if required.
Note:
Remember to restore the language setting to the customer’s preferred language on completion.
Caution:
Before carrying out any work on the equipment you should be familiar with the
contents of the Safety Section or Safety Guide SFTY/4LM as well as the ratings on the
equipment’s rating label.
Warning:
With the exception of the CT shorting contacts check, do not disassemble the device
during commissioning.
608 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
Note:
When the Test Mode cell is set to Contacts Blocked, the relay output status indicates which contacts would operate if
the IED was in-service. It does not show the actual status of the output relays, as they are blocked.
Caution:
The monitor/download port is not electrically isolated against induced voltages on
the communications channel. It should therefore only be used for local
communications.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 609
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
Caution:
When the cell is in Test Mode, the Scheme Logic still drives the output relays, which
could result in tripping of circuit breakers. To avoid this, set the Test Mode cell to
Contacts Blocked.
Note:
Test mode and Contacts Blocked mode can also be selected by energising an opto-input mapped to the Test Mode
signal, and the Contact Block signal respectively.
Note:
When the Test Mode cell is set to Contacts Blocked the Relay O/P Status cell does not show the current status of the
output relays and therefore cannot be used to confirm operation of the output relays. Therefore it will be necessary to monitor
the state of each contact in turn.
610 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
cycle. Once the trip output has operated the command text will revert to No Operation whilst the rest of the
auto-reclose cycle is performed. To test subsequent three-phase autoreclose cycles, you repeat the Trip 3
Pole command. You can also test the single phases with Trip Pole A , Trip Pole B and Trip Pole B.
Note:
The default settings for the programmable scheme logic has the AR Trip Test signals mapped to the Trip Input
signals. If the programmable scheme logic has been changed, it is essential that these signals retain this mapping for the
Test Autoreclose facility to work.
Note:
Trip times may be up to ½ cycle longer when tested in the static mode, due to the nature of the test voltage and current, and
the slower filtering. This is normal, and perfectly acceptable.
Note:
If the cell is set to Internal, only the IED software is checked. If the cell is set to External, both the software and hardware
are checked.
When the device is switched into Loopback Mode, it automatically uses generic addresses 0-0. It responds as if it is
connected to a remote device. The sent and received IM64 signals continue to be routed to and from the signals
defined in the programmable logic.
Note:
Loopback mode can also be selected by energising an opto-input mapped to the Loopback signal.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 611
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
Note:
When the status in both Red LED Status and Green LED Status cells is ‘1’, this indicates the LEDs illumination is yellow.
612 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
4 COMMISSIONING EQUIPMENT
Specialist test equipment is required to commission this product. We recognise three classes of equipment for
commissioning :
● Recommended
● Essential
● Advisory
Recommended equipment constitutes equipment that is both necessary, and sufficient, to verify correct
performance of the principal protection functions.
Essential equipment represents the minimum necessary to check that the product includes the basic expected
protection functions and that they operate within limits.
Advisory equipment represents equipment that is needed to verify satisfactory operation of features that may be
unused, or supplementary, or which may, for example, be integral to a distributed control/automation scheme.
Operation of such features may, perhaps, be more appropriately verified as part of a customer defined
commissioning requirement, or as part of a system-level commissioning regime.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 613
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
● Timer
● Test switches
● Suitable electrical test leads
● Continuity tester
For products that use fibre-optic communications to implement unit protection schemes :
● Fibre optic test leads (minimum 2). 10m minimum length, multimode 50/125 µm or 62.5µm, OR single mode
(according to the model variant) terminated with connectors as required by the product.
● Fibre-optic power meter
Note that if the AC test source that you are using is not capable of dynamic fault simulation (cannot dynamically
switch from load to fault conditions) you must use the product’s static test mode feature
To do this, in COMMISSIONING TESTS, set Static Test Mode to Enabled.
614 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
5 PRODUCT CHECKS
These product checks are designed to ensure that the device has not been physically damaged prior to
commissioning, is functioning correctly and that all input quantity measurements are within the stated tolerances.
If the application-specific settings have been applied to the IED prior to commissioning, you should make a copy of
the settings. This will allow you to restore them at a later date if necessary. This can be done by:
● Obtaining a setting file from the customer.
● Extracting the settings from the IED itself, using a portable PC with appropriate setting software.
If the customer has changed the password that prevents unauthorised changes to some of the settings, either the
revised password should be provided, or the original password restored before testing.
Note:
If the password has been lost, a recovery password can be obtained from General Electric.
Warning:
The following group of tests should be carried out without the auxiliary supply being
applied to the IED and, if applicable, with the trip circuit isolated.
The current and voltage transformer connections must be isolated from the IED for these checks. If a P991 test
block is provided, the required isolation can be achieved by inserting test plug type P992. This open circuits all
wiring routed through the test block.
Before inserting the test plug, you should check the scheme diagram to ensure that this will not cause damage or
a safety hazard (the test block may, for example, be associated with protection current transformer circuits). The
sockets in the test plug, which correspond to the current transformer secondary windings, must be linked before
the test plug is inserted into the test block.
Warning:
Never open-circuit the secondary circuit of a current transformer since the high
voltage produced may be lethal and could damage insulation.
If a test block is not provided, the voltage transformer supply to the IED should be isolated by means of the panel
links or connecting blocks. The line current transformers should be short-circuited and disconnected from the IED
terminals. Where means of isolating the auxiliary supply and trip circuit (for example isolation links, fuses and MCB)
are provided, these should be used. If this is not possible, the wiring to these circuits must be disconnected and the
exposed ends suitably terminated to prevent them from being a safety hazard.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 615
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
Warning:
Check the rating information under the top access cover on the front of the IED.
Warning:
Check that the IED being tested is correct for the line or circuit.
Warning:
Record the circuit reference and system details.
Warning:
Check the CT secondary current rating and record the CT tap which is in use.
Carefully examine the IED to see that no physical damage has occurred since installation.
Ensure that the case earthing connections (bottom left-hand corner at the rear of the IED case) are used to
connect the IED to a local earth bar using an adequate conductor.
Note:
Use a magnetic bladed screwdriver to minimise the risk of the screws being left in the terminal block or lost.
Pull the terminal block away from the rear of the case and check with a continuity tester that all the shorting
switches being used are closed.
5.1.3 INSULATION
Insulation resistance tests are only necessary during commissioning if explicitly requested.
Isolate all wiring from the earth and test the insulation with an electronic or brushless insulation tester at a DC
voltage not exceeding 500 V. Terminals of the same circuits should be temporarily connected together.
The insulation resistance should be greater than 100 MW at 500 V.
On completion of the insulation resistance tests, ensure all external wiring is correctly reconnected to the IED.
Caution:
Check that the external wiring is correct according to the relevant IED and scheme
diagrams. Ensure that phasing/phase rotation appears to be as expected.
616 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
Note:
The IED can withstand an AC ripple of up to 12% of the upper rated voltage on the DC auxiliary supply.
Warning:
Do not energise the IED or interface unit using the battery charger with the battery
disconnected as this can irreparably damage the power supply circuitry.
Caution:
Energise the IED only if the auxiliary supply is within the specified operating ranges.
If a test block is provided, it may be necessary to link across the front of the test plug
to connect the auxiliary supply to the IED.
Warning:
The current and voltage transformer connections must remain isolated from the IED
for these checks. The trip circuit should also remain isolated to prevent accidental
operation of the associated circuit breaker.
The following group of tests verifies that the IED hardware and software is functioning correctly and should be
carried out with the supply applied to the IED.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 617
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
Caution:
Before applying a contrast setting, make sure that it will not make the display so
light or dark such that menu text becomes unreadable. It is possible to restore the
visibility of a display by downloading a setting file, with the LCD Contrast set within
the typical range of 7 - 11.
Note:
If the auxiliary supply fails, the time and date will be maintained by the auxiliary battery. Therefore, when the auxiliary supply
is restored, you should not have to set the time and date again. To test this, remove the IRIG-B signal, and then remove the
auxiliary supply. Leave the device de-energised for approximately 30 seconds. On re energisation, the time should be correct.
When using IRIG-B to maintain the clock, the IED must first be connected to the satellite clock equipment (usually a
P594), which should be energised and functioning.
1. Set the IRIG-B Sync cell in the DATE AND TIME column to Enabled.
2. Ensure the IED is receiving the IRIG-B signal by checking that cell IRIG-B Status reads Active.
3. Once the IRIG-B signal is active, adjust the time offset of the universal co coordinated time (satellite clock
time) on the satellite clock equipment so that local time is displayed.
4. Check that the time, date and month are correct in the Date/Time cell. The IRIG-B signal does not contain
the current year so it will need to be set manually in this cell.
5. Reconnect the IRIG-B signal.
If the time and date is not being maintained by an IRIG-B signal, ensure that the IRIG-B Sync cell in the DATE AND
TIME column is set to Disabled.
1. Set the date and time to the correct local time and date using Date/Time cell or using the serial protocol.
618 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
Note:
In most cases, alarms related to the communications channels will not reset at this stage.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 619
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
For K-Bus applications, pins 17 and 18 are not polarity sensitive and it does not matter which way round the wires
are connected. EIA(RS)485 is polarity sensitive, so you must ensure the wires are connected the correct way round
(pin 18 is positive, pin 17 is negative).
If K-Bus is being used, a Kitz protocol converter (KITZ101, KITZ102 OR KITZ201) will have been installed to convert
the K-Bus signals into RS232. Likewise, if RS485 is being used, an RS485-RS232 converter will have been installed.
In the case where a protocol converter is being used, a laptop PC running appropriate software (such as MiCOM S1
Agile) can be connected to the incoming side of the protocol converter. An example for K-bus to RS232 conversion
is shown below. RS485 to RS232 would follow the same principle, only using a RS485-RS232 converter. Most
modern laptops have USB ports, so it is likely you will also require a RS232 to USB converter too.
620 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
RS232 K-Bus
V01001
Fibre Connection
Some models have an optional fibre optic communications port fitted (on a separate communications board). The
communications port to be used is selected by setting the Physical Link cell in the COMMUNICATIONS column, the
values being Copper or K-Bus for the RS485/K-bus port and Fibre Optic for the fibre optic port.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 621
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
If there is no board fitted or the board is faulty, a NIC link alarm will be raised (providing this option has been set in
the NIC Link Report cell in the COMMUNICATIONS column).
Note:
If a PC connected to the IED using the rear communications port is being used to display the measured current, the process
will be similar. However, the setting of the Remote Values cell in the MEASURE’T SETUP column will determine whether the
displayed values are in primary or secondary Amperes.
The measurement accuracy of the IED is +/- 1%. However, an additional allowance must be made for the accuracy
of the test equipment being used.
Note:
If a PC connected to the IED using the rear communications port is being used to display the measured current, the process
will be similar. However, the setting of the Remote Values cell in the MEASURE’T SETUP column will determine whether the
displayed values are in primary or secondary Amperes.
622 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
The measurement accuracy of the IED is +/- 1%. However, an additional allowance must be made for the accuracy
of the test equipment being used.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 623
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
Note:
If INTERMICOM COMMS > Loopback Mode is set to Internal, only the internal software of the device is checked. This is
useful for testing functionality if no communications connections are made. Use the 'External' setting during commissioning
because it checks both the software and hardware. When the IED is switched into either Internal or External Loopback Mode it
automatically inhibits InterMiCOM messages to the PSL by setting all eight InterMiCOM message command states to zero.
Set INTERMICOM COMMS > Loopback Mode to External and form a communications loopback by connecting
the transmit signal (pin 2) to the receive signal (pin 3).
Note:
The DCD signal must be held high (by connecting pin 1 to pin 4) if the connected equipment does not support DCD.
DCD 1
RxD 2
TxD 3
DTR 4
GND 5
6
RTS 7
8
9
E01450
The loopback mode is shown on the front panel by an Alarm LED and the message IM Loopback on the LCD.
Check that all connections are correct and the software is working correctly.
Check that INTERMICOM COMMS > Loopback Status shows OK.
624 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
Note:
Some or all of these cells show Fail depending on the communications configuration and the way the link has failed.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 625
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
7 INTERMICOM 64 COMMUNICATION
If the IED is used in a scheme with InterMiCOM64 communication, you need to configure a loopback for testing
purposes.
IM64 is fibre-based. Several different fibre-optic interfaces are available. In general, 1300 nm fibres are used for
direct connection (these may be single mode or multimode). 850 nm multimode fibres are generally used with
multiplexing telecommunications equipment.
Note:
It is important that fibres used for testing are correct for the specified interface(s).
Optical fibres should be terminated with BFOC2.5 (ST2.5) connectors. For multimode applications use 50/125 µm
core fibre. Make sure fibre test leads used for measurements are long enough for mode stripping (a method of
reducing loss within the core). We recommend a minimum length of 10 m (30ft) for this.
If IEDs communicate using IEEE C37.94 compliant multiplexed electrical communication channels, a P590 is used.
This is a bidirectional optical-to-electrical signal converter. It is situated near the multiplexer, between the fibre
from the IED and the electrical interface of the multiplexer. Apply the loopback either at the P590 or the multiplexer
to ensure as much of the circuit as possible is tested. If the IED is connected to a multiplexer, the loopback testing
is exactly the same whether connected directly or via a multiplexer. The P590 interface units require additional
tests (see P590 documentation).
To enable IM64, set the InterMiCOM64 cell in the CONFIGURATION column to Enable.
Warning:
NEVER look directly into the transmit port or the end of an optical fibre, as this could
severely damage your eyes.
Note:
If CONFIGURATION > InterMiCOM64 is set to Enable, the signals normally sent and received by and from the
communications interface are routed to and from the signals defined in the Programmable Scheme Logic. If, however,
COMMISSION TESTS > IM64 Test Mode is set to Enabled, an IM64 test pattern is transmitted instead.
626 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
Note:
The propagation delay measurement is not valid in this mode of operation. The IED responds as if it is connected to a remote
IED. It indicates a loopback alarm which can only be cleared by setting COMMISSION TESTS > Loopback Mode to Disabled.
Note:
In loopback mode the signals sent and received through the protection communications interface continue to be routed to
and from the signals defined in the programmable logic.
Note:
A test pattern can also be sent to the remote end to test the whole InterMiCOM communication path. To do this, set
COMMISSION TESTS >IM64 Test Mode to Enable and connect two ends. Take special care because the test pattern is
executed using PSL at the remote end.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 627
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
8 SETTING CHECKS
The setting checks ensure that all of the application-specific settings (both the IED’s function and programmable
scheme logic settings) have been correctly applied.
Note:
If applicable, the trip circuit should remain isolated during these checks to prevent accidental operation of the associated
circuit breaker.
Note:
The device name may not already exist in the system shown in System Explorer. In this case, perform a Quick Connect to the
IED, then manually add the settings file to the device name in the system. Refer to the Settings Application Software help for
details of how to do this.
628 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
8. Press the Enter key to confirm the new setting value or the Clear key to discard it. The new setting is
automatically discarded if it is not confirmed within 15 seconds.
9. For protection group settings and disturbance recorder settings, the changes must be confirmed before
they are used. When all required changes have been entered, return to the column heading level and press
the down cursor key. Before returning to the default display, the following prompt appears.
Update settings?
ENTER or CLEAR
10. Press the Enter key to accept the new settings or press the Clear key to discard the new settings.
Note:
If the menu time-out occurs before the setting changes have been confirmed, the setting values are also discarded.
Control and support settings are updated immediately after they are entered, without the Update settings prompt.
It is not possible to change the PSL using the IED’s front panel HMI.
Caution:
Where the installation needs application-specific PSL, the relevant .psl files, must be
transferred to the IED, for each and every setting group that will be used. If you do
not do this, the factory default PSL will still be resident. This may have severe
operational and safety consequences.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 629
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
The following table summarises the IED behaviour under the different modes:
IED Test Mode Setting Result
Disabled ● Normal IED behaviour
● Protection remains enabled
● Output from the device is still active
Test ● IEC 61850 message output has the 'quality' parameter set to 'test'
● The device only responds to IEC61850 MMS messages from the client with the
'test' flag set
● Protection remains enabled
● Output from the device is disabled
Contacts Blocked ● IEC 61850 message output has quality set to ‘test’
● The device only responds to IEC 61850 MMS messages from the client with the
'test' flag set
Setting the Test or Contacts Blocked mode puts the whole IED into test mode. The IEC 61850 data object Beh in all
Logical Nodes (except LPHD and any protection Logical Nodes that have Beh = 5 (off) due to the function being
disabled) will be set to 3 (test) or 4 (test/blocked) as applicable.
630 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
LPHD1
Incoming data
processed
Real GOOSE 2 messages
Reception buffer
V01058
P446SV-TM-EN-1 631
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
V01062
632 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
V01063
P446SV-TM-EN-1 633
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
V01064
Note:
When the IED Test Mode cell is set to Contacts Blocked, the Relay O/P Status cell does not show the current status of the
output relays so cannot be used to confirm operation of the output relays. Therefore it is necessary to monitor the state of
each contact in turn.
634 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
10 DISTANCE PROTECTION
10.1.1 PRELIMINARIES
You should now connect the IED to equipment able to supply phase-phase and phase-neutral volts with current in
the correct phase relation for a particular type of fault on the selected characteristic angle. The facility for altering
the loop impedance (phase-to-ground fault or phase-phase) presented to the IED is essential.
Use a three-phase digital/electronic injection test set to make the commissioning procedure easier.
1. If testing the distance elements using using test sets that do not provide a dynamic model to generate true
fault delta conditions, set COMMISSIONING TESTS > Static Test Mode to Enabled. When set, this disables
phase selector control and forces the device to use a conventional (non-delta) directional line.
2. For lower specification test equipment that cannot apply a full three phase set of healthy simulated pre-
fault voltages, the VT supervision may need to be disabled to avoid spurious pickup. Set CONFIGURATION >
Supervision to Disabled.
3. Connect the test equipment to the device using the test block(s), taking care not to open-circuit any CT
secondary windings. If using MMLG type test blocks, the live side of the test plug must be provided with
shorting links before it is inserted into the test block.
4. When the test is complete, make sure COMMISSIONING TESTS > Static Test Mode is set back to Disabled.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 635
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
636 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
Note:
Zone 3 has an independent setting for the forward resistance reach (right-hand resistive reach line), and the reverse resistance
reach (left-hand resistive reach line).
10.2.1 PHASE A
1. Prepare a dynamic A-phase-to-neutral fault, as detailed above.
2. Set a timer to start when the fault injection is applied and to stop when the trip occurs.
3. To verify correct output contact mapping use the trip contacts that would be expected to trip the circuit
breaker(s) (Any Trip for 3-pole tripping, Trip A for single pole tripping).
4. For two breaker applications, stop the timer when CB1 and CB2 trip contacts have both closed. Monitor by
connecting the contacts in series to stop the timer if necessary.
5. Record the phase A trip time.
6. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.
10.2.2 PHASE B
1. Reconfigure to test a B phase fault.
2. Repeat the test, this time ensuring that the breaker trip contacts relative to B phase operation close
correctly.
3. Record the phase B trip time.
4. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.
10.2.3 PHASE C
1. Reconfigure to test a C phase fault.
2. Repeat the test, this time ensuring that the breaker trip contacts relative to C phase operation close
correctly.
3. Record the phase C trip time.
4. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 637
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
The average of the recorded operating times for the three phases should typically be less than 20 ms for 50 Hz,
and less than 16.7 ms for 60 Hz when set for instantaneous operation.
Note:
Where a non-zero time delay is set in the DISTANCE menu column, the expected operating time is typically within +/- 5% of
the delay setting plus the “instantaneous” delay.
Note:
The device allows separate time delay settings for phase (“Ph”) and ground (“Gnd”) fault elements. BOTH must be checked to
ensure that they have been set correctly.
If an InterMiCOM64 scheme is used to provide the signalling, the scheme logic may not use opto-inputs for the
aided scheme implementation. In this case, internal DDB signals need to be set or reset to test the operation of the
protection scheme.
Use the IM64 Test Mode with the IM64 Test Pattern to assert or monitor the relevant signals.
Ensure that the injection test set timer is still connected to measure the time taken for the device to trip. A series of
fault injections are applied, with a Zone 1, end-of-line, or Zone 4 fault simulated. At this stage, note the method in
which each fault is applied, but do not inject yet:
● Zone 1 fault: A dynamic forward A-B fault at half the Zone 1 reach is simulated.
● End of line fault: A dynamic forward A-B fault at the remote end of the line is simulated. The fault
impedance simulated should match the LINE PARAMETERS > Line Impedance setting.
● Zone 4 fault: A dynamic reverse A-B fault at half the Zone 4 reach is simulated.
The following table indicates the expected response for various test situations for a conventional signalling
scheme.
IED RESPONSE
Forward fault in Forward fault at end of line
Fault type simulated Reverse fault in zone 4
zone 1 (within Z1X/Z2)
Signal receive opto ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF
Zone 1 extension Trip Trip No Trip Trip No Trip No Trip
Trip, Trip, No Trip, No Signal Trip, No Trip, Signal No Trip, Signal
Blocking scheme
No Signal Send No Signal Send Send No Signal Send Send Send
638 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
IED RESPONSE
Forward fault in Forward fault at end of line
Fault type simulated Reverse fault in zone 4
zone 1 (within Z1X/Z2)
Permissive Scheme Trip, No Trip, No Signal No Trip, No Signal No Trip, No Signal
Trip, Signal Send Trip, Signal Send
(PUR/PUTT) No Signal Send Send Send Send
Permissive Scheme No Trip, Signal No Trip, No Signal No Trip, No Signal
Trip, Signal Send Trip, Signal Send Trip, Signal Send
(POR/POTT) Send Send Send
Note:
Here a non-zero tZ1 Ph or tZ1 Gnd time delay is set in the DISTANCE column, the expected operating time is typically within
+/- 5% of the tZ1 setting plus the “instantaneous” delay quoted above.
Note:
Where a non-zero Aided Distance Dly time delay is set in the DISTANCE menu column, the expected operating time is typically
within +/- 5% of the tZ1 setting plus the “instantaneous” delay quoted above.
Note:
For blocking schemes, a non-zero Aided Distance Dly time delay is set, so the expected operating time is typically within +/-
5% of the delay setting plus the “instantaneous” operating delay. The trip time should thus be less than 20 ms for 50 Hz, and
less than 16.7 ms for 60 Hz, plus 1.05 x Delay setting.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 639
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
640 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
11.1.1 PRELIMINARIES
Use a three-phase digital/electronic injection test set to make the commissioning procedure easier.
Connect the test equipment to the device using the test block(s) taking care not to open-circuit any CT secondary.
If MMLG type test blocks are used, the live side of the test plug must be provided with shorting links before it is
inserted into the test block.
If an InterMiCOM64 scheme is used to provide the signalling, the scheme logic may not use opto-inputs for the
aided scheme implementation. In this case, internal DDB signals need to be set or reset to test the operation of the
protection scheme.
Use the IM64 Test Mode with the IM64 Test Pattern to assert or monitor the relevant signals.
IED RESPONSE
Direction of fault test
Forward fault Reverse fault
injection
Signal receive opto ON OFF ON OFF
No Trip, Trip, No Trip, No Trip,
Blocking scheme
No Signal Send No Signal Send Signal Send Signal Send
Permissive scheme (POR/ Trip, No Trip, No Trip, No Trip,
POTT) Signal Send Signal Send No Signal Send No Signal Send
P446SV-TM-EN-1 641
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
11.2.1 PHASE A
1. Prepare a dynamic A-phase-to-neutral fault, as detailed above.
2. Set a timer to start when the fault injection is applied and to stop when the trip occurs.
3. To verify correct output contact mapping use the trip contacts that would be expected to trip the circuit
breaker(s) (Any Trip for 3-pole tripping, Trip A for single pole tripping).
4. For two breaker applications, stop the timer when CB1 and CB2 trip contacts have both closed. Monitor by
connecting the contacts in series to stop the timer if necessary.
5. Record the phase A trip time.
6. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.
11.2.2 PHASE B
1. Reconfigure to test a B phase fault.
2. Repeat the test, this time ensuring that the breaker trip contacts relative to B phase operation close
correctly.
3. Record the phase B trip time.
4. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.
11.2.3 PHASE C
1. Reconfigure to test a C phase fault.
2. Repeat the test, this time ensuring that the breaker trip contacts relative to C phase operation close
correctly.
3. Record the phase C trip time.
4. Switch OFF the AC supply and reset the alarms.
The average of the recorded operating times for the three phases should typically be less than 20 ms for 50 Hz,
and less than 16.7 ms for 60 Hz when set for instantaneous operation.
Note:
Where a non-zero time delay is set in the DISTANCE menu column, the expected operating time is typically within +/- 5% of
the delay setting plus the “instantaneous” delay.
642 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
Caution:
When the tests are completed, restore all settings that were disabled for testing
purposes.
Caution:
Remove any wires or leads temporarily fitted to energise the channel receive opto-
input.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 643
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
If an InterMiCOM64 scheme is used to provide the signalling, the scheme logic may not use opto-inputs for the
aided scheme implementation. In this case, internal logic signals (DDBs) need to be set or reset to test the
operation of the protection scheme.
The IM64 Test Mode in conjunction with the IM64 Test Pattern should be used to assert or monitor the relevant
signals.
This set of injection tests aims to determine that a single device, at one end of the scheme is performing correctly.
Note:
The device must be tested in isolation, with the communications channel to the remote line terminal disconnected.
12.1.1 PRELIMINARIES
1. Determine which output relays have been selected to operate when a DEF trip occurs, by viewing the
programmable scheme logic. If the trip outputs are phase segregated (a different output relay allocated for
each phase), the output relay assigned for tripping on ‘A’ phase faults should be used.
2. Connect the output relay so that its operation will trip the test set and stop the timer.
3. Connect the current output of the test set to the ‘A’ phase current transformer input
4. Connect, all three phase voltages Va, Vb, and Vc.
5. Depending on the test equipment used, make sure the timer is set to start when the current is applied.
644 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
Caution:
When the tests are completed, restore all settings that were disabled for testing
purposes.
Caution:
Remove any wires or leads temporarily fitted to energise the channel receive opto-
input.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 645
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
+jX
Z6
Z5
State 4
State 3
State 2
State 1
R
R6' R5' R5 R6
∆R
Z5'
Z6'
V01451
Depending on the Out of Step (OST) settings, use one of the following setting options.
● OST setting
● Predictive OST setting
● Predictive and OST setting
Now apply the 4-state sequence, check that all 3-phases have tripped and that an OST alarm is displayed on the
local LCD.
646 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
Note:
The angle in the table above is the angle between voltages and their respective currents. In state 4 the currents are displaced
180° from their respective voltages.
Now apply the 3-state sequence, check that all 3-phases have tripped and that an OST alarm is displayed on the
local LCD.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 647
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
Note:
If using the default PSL, use output relay 3 as this is already mapped to the DDB signal Trip Command Out.
4. Connect the output relay so that its operation will trip the test set and stop the timer.
5. Connect the current output of the test set to the A-phase current transformer input.
If the I>1 Directional cell in the OVERCURRENT column is set to Directional Fwd, the current should
flow out of terminal 2. If set to Directional Rev, it should flow into terminal 2.
If the I>1 Directional cell in the OVERCURRENT column has been set to Directional Fwd or
Directional Rev, the rated voltage should be applied to terminals 20 and 21.
6. Ensure that the timer starts when the current is applied.
Note:
If the timer does not stop when the current is applied and stage 1 has been set for directional operation, the connections may
be incorrect for the direction of operation set. Try again with the current connections reversed.
648 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
Note:
With the exception of the definite time characteristic, the operating times given are for a Time Multiplier Setting (TMS) or Time
Dial Setting (TDS) of 1. For other values of TMS or TDS, the values need to be modified accordingly.
Note:
For definite time and inverse characteristics there is an additional delay of up to 0.02 second and 0.08 second respectively.
You may need to add this the IED's acceptable range of operating times.
Caution:
On completion of the tests, you must restore all settings to customer specifications.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 649
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
For a dual circuit breaker installation (breaker-and-a-half switch or mesh/ring bus), three VT inputs are required:
● one from the common point of the two circuit breakers, identified as the line (Main VT)
● one from the bus side of CB1 (CB1 CS VT)
● one from the bus side of CB2 (CB2 CS VT)
In most cases the line VT input is three phase, whereas the bus VTs are single phase.
The bus VT inputs are normally single phase so the system voltage checks are made on single phases and the VT
may be connected to either a phase-to-phase or phase to neutral voltage.
For these reasons, the IED has to be programmed with the appropriate connection. The CS Input setting in the CT
AND VT RATIOS column can be set to A-N, B-N, C-N, A-B, B-C or C-A according to the application.
The single-phase bus VT inputs each have associated phase shift and voltage magnitude compensation settings
to compensate for healthy voltage angle and magnitude differences between the check sync VT input and the
selected main VT reference phase. These are:
● CB1 CS VT PhShft, CB1 CS VT Mag, CB2 CS VT PhShft, CB2 CS VT Mag
Any voltage measurements or comparisons using bus VT inputs are made using the compensated values.
Each circuit breaker controlled can have two stages of check synchronism enabled according to the settings:
● Sys Checks CB1, CB1 CS1 Status, CB1 CS2 Status, Sys Checks CB2, CB2 CS1 Status, CB1 CS2 Status
When the system voltage check conditions are satisfied, the relevant DDB signals are asserted high as follows:
● DDB (883): CB1 CS1 OK
● DDB (884): CB1 CS2 OK
● DDB (1577): CB2 CS1 OK
● DDB (1463): CB2 CS2 OK
These DDB signals should be mapped to the monitor/download port and used to indicate that the system check
synchronism condition has been satisfied.
650 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
1. To test the first three-phase auto-reclose cycle, set COMMISSION TESTS > Test Autoreclose to Trip 3
Pole. The IED performs a trip/reclose cycle.
2. Repeat this operation to test the subsequent three-phase auto-reclose cycles.
3. Check all output relays (used for such as circuit breaker tripping and closing, or blocking other devices)
operate at the correct times during the trip/close cycle.
Check the auto-reclose cycles for single phase trip conditions one at a time by sequentially setting COMMISSION
TESTS > Test Autoreclose to Trip Pole A, Trip Pole B and Trip Pole C.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 651
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
If the IED is being used in a scheme with InterMiCOM64 communications you must perform end-to-end testing of
the protection communications channels.
In this section all loopbacks are removed and satisfactory communications between line ends of the IEDs in the
scheme are confirmed.
Note:
End-to-end communication requires a working telecommunication channel between line ends (which may be a multiplexed
link or may be a direct connection). If the telecommunication channel is not available, it is not possible to establish end-to end
communication. Unless otherwise directed by local operational practise, follow the instructions in this section so the scheme
is ready for full operation when the telecommunications channels become available.
Note:
The trip circuit should remain isolated during these checks to prevent accidental operation of the associated circuit breaker.
Note:
Most of the required optical signal power levels have already been measured and recorded. If all signalling uses P59x
interface units, no further measurements are required. If, however, direct fibre or C37.94 communications are used, further
measurements are needed.
Warning:
NEVER look directly into the transmit port or the end of an optical fibre, as this could
severely damage your eyes.
652 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
Warning:
NEVER look directly into the transmit port or the end of an optical fibre, as this could
severely damage your eyes.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 653
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
3. Clear the statistics and record the number of valid messages and the number of errored messages after a
minimum period of 1 hour.
4. Check that the ratio of errored/good messages is better than 10-4.
5. Record the measured message propagation delays for channel 1, and channel 2 (if fitted).
654 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
P446SV-TM-EN-1 655
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
2. Return the device to service by setting COMMISSION TESTS > Test Mode to Disabled.
656 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
19 ONLOAD CHECKS
Warning:
Onload checks are potentially very dangerous and may only be carried out by
qualified and authorised personnel.
Onload checks can only be carried out if there are no restrictions preventing the energisation of the plant, and the
other devices in the group have already been commissioned.
Remove all test leads and temporary shorting links, then replace any external wiring that has been removed to
allow testing.
Warning:
If any external wiring has been disconnected for the commissioning process, replace
it in accordance with the relevant external connection or scheme diagram.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 657
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
If the Local Values cell is set to Secondary, the values displayed should be equal to the applied secondary
voltage. The values should be within 1% of the applied secondary voltages. However, an additional allowance must
be made for the accuracy of the test equipment being used.
If the Local Values cell is set to Primary, the values displayed should be equal to the applied secondary voltage
multiplied the corresponding voltage transformer ratio set in the CT & VT RATIOS column. The values should be
within 1% of the expected values, plus an additional allowance for the accuracy of the test equipment being used.
Note:
This check applies only for Measurement Modes 0 (default), and 2. This should be checked in the MEASURE’T SETUP column
(Measurement Mode = 0 or 2). If measurement modes 1 or 3 are used, the expected power flow signing would be opposite to
that shown above.
In the event of any uncertainty, check the phase angle of the phase currents with respect to their phase voltage.
658 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
20 FINAL CHECKS
1. Remove all test leads and temporary shorting leads.
2. If you have had to disconnect any of the external wiring in order to perform the wiring verification tests,
replace all wiring, fuses and links in accordance with the relevant external connection or scheme diagram.
3. The settings applied should be carefully checked against the required application-specific settings to ensure
that they are correct, and have not been mistakenly altered during testing.
4. Ensure that all protection elements required have been set to Enabled in the CONFIGURATION column.
5. Ensure that the IED has been restored to service by checking that the Test Mode cell in the COMMISSION
TESTS column is set to Disabled.
6. If the IED is in a new installation or the circuit breaker has just been maintained, the circuit breaker
maintenance and current counters should be zero. These counters can be reset using the Reset All Values
cell. If the required access level is not active, the device will prompt for a password to be entered so that the
setting change can be made.
7. If the menu language has been changed to allow accurate testing it should be restored to the customer’s
preferred language.
8. If a P991/MMLG test block is installed, remove the P992/MMLB test plug and replace the cover so that the
protection is put into service.
9. Ensure that all event records, fault records, disturbance records, alarms and LEDs and communications
statistics have been reset.
Note:
Remember to restore the language setting to the customer’s preferred language on completion.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 659
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
Warning:
Check the rating information under the top access cover on the front of the IED.
Warning:
Check that the IED being tested is correct for the line or circuit.
Warning:
Record the circuit reference and system details.
Warning:
Check the CT secondary current rating and record the CT tap which is in use.
Carefully examine the IED to see that no physical damage has occurred since installation.
Ensure that the case earthing connections (bottom left-hand corner at the rear of the IED case) are used to
connect the IED to a local earth bar using an adequate conductor.
21.2 INSULATION
Insulation resistance tests are only necessary during commissioning if explicitly requested.
Isolate all wiring from the earth and test the insulation with an electronic or brushless insulation tester at a DC
voltage not exceeding 500 V. Terminals of the same circuits should be temporarily connected together.
The insulation resistance should be greater than 100 MW at 500 V.
On completion of the insulation resistance tests, ensure all external wiring is correctly reconnected to the IED.
Note:
The V.35 circuits and the X.21 circuits of the P592 and P593 respectively are isolated from all other circuits but are electrically
connected to the outer case. The circuits must therefore not be insulation or impulse tested to the case.
Caution:
Check that the external wiring is correct according to the relevant IED and scheme
diagrams. Ensure that phasing/phase rotation appears to be as expected.
660 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions
P592 and P593 units operate from a DC auxiliary supply within the range of 19 V to 300 V.
Without energizing the device, measure the auxiliary supply to ensure it is within the operating range.
The devices are designed to withstand an AC ripple component of up to 12% of the normal DC auxiliary supply.
However, in all cases the peak value of the DC supply must not exceed the maximum specified operating limit.
Warning:
Do not energise the device or interface unit using the battery charger with the
battery disconnected as this can irreparably damage the power supply circuitry.
P592 only
The four red LEDs can be tested by appropriate setting of the DIL switches on the front plate. Set the data rate
switch according to the communication channel bandwidth available. Set all other switches to 0. To illuminate the
‘DSR OFF’ and ‘CTS OFF’ LED’s, disconnect the V.35 connector from the rear of the P592 and set the ‘DSR’ and ‘CTS’
switches to ‘0’. The ‘OPTO LOOPBACK’ and ‘V.35 LOOPBACK’ LEDs can be illuminated by setting their corresponding
switches to ‘1’.
Once operation of the LEDs has been established set all DIL switches, except for the ‘OPTO LOOPBACK’ switch, to ‘0’
and reconnect the V.35 connector.
P593 only
Set the ‘X.21 LOOPBACK’ switch to ‘ON’. The green ‘CLOCK’ and red ‘X.21 LOOPBACK’ LED’s should illuminate. Reset
the ‘X.21 LOOPBACK’ switch to the ‘OFF’ position.
Set the ‘OPTO LOOPBACK’ switch to ‘ON’. The red ‘OPTO LOOPBACK’ LED should illuminate. Do not reset the “OPTO
LOOPBACK’ switch as it is required in this position for the next test.
Warning:
NEVER look directly into the transmit port or the end of an optical fibre, as this could
severely damage your eyes.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 661
Chapter 24 - Commissioning Instructions P446SV
P591
It is necessary to loop the transmitted electrical G.703 signal presented on terminals 3 and 4 of the P591 to the
received signal presented on terminals 7 and 8.
If test links have been designed into the scheme to facilitate this they should be used. Alternatively, remove any
external wiring from terminals 3, 4, 7 and 8 at the rear of each P591 unit. Loopback the G.703 signals on each
device by connecting a wire link between terminals 3 and 7, and a second wire between terminals 4 and 8.
P592
With the ‘OPTO LOOPBACK’ switch in the ‘1’ position, the receive and transmit optical ports are connected together.
This allows the optical fibre communications between the IED and the P592 to be tested, but not the internal
circuitry of the P592 itself.
P593
Set the ‘OPTO LOOPBACK’ switch to ‘OFF’ and ‘X.21 LOOPBACK’ switch to ‘ON’ respectively. With the ‘X.21
LOOPBACK’ switch in this position the ‘Receive Data’ and ‘Transmit Data’ lines of the X.21 communication interface
are connected together. This allows the optical fibre communications between the IED and the P593, and the
internal circuitry of the P593 itself to be tested.
662 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 25
664 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
The Maintenance and Troubleshooting chapter provides details of how to maintain and troubleshoot products
based on the Px4x and P40Agile platforms. Always follow the warning signs in this chapter. Failure to do so may
result injury or defective equipment.
Caution:
Before carrying out any work on the equipment you should be familiar with the
contents of the Safety Section or the Safety Guide SFTY/4LM and the ratings on the
equipment’s rating label.
The troubleshooting part of the chapter allows an error condition on the IED to be identified so that appropriate
corrective action can be taken.
If the device develops a fault, it is usually possible to identify which module needs replacing. It is not possible to
perform an on-site repair to a faulty module.
If you return a faulty unit or module to the manufacturer or one of their approved service centres, you should
include a completed copy of the Repair or Modification Return Authorization (RMA) form.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 665
Maintenance 666
Troubleshooting 674
P446SV-TM-EN-1 665
Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV
2 MAINTENANCE
Although some functionality checks can be performed from a remote location, these are predominantly restricted
to checking that the unit is measuring the applied currents and voltages accurately, and checking the circuit
breaker maintenance counters. For this reason, maintenance checks should also be performed locally at the
substation.
Caution:
Before carrying out any work on the equipment you should be familiar with the
contents of the Safety Section or the Safety Guide SFTY/4LM and the ratings on the
equipment’s rating label.
2.1.1 ALARMS
First check the alarm status LED to see if any alarm conditions exist. If so, press the Read key repeatedly to step
through the alarms.
After dealing with any problems, clear the alarms. This will clear the relevant LEDs.
2.1.2 OPTO-ISOLATORS
Check the opto-inputs by repeating the commissioning test detailed in the Commissioning chapter.
666 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Caution:
Replacing PCBs requires the correct on-site environment (clean and dry) as well as
suitably trained personnel.
Caution:
If the repair is not performed by an approved service centre, the warranty will be
invalidated.
Caution:
Before carrying out any work on the equipment, you should be familiar with the
contents of the Safety Information section of this guide or the Safety Guide SFTY/4LM,
as well as the ratings on the equipment’s rating label. This should ensure that no
damage is caused by incorrect handling of the electronic components.
Warning:
Before working at the rear of the device, isolate all voltage and current supplying it.
Note:
The current transformer inputs are equipped with integral shorting switches which will close for safety reasons, when the
terminal block is removed.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 667
Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV
Caution:
If the top and bottom access covers have been removed, some more screws with
smaller diameter heads are made accessible. Do NOT remove these screws, as they
secure the front panel to the device.
Note:
There are four possible types of terminal block: RTD/CLIO input, heavy duty, medium duty, and MiDOS. The terminal blocks are
fastened to the rear panel with slotted or cross-head screws depending on the type of terminal block. Not all terminal block
types are present on all products.
Warning:
Before removing the front panel to replace a PCB, you must first remove the auxiliary
power supply and wait 5 seconds for the internal capacitors to discharge. You should
also isolate voltage and current transformer connections and trip circuit.
668 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting
Caution:
Before removing the front panel, you should be familiar with the contents of the Safety
Information section of this guide or the Safety Guide SFTY/4LM, as well as the ratings
on the equipment’s rating label.
Caution:
Do not remove the screws with the larger diameter heads which are accessible when
the access covers are fitted and open. These screws hold the relay in its mounting
(panel or cubicle).
Caution:
The internal circuitry is now exposed and is not protected against electrostatic
discharge and dust ingress. Therefore ESD precautions and clean working conditions
must be maintained at all times.
Note:
To ensure compatibility, always replace a faulty PCB with one of an identical part number.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 669
Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV
Note:
After replacing the main processor board, all the settings required for the application need to be re-entered. This may be done
either manually or by downloading a settings file.
V01601
670 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting
6. Fit the replacement PCB carefully into the correct slot. Make sure it is pushed fully back and that the
securing screws are refitted.
7. Reconnect all connections at the rear.
8. Refit the front panel.
9. Refit and close the access covers then press the hinge assistance T-pieces so they click back into the front
panel moulding.
10. Once the unit has been reassembled, commission it according to the Commissioning chapter.
Caution:
With non-mounted IEDs, the case needs to be held firmly while the module is
withdrawn. Withdraw the input module with care as it suddenly comes loose once the
friction of the terminal blocks is overcome.
Note:
If individual boards within the input module are replaced, recalibration will be necessary. We therefore recommend
replacement of the complete module to avoid on-site recalibration.
Caution:
Before removing the front panel, you should be familiar with the contents of the Safety
Information section of this guide or the Safety Guide SFTY/4LM, as well as the ratings
on the equipment’s rating label.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 671
Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV
The power supply board is fastened to an output relay board with push fit nylon pillars. This doubled-up board is
secured on the extreme left hand side, looking from the front of the unit.
1. Remove front panel.
2. Pull the power supply module forward, away from the rear terminal blocks and out of the case. A
reasonable amount of force is needed due to the friction between the contacts of the terminal blocks.
3. Separate the boards by pulling them apart carefully. The power supply board is the one with two large
electrolytic capacitors.
4. Before reassembling the module, check that the number on the round label next to the front edge of the
PCB matches the slot number into which it will be fitted. If the slot number is missing or incorrect, write the
correct slot number on the label
5. Reassemble the module with a replacement PCB. Push the inter-board connectors firmly together. Fit the
four push fit nylon pillars securely in their respective holes in each PCB.
6. Slot the power supply module back into the housing. Push it fully back onto the rear terminal blocks.
7. Refit the front panel.
8. Refit and close the access covers then press the hinge assistance T-pieces so they click back into the front
panel moulding.
9. Once the unit has been reassembled, commission it according to the Commissioning chapter.
2.6 RECALIBRATION
Recalibration is not needed when a PCB is replaced, unless it is one of the boards in the input module. If any of the
boards in the input module is replaced, the unit must be recalibrated.
Although recalibration is needed when a board inside the input module is replaced, it is not needed if the input
module is replaced in its entirety.
Although it is possible to carry out recalibration on site, this requires special test equipment and software. We
therefore recommend that the work be carried out by the manufacturer, or entrusted to an approved service
centre.
672 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting
As part of the product's continuous self-monitoring, an alarm is given if the battery condition becomes poor.
Nevertheless, you should change the battery periodically to ensure reliability.
To replace the battery:
1. Open the bottom access cover on the front of the relay.
2. Gently remove the battery. If necessary, use a small insulated screwdriver.
3. Make sure the metal terminals in the battery socket are free from corrosion, grease and dust.
4. Remove the replacement battery from its packaging and insert it in the battery holder, ensuring correct
polarity.
5. Ensure that the battery is held securely in its socket and that the battery terminals make good contact with
the socket terminals.
6. Close the bottom access cover.
Caution:
Only use a type ½AA Lithium battery with a nominal voltage of 3.6 V and safety
approvals such as UL (Underwriters Laboratory), CSA (Canadian Standards Association)
or VDE (Vereinigung Deutscher Elektrizitätswerke).
Note:
Events, disturbance and maintenance records will be lost if the battery is replaced whilst the IED is de-energised.
2.8 CLEANING
Warning:
Before cleaning the device, ensure that all AC and DC supplies and transformer
connections are isolated, to prevent any chance of an electric shock while cleaning.
Only clean the equipment with a lint-free cloth dampened with clean water. Do not use detergents, solvents or
abrasive cleaners as they may damage the product's surfaces and leave a conductive residue.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 673
Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV
3 TROUBLESHOOTING
674 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting
P446SV-TM-EN-1 675
Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV
676 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting
If the signal is correctly applied, this indicates failure of an opto-input, which may be situated on standalone opto-
input board, or on an opto-input board that is part of the input module. Separate opto-input boards can simply be
replaced. If, however, the faulty opto-input board is part of the input module, the complete input module should be
replaced. This is because the analogue input module cannot be individually replaced without dismantling the
module and recalibration of the IED.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 677
Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV
678 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting
If required, an acceptance of the quote must be delivered before going to the next stage.
5. Send the product to the repair centre
○ Address the shipment to the repair centre specified by your local contact
○ Make sure all items are packaged in an anti-static bag and foam protection
○ Make sure a copy of the import invoice is attached with the returned unit
○ Make sure a copy of the RMA form is attached with the returned unit
○ E-mail or fax a copy of the import invoice and airway bill document to your local contact.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 679
Chapter 25 - Maintenance and Troubleshooting P446SV
680 P446SV-TM-EN-1
CHAPTER 26
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV
682 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications
1 CHAPTER OVERVIEW
This chapter describes the technical specifications of the product.
This chapter contains the following sections:
Chapter Overview 683
Interfaces 684
Protection Functions 688
Monitoring, Control and Supervision 693
Measurements and Recording 695
Ratings 696
Input / Output Connections 699
Mechanical Specifications 701
Type Tests 702
Environmental Conditions 703
Electromagnetic Compatibility 704
Regulatory Compliance 707
P446SV-TM-EN-1 683
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV
2 INTERFACES
684 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications
P446SV-TM-EN-1 685
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV
686 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications
Optical budget
850nm MM 1300 nm MM 1300 nm SM 1550 nm SM
Minimum transmit output level (average power) -19.8 dBm -6 dBm -6 dBm -6 dBm
Receiver sensitivity (average power) -25.4 dBm -49 dBm -49 dBm -49 dBm
Optical budget 5.6 dB 43 dB 43 dB 43 dB
Less safety margin (3 dB) 2.6 dB 40 dB 40 dB 40 dB
Typical cable loss 2.6 dB/km 0.8 dB/km 0.4 dB/km 0.3 dB/km
Maximum transmission distance 1 km 50 km 100 km 130 km
P446SV-TM-EN-1 687
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV
3 PROTECTION FUNCTIONS
Tripping characteristics
50 Hz, SIR = 5
60 Hz, SIR = 5
Operating time for resistive faults > 20% inside the 50 Hz, up to SIR = 30 < 30 ms
characteristic 60 Hz, up to SIR = 30 < 25 ms
Accuracy
+/- 5% for on-angle fault (on the set line angle)
+/- 10% for off-angle fault
Characteristic shape, up to SIR = 30
Example: For a 70 degree set line angle, injection testing at 40 degrees
would be referred to as "off-angle".
Zone time delay deviations +/- 20 ms or 2%, whichever is greater
Accuracy
Accuracy of zones and timers As per Distance
688 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications
Accuracy
Accuracy of zones and timers As per Distance
Operating range Up to 7 Hz
The table below shows the minimum and maximum transfer time for InterMiCOM64 (IM64). The times are
measured from opto initialization (with no opto filtering) to relay standard output and include a small propagation
delay for back-back test (2.7 ms for 64 kbits/s and 3.2 ms for 56 kbits/s).
IDiff IM64 indicates InterMiCOM64 signals working in conjunction with the differential protection fibre optic
communications channel. IM64 indicates InterMiCOM64 signals working as a standalone feature.
Configuration Permissive op times (ms) Direct op times (ms)
IM64 at 64 k 13 - 18 17 - 20
IM64 at 56 k 15 - 20 19 - 22
IDiff IM64 at 64 k 22 - 24 23 - 25
IDiff IM64 at 56 k 24 - 26 25 - 27
Accuracy
Timers +/- 20 ms or 2%, whichever is greater
Accuracy
IDMT pick-up 1.05 x Setting +/-5%
DT pick-up Setting +/-5%
Drop-off (IDMT and DT) 0.98 x setting +/-5%
IDMT operate +/-5% of expected operating time or 40 ms, whichever is greater*
IEEE reset +/-5% or 40 ms, whichever is greater
DT operate +/-2% of setting or 40 ms, whichever is greater
DT reset Setting +/-5%
Repeatability <5%
Characteristic UK IEC 60255-3 1998
Characteristic US IEEE C37.112 1996
Note:
*Reference conditions: TMS = 1, TD = 7, I> = 1A, operating range = 2-20In
P446SV-TM-EN-1 689
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV
Additional tolerance due to increasing X/R ratios +/-5% over the X/R ratio of 1 to 90
Overshoot of overcurrent elements < 30 ms
Accuracy
Directional boundary pickup (RCA +/-90%) +/-2°
Directional boundary hysteresis < 2°
Directional boundary repeatability <2%
Accuracy
IDMT pick-up 1.05 x Setting +/-5%
DT pick-up Setting +/-5%, or 20 mA, whichever is greater
Drop-off (IDMT and DT) 0.95 x setting +/-5%
IDMT Operate +/-5% or 40 ms, whichever is greater*
IEEE reset +/-10% or 40 ms, whichever is greater
Repeatability < 5%
DT operate +/-2% or 50 ms, whichever is greater
DT reset +/- 5% or 50 ms, whichever is greater
Note:
Reference conditions: TMS = 1, TD = 1, IN> = 1A, operating range = 2-20In.
690 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications
Note:
Reference conditions: TMS = 1, TD = 1, IN> setting = 100 mA with operating range of 2-20Is.
Wattmetric SEF
Pick-up P = 0 W ISEF > +/-5% or 5 mA
Pick-up P > 0 W P > +/-5%
Drop-off P = 0 W 0.95 x ISEF> +/- 5% or 5 mA
Drop-off P > 0 W 0.9 x P> +/- 5% or 5 mA
Boundary accuracy +/-5% with hysteresis < 1°
Repeatability < 1%
P446SV-TM-EN-1 691
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV
Note:
Operating time measured with applied current of 20% above thermal setting.
692 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications
Accuracy
I1> Pick-up Setting +/- 5%
I1> Drop-off 0.9 x setting +/- 5%
I2/I1> Pick-up Setting +/- 5%
I2/I1> Drop-off 0.9 x setting +/-5%
I2/I1>> Pick-up Setting +/- 5%
I2/I1 >> Drop-off 0.9 x setting +/-5%
Time delay operation Setting +/-2% or 20 ms, whichever is greater
CTS block diff operation < 1 cycle
CTS reset < 35 ms
Accuracy
Timers +/- 40 ms or 2%, whichever is greater
Broken current accuracy +/- 5%
Reset time < 30 ms
P446SV-TM-EN-1 693
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV
694 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications
5.1 GENERAL
Accuracy
+/- 2% of line length
Fault Location
Reference conditions: solid fault applied on line
P446SV-TM-EN-1 695
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV
6 RATINGS
AC Measuring Inputs
Nominal frequency 50 Hz or 60 Hz (settable)
Operating range 45 to 65 Hz
Phase rotation ABC or CBA
AC Voltage Inputs
Nominal voltage 100 V to 120 V
Nominal burden per phase < 0.1 VA at Vn
2 x Vn (continuous operation)
Thermal withstand
2.6 x Vn (for 10 seconds)
Linear up to 200 V (100/120 V supply)
Linearity
Linear up to 800 V (380/400 V supply)
696 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications
Quiescent burden 11 W
2nd rear communications port 1.25 W
Each relay output burden 0.13 W per output relay
Each opto-input burden (24 – 27 V) 0.065 W max
Each opto-input burden (30 – 34 V) 0.065 W max
Each opto-input burden (48 – 54 V) 0.125 W max
Each opto-input burden (110 – 125 V) 0.36 W max
Each opto-input burden (220 – 250 V) 0.9 W max
P446SV-TM-EN-1 697
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV
Note:
Maximum loading = all inputs/outputs energised.
Note:
Quiescent or 1/2 loading = 1/2 of all inputs/outputs energised.
698 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications
Nominal battery
Logic levels: 60-80% DO/PU Logic Levels: 50-70% DO/PU
voltage
24/27 V Logic 0 < 16.2V, Logic 1 > 19.2V Logic 0 <12V, Logic 1 > 16.8V
30/34 Logic 0 < 20.4V, Logic 1 > 24V Logic 0 < 15V, Logic 1 > 21V
48/54 Logic 0 < 32.4V, Logic 1 > 38.4V Logic 0 < 24V, Logic 1 > 33.6V
110/125 Logic 0 < 75V, Logic 1 > 88V Logic 0 < 55.V, Logic 1 > 77V
220/250 Logic 0 < 150V, Logic 1 > 176V Logic 0 < 110V, Logic 1 > 154V
Note:
Filter is required to make the opto-inputs immune to induced AC voltages.
In addition to the above thresholds, some models of this product provide the following threshold levels for FSK
applications:
● For 220/250 voltage inputs: Logic 0 < 145V, Logic 1 > 165V
P446SV-TM-EN-1 699
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV
Make, carry and break, dc inductive 0.5 A for 1 s, 10000 operations (subject to the above limits)
Make, carry and break ac resistive 30 A for 200 ms, 2000 operations (subject to the above limits)
Make, carry and break ac inductive 10 A for 1.5 s, 10000 operations (subject to the above limits)
Loaded contact 1000 operations min.
Unloaded contact 10000 operations min.
Operate time < 5 ms
Reset time < 10 ms
700 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications
8 MECHANICAL SPECIFICATIONS
40TE
Case Types* 60TE
80TE
Weight (40TE case) 7 kg – 8 kg (depending on chosen options)
Weight (60TE case) 9 kg – 12 kg (depending on chosen options)
Weight (80TE case) 13 kg - 16 kg (depending on chosen options)
Dimensions in mm (w x h x l) (40TE case) W: 206.0 mm H: 177.0 mm D: 243.1 mm
Dimensions in mm (w x h x l) (60TE case) W: 309.6 mm H: 177.0 mm D: 243.1 mm
Dimensions in mm (w x h x l) (80TE case) W 413.2 mm H 177.0 mm D 243.1 mm
Mounting Panel, rack, or retrofit
Note:
*Case size is product dependent.
Against dust and dripping water (front face) IP52 as per IEC 60529:2002
Protection against dust (whole case) IP50 as per IEC 60529:2002
Protection for sides of the case (safety) IP30 as per IEC 60529:2002
Protection for rear of the case (safety) IP10 as per IEC 60529:2002
P446SV-TM-EN-1 701
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV
9 TYPE TESTS
9.1 INSULATION
Note:
Exceptions are communications ports and normally-open output contacts, where applicable.
702 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications
10 ENVIRONMENTAL CONDITIONS
P446SV-TM-EN-1 703
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV
11 ELECTROMAGNETIC COMPATIBILITY
IEC 60255-22-4: 2008 and EN61000-4-4:2004. Test severity level lll and lV, IEC
Compliance
60255-26:2013
Applied to communication inputs Amplitude: 2 kV, burst frequency 5 kHz and 100 KHz (level 4)
Applied to power supply and all other inputs
Amplitude: 4 kV, burst frequency 5 kHz and 100 KHz (level 4)
except for communication inputs
704 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications
P446SV-TM-EN-1 705
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV
Note:
Compliance is achieved using the opto-input filter.
706 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications
12 REGULATORY COMPLIANCE
Compliance with the European Commission Directive on EMC and LVD is demonstrated using a technical file.
P446SV-TM-EN-1 707
Chapter 26 - Technical Specifications P446SV
Where:
'(2)G' High protection equipment category, for control of equipment in gas atmospheres in Zone 1 and 2.
This equipment (with parentheses marking around the zone number) is not itself suitable for operation
within a potentially explosive atmosphere.
708 P446SV-TM-EN-1
APPENDIX A
ORDERING OPTIONS
Appendix A - Ordering Options P446SV
P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix A - Ordering Options
In/Vn rating
In = 1A/5A ; Vn = 100-120Vac 1
IEC 61850-9-2LE Sampled Analogue Values Ethernet board * C
Product Options
24 inputs and 32 outputs (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) B
24 inputs and 8 standard plus 12 high break outputs C
24 inputs and 16 standard plus 8 high break outputs D
As B + 850nm dual channel (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) F
As C + 850nm dual channel G
As D + 850nm dual channel H
As B + 1300nm SM single channel (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) J
As C + 1300nm SM single channel K
As D + 1300nm SM single channel L
As B + 1300nm SM dual channel (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) N
As C + 1300nm SM dual channel O
As D + 1300nm SM dual channel P
As B + 1300nm MM single channel (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) R
As C + 1300nm MM single channel S
As D + 1300nm MM single channel T
As B + 1300nm MM dual channel (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) V
As C + 1300nm MM dual channel W
As D + 1300nm MM dual channel X
As B + 850nm MM + 1300mn SM (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) Z
As D + 850nm MM + 1300mn SM 1
As B + 1300mn SM + 850nm MM (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) 2
As D + 1300mn SM + 850nm MM 3
As B + 850nm MM + 1300mn MM (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) 4
As D + 850nm MM + 1300mn MM 5
As B + 1300mn MM + 850nm MM (8 input and 8 outputs Mounting Opt R) 6
As D + 1300mn MM + 850nm MM 7
Mounting
Flush/Panel Mounting with Harsh Environment Coating M
Rack Mounting with Harsh Environmental Coating N
Flush/panel mounting with harsh environment coating P
19" Rack mounting with harsh environmental coating Q
40TE Case (9-2LE models only) Flush/Panel Mounting with Harsh Environmetal Coating R
Language
English, French, German, Spanish 0
English, French, German, Russian 5
English, Italian, Polish and Portuguese * 7
Chinese, English or French via HMI, with English or French only via Communications port C
Software version
Date and application dependant **
Hardware version
Extended main processor (XCPU2) With Function Keys & Tri-colour LEDs K
Main processor (CPU3) 40TE P
As K plus increased main processor memory (XCPU3), Cyber Security M
P446SV-TM-EN-1 A1
Appendix A - Ordering Options P446SV
A2 P446SV-TM-EN-1
APPENDIX B
P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B1
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B2 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B3
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B4 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B5
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B6 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B7
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B8 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B9
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B10 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B11
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B12 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B13
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B14 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B15
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B16 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B17
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B18 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B19
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B20 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B21
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B22 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
‘Free Running’ means the IED is not synchronised with any normal time-server, including IRIG-B, PTP or SNTP. The IED relies solely on its
internal clock.
Card Not Fitted
Card Failed
IRIG-B Status 08 11
Signal Healthy
No Signal
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B23
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
No Master Found = No PTP master can be found, the IED has not received a valid ‘Announce’ message.
Illegal Master = Master clock is not valid, typically this will occur when the clock is not using the correct epoch
Valid Master = At least valid one master clock is available
Disabled
Trying server 1
Trying server 2
Server 1 OK
SNTP Status 08 13
Server 2 OK
No response
No valid clock
[Indexed String]
IEC61850 or DNP3.0 over Ethernet versions only. Displays information about the SNTP time synchronisation status.
Disabled
Fixed
LocalTime Enable 08 20 Flexible
Flexible
[Indexed String]
Setting to turn on/off local time adjustments.
Disabled - No local time zone will be maintained. Time synchronization from any interface will be used to directly set the master clock and all
displayed (or read) times on all interfaces will be based on the master clock with no adjustment.
Fixed - A local time zone adjustment can be defined using the LocalTime offset setting and all interfaces will use local time except SNTP time
synchronization and IEC 61850 timestamps.
Flexible - A local time zone adjustment can be defined using the LocalTime offset setting and each interface can be assigned to the UTC zone
or local time zone with the exception of the local interfaces which will always be in the local time zone and IEC 61850/SNTP which will always
be in the UTC zone.
From -720 to 720 in steps of 15
LocalTime Offset 08 21 0
[Courier Number (time-minutes)]
Setting to specify an offset of -12 to +12 hrs in 15 minute intervals for local time zone. This adjustment is applied to the time based on the
master clock which is UTC/GMT
Disabled
DST Enable 08 22 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to turn on/off daylight saving time adjustment to local time.
30 or 60
DST Offset 08 23 60
[Courier Number (time-minutes)]
Setting to specify daylight saving offset which will be used for the time adjustment to local time.
First
Second
Third
DST Start 08 24 Last
Fourth
Last
[Indexed String]
Setting to specify the week of the month in which daylight saving time adjustment starts
Sunday
Monday
Tuesday
Wednesday
DST Start Day 08 25 Sunday
Thursday
Friday
Saturday
[Indexed String]
Setting to specify the day of the week in which daylight saving time adjustment starts
January
DST Start Month 08 26 March
February
B24 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B25
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B26 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B27
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B28 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B29
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B30 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B31
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B32 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B33
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B34 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B35
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B36 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B37
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B38 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B39
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B40 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B41
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B42 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B43
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B44 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B45
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B46 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B47
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B48 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B49
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
This setting influences the processing of GOOSE and control service frames with an IEC61850 Test mode flag.
To select test mode the IED Test Mode menu cell should be set to ‘Test’, which takes the IED out of service. It also causes an alarm condition
to be recorded and the yellow ‘Out of Service’ LED to illuminate. In IEC 60870-5-103 builds changes the Cause of Transmission, COT, to Test
Mode. In IED Test Mode, only GOOSE messages and control service commands with a quality flat set to "test" will be processed as valid .
To enable testing of output contacts the IED Test Mode cell should be set to Contacts Blocked. This blocks the protection from operating the
contacts and enables the test pattern and contact test functions which can be used to manually operate the output contacts. This mode
also blocks maintenance, counters and freezes any information stored in the Circuit Breaker Condition column. Also in IEC 60870-5-103
B50 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
Once testing is complete the cell must be set back to ‘Disabled’ to restore the IED back to service
The following IEC 61850 Mode definitions apply for the different settings:
0 = Disabled Mod = 1 (On)
1 = Test Mod = 3 (Test)
2 = Contacts Blocked Mod = 4 (Test/blocked)
Note: The cell ‘Test Mode’ used in software prior to IEC 61850 edition 2 has been renamed as ‘IED Test Mode’
Relay 1
Relay 2
Relay 3
Relay 4
Relay 5
Relay 6
Relay 7
Relay 8
Relay 9
Relay 10
Relay 11
Relay 12
Relay 13
Relay 14
Relay 15
Relay 16
Test Pattern 0F 0E 0x0 Relay 17
Relay 18
Relay 19
Relay 20
Relay 21
Relay 22
Relay 23
Relay 24
Relay 25
Relay 26
Relay 27
Relay 28
Relay 29
Relay 30
Relay 31
Relay 32
[Binary Flag (32) Indexed String]
This cell is used to select the output relay contacts that will be tested when the ‘Contact Test’ cell is set to ‘Apply Test’.
No Operation
Apply Test
Contact Test 0F 0F No Operation
Remove Test
[Indexed String]
When the ‘Apply Test’ command in this cell is issued the contacts set for operation (set to ‘1’) in the ‘Test Pattern’ cell change state. After the
test has been applied the command text on the LCD will change to ‘No Operation’ and the contacts will remain in the Test State until reset
issuing the ‘Remove Test’ command. The command text on the LCD will again revert to ‘No Operation’ after the ‘Remove Test’ command has
been issued.
Note: When the ‘Test Mode’ cell is set to ‘Enabled’ the ‘Relay O/P Status’ cell does not show the current status of the output relays and hence
can not be used to confirm operation of the output relays. Therefore it will be necessary to monitor the state of each contact in turn.
No Operation
Test LEDs 0F 10 No Operation Apply Test
[Indexed String]
When the ‘Apply Test’ command in this cell is issued the eighteen user-programmable LEDs will illuminate for approximately 2 seconds
before they extinguish and the command text on the LCD reverts to ‘No Operation’.
No Operation
Test Autoreclose 0F 11 No Operation
Trip 3 Pole
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B51
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B52 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B53
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B54 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B55
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B56 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B57
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B58 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B59
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B60 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B61
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B62 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B63
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B64 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B65
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B66 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B67
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B68 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B69
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B70 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B71
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B72 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B73
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B74 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B75
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B76 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
Disabled
AntiAlias Filter 18 02 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
From 0 to 2 in steps of 1
Synchro Alarm 18 03 Local 1PPS
[Indexed String]
0 or 1
SV Test Mode 18 04 Disabled
[Indexed String]
This setting is used for processing Sampled Value frames with an IEC 61850 Test mode flag. This setting is common to all SV Logical Nodes
configured in the IED.
Disabled: all channel data frames received with an IEC 61850 Test flag are treated as invalid. The IED blocks relevant protection functions
Enabled: all channel data frames received with an IEC 61850 Test flag are treated as good so all protection functions remain active.
Note: The cell ‘9.2 Mode’ used in software prior to IEC 61850 edition 2 has been renamed as ‘SV Test Mode’
From 0 to 3 in steps of 0.25
Merge Unit Delay 18 05 1
[Numeric(time-ms)]
0 or 1
VT Switch Mode 18 06 Disabled
[Indexed String]
From 1 to 8 in steps of 1
LN Count 18 11 1
[Integers]
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B77
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
IA1 IB1 IC1 18 31 LN1 LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]
LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
IA2 IB2 IC2 18 32 Unused LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]
LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
INsen 18 33 Unused LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]
LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
IM 18 34 Unused LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]
LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
VA VB VC 18 35 LN1 LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]
LN1
LN2
Vsc1 18 36 Unused LN3
LN4
LN5
B78 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
Vsc2 18 37 Unused LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]
LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
VA1 VB1 VC1 18 38 LN1 LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]
LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
VA2 VB2 VC2 18 39 Unused LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]
LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
Vcs1 18 3A Unused LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]
LN1
LN2
LN3
LN4
Vcs2 18 3B Unused LN5
LN6
LN7
LN8
[Indexed String]
LN1
LN2
LN3
Vcs3 18 3C Unused LN4
LN5
LN6
LN7
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B79
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
No
MUs Delay Search 18 41 No Yes
[Indexed String]
SAV Absence
SAV Absence 18 51 0
[Binary Flag]
SAV No SmpSynch
SAV No SmpSynch 18 52 0
[Binary Flag]
LN1 FramesRcvd
LN1 FramesRcvd 18 61 1
[Indexed String]
Count of IEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
LN2 FramesRcvd
LN2 FramesRcvd 18 62 0
[Indexed String]
Count of IEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
LN3 FramesRcvd
LN3 FramesRcvd 18 63 0
[Indexed String]
Count of IEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
LN4 FramesRcvd
LN4 FramesRcvd 18 64 0
[Indexed String]
Count of IEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
LN5 FramesRcvd
LN5 FramesRcvd 18 65 0
[Indexed String]
Count ofIEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
LN6 FramesRcvd
LN6 FramesRcvd 18 66 0
[Indexed String]
Count ofIEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
LN7 FramesRcvd
LN7 FramesRcvd 18 67 0
[Indexed String]
Count ofIEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
LN8 FramesRcvd
LN8 FramesRcvd 18 68 0
[Indexed String]
Count of IEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
LN9 FramesRcvd
LN9 FramesRcvd 18 69 0
[Indexed String]
Count of IEC 61850-9-2LE frames received by the LN
Frame Loss Data
Frame Loss Data 18 70 0
[Indexed String]
B80 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
2nd character
LN1 LossRate Sec 18 72 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]
2nd character
LN2 LossRate Sec 18 73 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]
2nd character
LN3 LossRate Sec 18 74 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]
2nd character
LN4 LossRate Sec 18 75 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]
2nd character
LN5 LossRate Sec 18 76 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]
2nd character
LN6 LossRate Sec 18 77 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]
2nd character
LN7 LossRate Sec 18 78 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]
2nd character
LN8 LossRate Sec 18 79 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]
2nd character
LN9 LossRate Sec 18 7A 0 1st character
[Numeric(Percentage)]
No
Loss Rate Reset 18 90 No Yes
[Indexed String]
Reset Time
Reset Time 18 91 0
[Integer]
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B81
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
VA VB VC
VA VB VC 18 D1 0
[Indexed String]
Vsc1
Vsc1 18 D2 0
[Indexed String]
Vsc2
Vsc2 18 D3 0
[Indexed String]
B82 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
This setting allows for an Ethernet connection to be established with the relay without needing to first send a .MCL file via the serial port.
Once a connection has been established the correct .MCL can be sent via Ethernet and this setting can be changed back to “Disabled”.
Note: You can enable this feature when you use the IED for the first time. However, the IED will at this point not have an active MCL file and
any data model extracted from IEC 61850 may not be correct. Therefore, to prevent any issues you should send a correct MCL file to the IED
after a connection is first established.
IP PARAMETERS
IP PARAMETERS 19 30
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only.
IP address
IP address 19 31
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. Displays the unique network IP address that identifies the relay.
Subnet mask
Subnet mask 19 32
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. Displays the sub-network the relay is connected to.
Gateway
Gateway 19 33
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. Displays the IP address of the gateway (proxy) that the relay is connected to, if any.
0 or 1
Media 19 34 1xFibre
[Indexed String]
IEC 61850 versions only. Displays the communication media of the Ethernet port that is currently in use.
IP address
IP address 19 38 0.0.0.0
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. When IP From HMI is enabled this is used to set the unique network IP address that identifies the unit.
Subnet mask
Subnet mask 19 39 0.0.0.0
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. When IP From HMI is enabled this is used to set the sub-network mask.
Gateway
Gateway 19 3A 0.0.0.0
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. Set the IP address of the gateway (proxy) the relay is connected to via HMI if any.
0 or 1
Media 19 3B 1xFibre
[Indexed String]
IEC 61850 versions only. Sets the communication media of the Ethernet port. For products with dual redundant fibre select the
1xCopper/2xFibre setting
SNTP PARAMETERS 19 40
IEC61850 versions only.
SNTP Server 1
SNTP Server 1 19 41
[ASCII text]
IEC61850 versions only. Displays the IP address of the primary SNTP server.
SNTP Server 2
SNTP Server 2 19 42
[ASCII text]
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B83
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
When ‘Disabled’ is selected, the simulation bit for the goose control block is not set.
When ‘Enabled’ is selected, the simulation bit for the goose control block is set.
Once testing is complete the cell must be set back to ‘Disabled’ to restore the GOOSE scheme back to normal service.
Note: The cell ‘Test Mode’ under IED Configurator used in software prior to IEC 61850 Edition 2 has been renamed as ‘Publisher Sim’
No
Ignore Test Flag 19 73 No Yes
[Indexed String]
Be removed after Cat2,This setting is determines whether GOOSE messages with an IEC 61850 Test mode flag are ignored or processed as
valid by the IED.
PROT COMMS/ IM64 20 00
This column contains settings for Current Differtial/IM64 Configuration
3 Terminal
2 Terminal
Scheme Setup 20 01 2 Terminal
Dual Redundant
[Indexed String]
Settings to determine how many relay ends are connected in the differential zone or how many relays are connected to the teleprotection
scheme for the protected line, with two or three ends possible.
For a plain two terminal line, there is an additional option to use dual communication channels, to implement redundancy (i.e. employ a
parallel “hot-standby” path).
0-0
1-A
2-A
3-A
4-A
5-A
6-A
7-A
8-A
Address 20 02 0-0 9-A
10-A
11-A
12-A
13-A
14-A
15-A
16-A
17-A
18-A
B84 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B85
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B86 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B87
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B88 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B89
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
From 0 to 2 in steps of 1
Attempts Limit 25 02 2
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
From 1 to 3 in steps of 1
Attempts Timer 25 03 2
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
B90 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
From 1 to 30 in steps of 1
Blocking Timer 25 04 5
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Disabled
Front Port 25 05 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Disabled
Rear Port 1 25 06 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Disabled
Rear Port 2 25 07 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Disabled
Ethernet Port 25 08 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Disabled
Courier Tunnel 25 09 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Disabled
IEC61850 25 0A Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Disabled
DNP3 OE 25 0B Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Attempts Remain
Attempts Remain 25 11
[Integer]
Fallbck PW Level
Fallbck PW Level 25 20 0
[Unsigned Integer (16 bits)]
Security Code
Security Code 25 FF
[ASCII Text]
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B91
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B92 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B93
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B94 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
Disabled
Mho
Quadrilateral
Phase Chars. 31 11 Mho
Disabled
Mho
[Indexed String]
Setting to disable (turn off) phase distance protection or to set Mho or Quad operating characteristic: ANSI 21P.
The chosen setting is applicable to all phase distance zones.
Common
Quad Resistance 31 12 Proportional Proportional
[Indexed String]
Setting to define the mode of resistive reach coverage. If ‘Common’ mode is selected, all phase distance zones will have the equal resistive
coverage. If ‘Proportional’ mode is selected, the zones will have resistive coverage according to the % reach set for the zone, multiplied by
the ‘Fault Resistance’ RPH setting.
This setting is visible only when ‘Simple’ setting mode and quad characteristic are set.
From 0.1*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
Fault Resistance 31 13 10
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting used to specify the fault arc resistance that can be detected for faults between phases. The set value determines the right hand side
of the quadrilaterals.
This setting is visible only when ‘Simple’ setting mode and quad characteristic are set.
Disabled
Enabled
Zone 1 Ph Status 31 20 Enabled
Enabled Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) or enable (only in the case that differential protection communication channel is lost) Z1 for phase
faults.
This setting is invisible if ‘Phase Char.’ is disabled.
From 10 to 1000 in steps of 1
Zone 1 Ph Reach 31 21 80
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting entry as percentage of the line impedance that sets Zone 1 reach in ohms.
Disabled
Enabled
Zone 2 Ph Status 31 30 Enabled
Enabled Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) or enable (only in the case that differential protection communication channel is lost) Z2 for phase
faults.
This setting is invisible if ‘Phase Char.’ is disabled.
From 10 to 1000 in steps of 1
Zone 2 Ph Reach 31 31 150
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting entry as percentage of the line impedance that sets Zone 2 reach in ohms.
Disabled
Enabled
Zone 3 Ph Status 31 40 Enabled
Enabled Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) or enable (only in the case that differential protection communication channel is lost) Z3 for phase
faults.
This setting is invisible if ‘Phase Char.’ is disabled.
From 10 to 1000 in steps of 1
Zone 3 Ph Reach 31 41 250
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Setting entry as percentage of the line impedance that sets Zone 3 forward reach in ohms.
Disabled
Zone 3 Ph Offset 31 42 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B95
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
Disabled
Mho
Quadrilateral
Ground Chars. 31 71 Mho
Disabled
Mho
[Indexed String]
Setting to disable (turn off) ground distance protection or to set Mho or Quad operating characteristic: ANSI 21G.
The chosen setting is applicable to all ground distance zones.
Common
Quad Resistance 31 72 Proportional Proportional
[Indexed String]
Setting to define the mode of resistive reach coverage. If ‘Common’ mode is selected, all ground distance zones will have the equal resistive
coverage. If ‘Proportional’ mode is selected, the zones will have resistive coverage according to the % reach set for the zone, multiplied by
the ‘Fault Resistance’ RG setting.
This setting is visible only when ‘Simple’ setting mode and quad characteristic are set.
From 0.1*v1/I1 to 500*V1/I1 in steps of 0.01*V1/I1
Fault Resistance 31 73 10
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Setting used to specify the fault arc resistance that can be detected for faults phase - ground. The set value determines the right hand side
of the quadrilaterals.
This setting is visible only when ‘Simple’ setting mode and quad characteristic are set.
Disabled
Enabled
Zone 1 Gnd Stat. 31 80 Enabled
Enabled Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
To enable (activate) or disable (turn off) or enable (only in the case that differential protection communication channel is lost) Zone 1 for
ground faults.
This setting is invisible if ‘Ground Char.’ is disabled.
B96 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B97
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
Disabled
Dir. Status 31 E1 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting used to enable or disable Delta Direction (∆I/∆V).
To enable or disable the delta direction decision used by distance elements. If disabled, the relay uses conventional (non delta) directional
lines.
Disabled
Phase only
AidedDeltaStatus 31 E2 Phase and Ground Ground only
Phase And Ground
[Indexed String]
This setting is only used for channel aided schemes, and is used to select which types of fault Delta Directional Comparison protection to
apply.
When this setting is disabled, Delta V Fwd, Delta V Rev, Delta I Fwd and Delta I Rev are invisible.
This setting is invisible if the Delta Status setting is disabled.
B98 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B99
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B100 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B101
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B102 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B103
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B104 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B105
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
Disabled
PUR
PUR Unblocking
POR
POR Unblocking
Aid. 2 Selection 34 61 Disabled
Blocking 1
Blocking 2
Prog. Unblocking
Programmable
[Indexed String]
Selection of the generic scheme type for aided channel 2.
Note: POR is equivalent to POTT (permissive overreach transfer trip), PUR is
equivalent to PUTT (permissive underreach transfer trip).
Disabled
Phase only
Aid 2 Distance 34 62 Disabled Ground only
Phase And Ground
[Indexed String]
B106 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B107
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
Disabled
Enabled PoleDead
SOTF Status 34 81 Enabled PoleDead Enabled ExtPulse
En Pdead + Pulse
[Indexed String]
Setting that enables note (turns on) or disables (turns off) a special protection logic which can apply upon line energization. SOTF = Switch
on to Fault.
Note: SOTF can be enabled in three different manners:
1. Enabled Pole Dead. By using pole dead logic detection logic
2. Enabled ExtPulse. By using an external pulse
3. En Pdead + Pulse. By using both
From 0.2 to 1000 in steps of 0.2
SOTF Delay 34 82 110
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
The SOTF Delay is a pick up time delay that starts after opening all 3 poles of a CB. If the CB is then closed after the set time delay has
expired, SOTF protection will be active. SOTF provides enhanced protection for manual closure of the breaker (not for auto-reclosure).
This setting is visible only if Pole Dead or Pdead + Pulse are selected to enable SOTF.
Zone 1
Zone 2
Zone 3
SOTF Tripping 34 83 1 Zone P
Zone 4
Current No Volts
[Binary Flag (indexed string)]
Logic Settings that determine the Distance zones that are allowed to operate instantaneously upon line energization. If, for example, Bit 1 is
set to 1 (High), Z2 will operate without waiting for the usual tZ2 time delay should a fault lie within Z2 upon CB closure. It also allows a user
to map ‘Currents No Volt’ option for fast fault clearance upon line energization. SOTF tripping is 3 phase and auto-reclose will be blocked.
Disabled
TOR Status 34 84 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
B108 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
Disabled
Enabled
En. on Ch1 Fail
Z1 Ext Scheme 34 B1 Disabled En. on Ch2 Fail
En. All Ch Fail
En. Any Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
Setting that enables (turns on) or disables (turns off) the Zone 1 Extension scheme. When Enabled, extended Zone 1 will apply unless the
Reset Zone 1 Extension DDB signal is energized. Otherwise, it is possible to enable Z1X when aided scheme channel(s) fail.
From 100 to 200 in steps of 1
Z1 Ext Ph 34 B2 150
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Extended Z1X phase reach as a percentage of the Z1 phase reach. (Phase resistive reach for Z1X is the same as for Zone 1.)
From 100 to 200 in steps of 1
Z1 Ext Gnd 34 B3 150
[Courier Number (percentage)]
Extended Z1X ground reach as a percentage of Z1 ground reach. (Ground resistive reach and residual compensation for Z1X is the same as
for Zone 1.)
Loss of Load 34 C0
Disabled
Enabled
En. on Ch1 Fail
LOL Scheme 34 C1 Disabled En. on Ch2 Fail
En. All Ch Fail
En. Any Ch Fail
[Indexed String]
Setting that enables (turns on) or disables (turns off) the Loss of Load scheme. When Enabled, accelerated tripping can apply as the remote
end opens (3-pole trip applications only). Otherwise, it is possible to enable Z1X when aided scheme channel(s) fail.
From 0.05*I1 to 1*I1 in steps of 0.05*I1
LOL <I 34 C3 0.5
[Courier Number (current)]
LOL undercurrent detector that indicates a loss of load condition on the unfaulted phases, indicating that the remote end has just opened.
From 0.01 to 0.1 in steps of 0.01
LoL Window 34 C4 0.04
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B109
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B110 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B111
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B112 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B113
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B114 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B115
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B116 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B117
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B118 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B119
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B120 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B121
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B122 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B123
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B124 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B125
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
Disabled
DT
V1>1 Cmp Funct 42 23 Disabled
IDMT
[Indexed String]
Tripping characteristic setting for the first stage compensated overvoltage element.
The IDMT characteristic available on the first stage is defined by the following formula:
t = K/(M - 1)
Where:
K = Time multiplier setting
t = Operating time in seconds
M = Remote calculated voltage/relay setting voltage (V<>Voltage Set)
From 60*V1 to 110*V1 in steps of 1*V1
V1>1 Cmp Vlt Set 42 24 75
[Courier Number (voltage)]
Sets the pick-up setting for first stage overvoltage element. This is set in terms of the phase to neutral voltage.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
V1>1 Cmp Tim Dly 42 25 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the operating time-delay for the first stage definite time compensated overvoltage element.
From 0.5 to 100 in steps of 0.5
V1>1 Cmp TMS 42 26 1
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Setting for the time multiplier setting to adjust the operating time of the IDMT characteristic.
Disabled
V1>2 Cmp Status 42 27 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the second stage compensated overvoltage element.
V1>2 Cmp Vlt Set 42 28 85 From 60*V1 to 110*V1 in steps of 1*V1
B126 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
Disabled
F<1 Status 43 02 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the first stage underfrequency element.
From 45 to 65 in steps of 0.01
F<1 Setting 43 03 49.5
[Courier Number (frequency)]
Setting that determines the pick-up threshold for the first stage underfrequency element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
F<1 Time Delay 43 04 4
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the minimum operating time-delay for the first stage underfrequency element.
Disabled
F<2 Status 43 05 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the second stage underfrequency element.
From 45 to 65 in steps of 0.01
F<2 Setting 43 06 49
[Courier Number (frequency)]
Setting that determines the pick-up threshold for the second stage underfrequency element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
F<2 Time Delay 43 07 3
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the minimum operating time-delay for the second stage underfrequency element.
Disabled
F<3 Status 43 08 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the third stage underfrequency element.
From 45 to 65 in steps of 0.01
F<3 Setting 43 09 48.5
[Courier Number (frequency)]
Setting that determines the pick-up threshold for the third stage underfrequency element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
F<3 Time Delay 43 0A 2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the minimum operating time-delay for the third stage underfrequency element.
Disabled
F<4 Status 43 0B Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the fourth stage underfrequency element.
From 45 to 65 in steps of 0.01
F<4 Setting 43 0C 48
[Courier Number (frequency)]
Setting that determines the pick-up threshold for the fourth stage underfrequency element.
From 0 to 100 in steps of 0.01
F<4 Time Delay 43 0D 1
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the minimum operating time-delay for the fourth stage underfrequency element.
F<1 U/V Block
F<2 U/V Block
F< Function Link 43 0E 0x0 F<3 U/V Block
F<4 U/V Block
[Binary Flag (4 bits)]
Settings that determines whether undervoltage level (setting CB FAIL & P.DEAD/POLEDEAD VOLTAGE/V< ) signal block the underfrequency
elements.
OVER FREQUENCY 43 0F
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B127
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B128 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
Disabled
CB Fail 1 Status 45 02 Enabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the first stage of the circuit breaker function.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
CB Fail 1 Timer 45 03 0.2
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the circuit breaker fail timer stage 1, during which breaker opening must be detected. There are timers per phase to cope with
evolving faults, but the timer setting is common.
Disabled
CB Fail 2 Status 45 04 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
Setting to enable or disable the second stage of the circuit breaker function.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
CB Fail 2 Timer 45 05 0.4
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting for the circuit breaker fail timer stage 2, during which breaker opening must be detected.
I< Only
CB Open & I<
Volt Prot Reset 45 06 Prot Reset & I<
Prot Reset & I<
[Indexed String]
Setting which determines the elements that will reset the circuit breaker fail time for voltage protection function initiated circuit breaker fail
conditions.
I< Only
CB Open & I<
Ext Prot Reset 45 07 Prot Reset & I<
Prot Reset & I<
[Indexed String]
Setting which determines the elements that will reset the circuit breaker fail time for external protection function initiated circuit breaker fail
conditions.
Disabled
WI Prot Reset 45 08 Disabled
Enabled
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B129
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B130 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
Disabled
Standard / Enabled
CTS Mode 46 31 Disabled I Diff
IDiff + Std
[Indexed String]
Setting to disable, enable the standard (voltage dependant) CTS element
Restrain
CTS Status 46 32 Restrain Indication
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether the following operations will occur upon detection of CTS.
• CTS set to provide alarm indication only.
• CTS set to restrain local protection
The settings are visible if CTS Mode is not disabled.
Manual
CTS Reset Mode 46 33 Manual Auto
[Indexed String]
The CTS block will be latched after a user settable time delay ‘CTS Time Delay’. Once the signal has latched then two methods of resetting
are available. The first is manually via the front panel interface (or remote communications) and secondly, when in ‘Auto’ mode, provided the
CTS condition has been removed. The setting is visible if CTS Mode is not disabled.
From 0 to 10 in steps of 0.01
CTS Time Delay 46 34 5
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Setting that determines the operating time-delay of the element upon detection of a current transformer supervision condition. The setting
is visible if CTS Mode is not disabled
From 0.5*V1 to 22*V1 in steps of 0.5*V1
CTS VN< Inhibit 46 35 5
[Courier Number (voltage)]
This setting is used to inhibit the current transformer supervision element should the zero sequence voltage exceed this setting. The setting
is visible if CTS Mode is not disabled
From 0.08*I1 to 4*I1 in steps of 0.01*I1
CTS IN> Set 46 36 0.1
[Courier Number (current)]
This setting determines the level of zero sequence current that must be present for a valid current transformer supervision condition. The
setting is visible if CTS Mode is not disabled
GROUP 1: SYSTEM
48 00
CHECKS
This column contains settings for System Checks
VOLTAGE MONITORS 48 14
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B131
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B132 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B133
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
CB1 Only
CB2 Only
Num CBs 48 B1 CB1 Only
CB1&CB2
[Indexed String]
This setting is only visible if the CB Control by cell (Cell 0701 under CB CONTROL column) is ‘Enabled’.
If visible, the setting dictates which of the circuit breakers (CB1 only, CB2 only, or both CB1 & CB2) can be manually closed.
Disabled
CB1M SC required 48 B2 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting determines whether a system check (e.g. live bus / dead line etc) is required for any manual (operator-controlled) closure of CB1.
If Enabled, system check is required for closure. If Disabled, system check is not required.
Disabled
CB1M SC CS1 48 B3 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to close by manual control when the system satisfies all the System Check Synchronism Stage 1 conditions as listed
under the setting CB1 CS1 Status in the SYSTEM CHECKS column.
Disabled
CB1M SC CS2 48 B4 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to close by manual control when the system satisfies all the System Check Synchronism Stage 2 conditions as listed
under the setting CB1 CS2 Status in the SYSTEM CHECKS column.
Disabled
CB1M SC DLLB 48 B5 Disabled Enabled
[Indexed String]
This setting enables CB1 to close by manual control when the dead line & live bus1 conditions are satisfied as set in the SYSTEM CHECKS
column.
Disabled
CB1M SC LLDB 48 B6 Disabled
Enabled
B134 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B135
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B136 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B137
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B138 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B139
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B140 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B141
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B142 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B143
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B144 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
Faulted Phase
Faulted Phase B0 07
[Binary Flag (8) Indexed String]
Fault Time
Fault Time B0 0D
[IEC870 Time & Date]
Active Group
Active Group B0 0E
[Unsigned Integer]
System Frequency
System Frequency B0 0F
[Courier Number (frequency)]
Fault Duration
Fault Duration B0 10
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B145
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
CB Operate Time
CB Operate Time B0 11
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Fault Location
Fault Location B0 13
[Courier Number (metres)]
Fault Location
Fault Location B0 14
[Courier Number (miles)]
Fault Location
Fault Location B0 15
[Courier Number (impedance)]
Fault Location
Fault Location B0 16
[Courier Number (percentage)]
IA Pre Flt
IA Pre Flt B0 20
[Courier Number (current)]
IB Pre Flt
IB Pre Flt B0 22
[Courier Number (current)]
IC Pre Flt
IC Pre Flt B0 24
[Courier Number (current)]
IN Pre Flt
IN Pre Flt B0 26
[Courier Number (current)]
IM Pre Flt
IM Pre Flt B0 28
[Courier Number (current)]
VA Pre Flt
VA Pre Flt B0 30
[Courier Number (voltage)]
B146 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
VC Pre Flt
VC Pre Flt B0 34
[Courier Number (voltage)]
VN Pre Flt
VN Pre Flt B0 36
[Courier Number (voltage)]
IA Fault
IA Fault B0 40
[Courier Number (current)]
IA Angle Fault
IA Angle Fault B0 41
[Courier Number (degrees)]
IB Fault
IB Fault B0 42
[Courier Number (current)]
IB Angle Fault
IB Angle Fault B0 43
[Courier Number (degrees)]
IC Fault
IC Fault B0 44
[Courier Number (current)]
IC Angle Fault
IC Angle Fault B0 45
[Courier Number (degrees)]
IN Fault
IN Fault B0 46
[Courier Number (current)]
IN Angle Fault
IN Angle Fault B0 47
[Courier Number (degrees)]
IM Fault
IM Fault B0 48
[Courier Number (current)]
IM Angle Fault
IM Angle Fault B0 49
[Courier Number (degrees)]
VA Fault
VA Fault B0 50
[Courier Number (voltage)]
VA Angle Fault
VA Angle Fault B0 51
[Courier Number (degrees)]
VB Fault
VB Fault B0 52
[Courier Number (voltage)]
VB Angle Fault
VB Angle Fault B0 53
[Courier Number (degrees)]
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B147
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
VC Angle Fault
VC Angle Fault B0 55
[Courier Number (degrees)]
VN Fault
VN Fault B0 56
[Courier Number (voltage)]
VN Angle Fault
VN Angle Fault B0 57
[Courier Number (degrees)]
V1 Rem Magnitude
V1 Rem Magnitude B0 98
[Courier Number (current)]
Event Text
Event Text B1 03
[ASCII Text]
Maint Type
Maint Type B1 04
[UINT32]
Maint Data
Maint Data B1 05
[UINT32]
0 or 1
Domain B2 04 PSL Settings
[Indexed String]
From 0 to 3 in steps of 1
Sub-Domain B2 08 Group 1
[Indexed String]
Prepare Rx
Complete Rx
Prepare Tx
Complete Tx
Transfer Mode B2 1C 6 Rx Prepared
Tx Prepared
OK
Error
[Unsigned Integer Indexed String]
Data Transfer B2 20
Recorder Source
Recorder Source B3 02 Samples
[Indexed String]
B148 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
Active Channels
Active Channels B4 03
[Binary Flag]
Channel Types
Channel Types B4 04
[Binary Flag]
Channel Offsets
Channel Offsets B4 05
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Channel Scaling
Channel Scaling B4 06
[Courier Number (decimal)]
Channel SkewVal
Channel SkewVal B4 07
[Integer]
Channel MinVal
Channel MinVal B4 08
[Integer]
Channel MaxVal
Channel MaxVal B4 09
[Integer]
Format
Format B4 0A
[Unsigned Integer]
Upload
Upload B4 0B
[Unsigned Integer]
No. Of Samples
No. Of Samples B4 10
[Unsigned Integer]
Trig Position
Trig Position B4 11
[Unsigned Integer]
Time Base
Time Base B4 12
[Courier Number (time-seconds)]
Sample Times
Sample Times B4 14
[Unsigned Integer]
Dist. Channel 1
Dist. Channel 1 B4 20
[Integer]
Dist. Channel 2
Dist. Channel 2 B4 21
[Integer]
Dist. Channel 3
Dist. Channel 3 B4 22
[Integer]
Dist. Channel 4
Dist. Channel 4 B4 23
[Integer]
Dist. Channel 5
Dist. Channel 5 B4 24
[Integer]
Dist. Channel 6
Dist. Channel 6 B4 25
[Integer]
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B149
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
Dist. Channel 7
Dist. Channel 7 B4 26
[Integer]
Dist. Channel 8
Dist. Channel 8 B4 27
[Integer]
Dist. Channel 9
Dist. Channel 9 B4 28
[Integer]
Dist. Channel 10
Dist. Channel 10 B4 29
[Integer]
Dist. Channel 11
Dist. Channel 11 B4 2A
[Integer]
Dist. Channel 12
Dist. Channel 12 B4 2B
[Integer]
Dist. Channel 13
Dist. Channel 13 B4 2C
[Integer]
Dist. Channel 31
Dist. Channel 31 B4 3D
[Binary Flag]
Dist. Channel 32
Dist. Channel 32 B4 3E
[Binary Flag]
Channel Types B5 03
Cal Coeffs B5 04
Err Count F B6 01
Msg Count F B6 02
Prot Count F B6 03
Slave Count F B6 04
Reset Count F B6 05
Err Count R B6 06
Prot Count R B6 07
Slave Count R B6 08
Busy Count R B6 09
Reset Count R B6 0A
PSL DATA B7 00
B150 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
Date/Time
Date/Time B7 02
[IEC870 Date & Time]
Grp1 PSL ID
Grp1 PSL ID B7 03 0
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
Date/Time
Date/Time B7 12
[IEC870 Date & Time]
Grp2 PSL ID
Grp2 PSL ID B7 13 0
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
Date/Time
Date/Time B7 22
[IEC870 Date & Time]
Grp3 PSL ID
Grp3 PSL ID B7 23 0
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
Date/Time
Date/Time B7 32
[IEC870 Date & Time]
Grp4 PSL ID
Grp4 PSL ID B7 33 0
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
Setting Transfer BF 03
Reset Demand BF 04
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B151
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
Connected i/face
Connected i/face BF 11
[Integer]
Security Column
Security Column BF 12 2500
[Menu Cell(2)]
Port Disable
Port Disable BF 13 2505
[Menu Cell(2)]
PW Entry Needed
PW Entry Needed BF 15
[Unsigned Integer (32 bits)]
B152 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B153
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B154 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B155
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B156 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B157
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B158 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B159
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B160 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B161
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B162 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B163
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B164 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B165
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B166 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B167
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B168 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B169
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B170 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B171
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B172 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B173
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B174 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B175
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B176 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
If the device has been put into 'Contact Blocked' mode using this input signal then the Apply Test command will not execute. This is to
prevent a device that has been blocked by an external process having its contacts operated by a local operator using the HMI.
If the Block Contacts DDB is not set and the Apply Test command in is issued, the contacts will change state.
863 Contacts Blocked DDB_CONTACTS_BLOCKED_OP
Indicates contacts blocked mode enabled. Can be mapped in PSL and sent via InterMiCOM/IM64 to block contacts at the remote end.
864 IA< Start DDB_PHASE_A_UNDERCURRENT
A phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current). It is used for breaker failure in models with one CT input and also it
is used for fault record reset (as the sum CTs in models with two CTs)
865 IB< Start DDB_PHASE_B_UNDERCURRENT
B phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current). It is used for breaker failure in models with one CT input and also it
is used for fault record reset (as the sum CTs in models with two CTs)
866 IC< Start DDB_PHASE_C_UNDERCURRENT
C phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current). It is used for breaker failure in models with one CT input and also it
is used for fault record reset (as the sum CTs in models with two CTs)
867 CB1 IA< Start DDB_PHASE_A_UNDERCURRENT_CB1
A phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current in CT1). It is used for breaker failure in models with two CT inputs
868 CB1 IB< Start DDB_PHASE_B_UNDERCURRENT_CB1
B phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current in CT1). It is used for breaker failure in models with two CT inputs
869 CB1 IC< Start DDB_PHASE_C_UNDERCURRENT_CB1
C phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current in CT1). It is used for breaker failure in models with two CT inputs
870 CB2 IA< Start DDB_PHASE_A_UNDERCURRENT_CB2
A phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current in CT2). It is used for breaker failure in models with two CT inputs
871 CB2 IB< Start DDB_PHASE_B_UNDERCURRENT_CB2
B phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current in CT2). It is used for breaker failure in models with two CT inputs
872 CB2 IC< Start DDB_PHASE_C_UNDERCURRENT_CB2
C phase undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current in CT2). It is used for breaker failure in models with two CT inputs
873 ISEF< Start DDB_SEF_UNDERCURRENT
SEF undercurrent level detector pickup (detects low current in CT SEF)
876 Z1X Active DDB_ZONE1_EXT_ACTIVE
Zone 1 extension active - zone 1 is operating in its reach extended mode
877 TOC Active DDB_TOC_ACTIVE
Trip on close functions (either SOTF or TOR) active. These elements are in-service for a period of time following circuit breaker closure
878 TOR Active DDB_TOR_ACTIVE
Trip on re-close protection is active - indicated TOC delay timer has elapsed after circuit breaker opening, and remains in-service on
auto-reclosure for the duration of the trip on close window
879 SOTF Active DDB_SOTF_ACTIVE
Switch on to fault protection is active - in service on manual breaker closure, and then remains in-service for the duration of the trip
on close window
880 SChksInactiveCB1 DDB_SYSCHECKS_INACTIVE
Output from CB1 system check logic: indicates system checks for CB1 are disabled (setting "System Checks CB1" = Disabled or global
setting "System Checks" = Disabled)+D2269
881 CB1 CS1 Enabled DDB_CHECKSYNC_1_ENABLED
DDB input must be high to enable CB1check sync 1 logic to operate. Defaults to high if not mapped in PSL; if mapped in PSL must be
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B177
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B178 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B179
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B180 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B181
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B182 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B183
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B184 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B185
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B186 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B187
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B188 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B189
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B190 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B191
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B192 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B193
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B194 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B195
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B196 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B197
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B198 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B199
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B200 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B201
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B202 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B203
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B204 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B205
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B206 P446SV-TM-EN-1
P446SV Appendix B -Settings and Signals
P446SV-TM-EN-1 B207
Appendix B -Settings and Signals P446SV
B208 P446SV-TM-EN-1
APPENDIX C
WIRING DIAGRAMS
Appendix C - Wiring Diagrams P446SV
P446SV-TM-EN-1
Issue: Revision: Title:
DRAWING OUTLINE UPDATED. CID BLIN-8BHLDT EXTERNAL CONNECTION DIAGRAM: COMMS OPTIONS
J MICOM Px40 PLATFORM
Drg
Date: 30/11/2010 Name: W.LINTERN ALSTOM GRID UK LTD Sht: 1
CAD DATA 1:1 DIMENSIONS: mm No:
Substation Automation Solutions
DO NOT SCALE Next -
Date: Chkd: (STAFFORD)
10Px4001 Sht:
MiCOM P446 (PART) MiCOM P446 (PART)
F11
WATCHDOG
F12 CONTACT
D1
- F13
OPTO 1 WATCHDOG
D2 F14 CONTACT
+
D3 NOTE 3
-
OPTO 2 E1
D4
+ E2 RELAY 1
D5 E3
-
D6 OPTO 3 E4 RELAY 2
RJ45 +
E5
TX+ 1 D7
- E6 RELAY 3
TX- 2 OPTO 4
D8 E7
100 BASE-TX RX+ 3 +
E8 RELAY 4
4 D9
SLOT C IEC 61850-9-2 LE SK6 -
OPTO 5 E9
5 D10
(SAMPLE ANALOGUE VALUE ONLY) + E10 RELAY 5
RX- 6
D11 E11
7 -
OPTO 6 E12 RELAY 6
8 D12
+ E13
D13 E14
- RELAY 7
D14 OPTO 7 E15
100 BASE-FX +
TX E16
D15
SLOT C IEC 61850-9-2 LE - E17
OPTO 8 RELAY 8
(SAMPLE ANALOGUE VALUE ONLY) D16 E18
RX +
D17
COMMON
D18 CONNECTION
SLOT A COMMS
NOTE 2.
F17
-
SEE DRAWING
EIA485/
TX1 KBUS 10Px4001.
F18
PORT +
F16
RX1 SCN
FIBRE OPTIC
SLOT B
COMMUNICATION
TX2
RX2
F1 *
-
AC OR DC
x F2
+
CASE
EARTH
NOTES .
1. PIN TERMINAL (P.C.B. TYPE)
2. FOR COMMS OPTIONS SEE DRAWING 10Px4001
Grid Solutions
St Leonards Building
Redhill Business Park
Stafford, ST16 1WT, UK
+44 (0) 1785 250 070
www.gegridsolutions.com/contact
© 2017 General Electric. All rights reserved. Information contained in this document is indicative only. No representation or warranty is given or
should be relied on that it is complete or correct or will apply to any particular project. This will depend on the technical and commercial
circumstances. It is provided without liability and is subject to change without notice. Reproduction, use or disclosure to third parties, without
express written authority, is strictly prohibited.
P446SV-TM-EN-1